[go: up one dir, main page]

WO2019160063A2 - Système de fourniture d'informations utilisant des supports physiques et procédé de fourniture d'informations - Google Patents

Système de fourniture d'informations utilisant des supports physiques et procédé de fourniture d'informations Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2019160063A2
WO2019160063A2 PCT/JP2019/005450 JP2019005450W WO2019160063A2 WO 2019160063 A2 WO2019160063 A2 WO 2019160063A2 JP 2019005450 W JP2019005450 W JP 2019005450W WO 2019160063 A2 WO2019160063 A2 WO 2019160063A2
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
information
node
user
article
main
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Ceased
Application number
PCT/JP2019/005450
Other languages
English (en)
Japanese (ja)
Other versions
WO2019160063A3 (fr
Inventor
崇司 今川
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Individual
Original Assignee
Individual
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Individual filed Critical Individual
Publication of WO2019160063A2 publication Critical patent/WO2019160063A2/fr
Publication of WO2019160063A3 publication Critical patent/WO2019160063A3/fr
Priority to US16/992,651 priority Critical patent/US20210124791A1/en
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Ceased legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING OR CALCULATING; COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F16/00Information retrieval; Database structures therefor; File system structures therefor
    • G06F16/90Details of database functions independent of the retrieved data types
    • G06F16/95Retrieval from the web
    • G06F16/955Retrieval from the web using information identifiers, e.g. uniform resource locators [URL]
    • G06F16/9566URL specific, e.g. using aliases, detecting broken or misspelled links
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING OR CALCULATING; COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F16/00Information retrieval; Database structures therefor; File system structures therefor
    • G06F16/90Details of database functions independent of the retrieved data types
    • G06F16/95Retrieval from the web
    • G06F16/955Retrieval from the web using information identifiers, e.g. uniform resource locators [URL]
    • G06F16/9558Details of hyperlinks; Management of linked annotations
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING OR CALCULATING; COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F16/00Information retrieval; Database structures therefor; File system structures therefor
    • G06F16/90Details of database functions independent of the retrieved data types
    • G06F16/95Retrieval from the web
    • G06F16/951Indexing; Web crawling techniques
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING OR CALCULATING; COUNTING
    • G06FELECTRIC DIGITAL DATA PROCESSING
    • G06F16/00Information retrieval; Database structures therefor; File system structures therefor
    • G06F16/90Details of database functions independent of the retrieved data types
    • G06F16/95Retrieval from the web
    • G06F16/955Retrieval from the web using information identifiers, e.g. uniform resource locators [URL]
    • G06F16/9562Bookmark management
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING OR CALCULATING; COUNTING
    • G06QINFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGY [ICT] SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES; SYSTEMS OR METHODS SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES, NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
    • G06Q30/00Commerce
    • G06Q30/02Marketing; Price estimation or determination; Fundraising

Definitions

  • the present invention is used as various physical media having article properties (article properties) and object properties (object properties) such as merchandise and advertising paper media and / or physical media such as information terminal devices having a liquid crystal screen.
  • NFC Near Field Communication
  • the invention of Patent Document 1 relates to Internet shopping in a form in which a recipient selects a product, and makes it a subject to prevent the recipient from knowing the gift amount designated as the amount of the gift (summary). reference). Specifically, the invention of Patent Document 1 displays a gift code on a gift card by displaying a money amount code (not a money amount display) corresponding to the amount of the gift. While the amount of money is hidden and not displayed directly, the recipient inputs the amount code into a smartphone or other device, and the product group in the price range corresponding to the amount code is displayed on the device.
  • this gift card may embed an NFC tag, and the recipient reads the NFC tag with the terminal, thereby displaying a home page for inputting the amount code on the recipient's terminal (see FIG. 10 and paragraph 0083). ).
  • the invention of Patent Document 2 has an object to input / output information obtained from the real world such as a real product to social media by a simple operation.
  • the NFC application when the user holds the information terminal over the NFC tag, the NFC application reads information from the NFC tag via the NFC reader, and Display a product page for propagating interest within a social network.
  • the user can propagate the interest and interest shown with respect to the product 101 to the community on the social network using the information extracted from the real world (the summary, FIG. 1 and the paragraph). 0052).
  • the NFC tag stores information about the product in the storage unit (paragraph 0045), and when the information terminal reads the information of the NFC tag, the information terminal performs a predetermined process. (Paragraph 0051).
  • the information stored in the NFC is information for causing the information terminal to execute some processing on the product (although the specific contents are not clear from the description of FIG. 1 and paragraph 0045). Can be inferred.
  • the invention of Patent Document 2 causes the information terminal to execute a predetermined process by reading NFC, but the process intended by the invention of Patent Document 2 is also completed at this point.
  • the conventional invention using NFC is based on predetermined information stored in NFC and performs predetermined processing corresponding to an NFC reading operation as an origin (event) (the invention of Patent Document 1 and Patent Document 2).
  • the invention of Patent Document 1 and Patent Document 2 In the present invention, only display processing on the terminal is executed.
  • bookmark function As a function of a web browser for browsing a website on the Internet, there is a function called a bookmark (hereinafter simply referred to as “bookmark function”).
  • This bookmark function registers the URL of the web page in the web browser for a specific web page of an arbitrary website accessed by the web browser, and thereafter the URL of the bookmark (to be exact, it corresponds to the URL).
  • This is a function that allows you to access the web page instantly by simply clicking on the page name of the top page of the website.
  • this bookmark function users of web browsers can collect websites that they want to re-access, and if necessary, instantly access desired web pages on any website and browse the contents. It becomes easy.
  • the conventional bookmark function exists only as a web site virtually provided on the Internet (for example, a web site of an online shop which is a virtual store on the Internet or a virtual site on the Internet. It is a technology that facilitates access to the website of a manufacturer of a specific product.
  • the present inventor uses the conventional bookmark function as a tangible object as a physical entity rather than a virtual entity, for example, a specific product itself in which the user is interested, or a specific actual store in which the user is interested. I thought that it could be related to tangible objects such as, and repeated earnest research and development on the technology that makes that possible.
  • the present inventor considers that the idea of the conventional bookmark function can be applied for the construction of an information network of a new idea using NFC, and a technology that enables such an idea. We have earnestly researched and developed. As a result, the inventor has conceived an information providing system using the physical medium according to the present invention.
  • the present invention provides a physical medium such as an information terminal device having a liquid crystal screen in addition to various physical media having article properties (article properties) and object properties (object properties) such as merchandise and advertising paper media.
  • Information providing system using a physical medium that provides predetermined information consisting of a series of information having temporal and / or locational and / or contextual relevance using a display of a liquid crystal screen as The provision of an information providing method is a first problem.
  • the present invention uses various physical media having article properties (article properties) and object properties (object properties) such as commodities and the like (hereinafter referred to as “physical media”).
  • Specific information ”), information related to the physical medium (hereinafter referred to as“ physical medium-related information ”), geographical information and location information where the physical medium is located, but not related to the physical medium.
  • Various kinds of predetermined information (hereinafter referred to as “physical medium association information”) that can be associated with a physical medium, such as unique information or related information (hereinafter referred to as “physical medium position information”).
  • the object ID can be recorded on the spot by simply recording the object ID (local ID or node ID) on the spot.
  • Another problem is to provide an information providing system and an information providing method using a physical medium that can be surely and effectively called and confirmed even when a considerable amount of time has passed at the place. You can also.
  • the present invention assigns a node corresponding to an arbitrary object in the physical world, links the nodes with edges, and assigns arbitrary attributes to the nodes and the edges, respectively.
  • Another problem (fourth issue) is to provide an information providing system and an information providing method using a physical medium that can form a data structure having a structure corresponding to an expression composed of an object with two nodes and an edge. Problem).
  • an information providing system using a physical medium is an ID assigned to an object including attributes related to people, things, things, and locations, and identifies the object.
  • First storage means for causing a computer to realize a first storage function for storing a local ID, which is a unique identifier for storing, in a first storage area of a database in association with attribute information unique to the object, and information
  • the reader reads the local ID of the object by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal which is a computer device for browsing information
  • the local ID is associated with the information viewer, and the first ID of the database is stored.
  • Second storage means for causing a computer to realize a second storage function for storing in the second storage area; Based on the local ID stored in the storage area and the attribute information specific to the object stored in the first storage area and associated with the local ID, attribute information specific to the object related to the local ID is obtained.
  • First access means for causing a computer to realize a first access function that enables access to a web page for display.
  • the local ID is a node ID that uniquely identifies a node assigned to each object.
  • the second storage area is a node table that stores the node ID for each node.
  • the information providing system using the physical medium according to the present invention realizes a new node generation function and a node table update function based on the node ID reading operation with reference to the node table data.
  • Node management means creates a node table specific to the information viewer as a user and assigns a node ID to the node table when the information viewer first accesses and logs in to the information providing system. Store.
  • An information providing system using a physical medium is an ID assigned to an object including attributes related to people, things, things, and places, and is a unique ID for identifying the object.
  • a first storage means for causing a computer to realize a first storage function for storing a local ID, which is an identifier, in association with attribute information unique to the object in a first storage area of a database;
  • the local ID of the object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal that is a computer device for browsing, the local ID is associated with the information viewer and stored in the second storage area of the database.
  • Second storage means for causing a computer to realize a second storage function for storing; Based on the local ID stored in the second storage area and the attribute information unique to the object stored in the first storage area and associated with the local ID, unique to the object associated with the local ID
  • First access means for causing a computer to implement a first access function that enables access to a web page for displaying the attribute information.
  • the information viewer further reads the local ID of one object and stores the local ID of the one object in the second storage.
  • the Third storage means for causing a computer to realize a third storage function for storing link information representing a relationship with a local ID of another object in a third storage area is provided.
  • An information providing method using a physical medium is an ID assigned to an object including attributes related to people, things, things, and places, and is a unique ID for identifying the object.
  • a first storage procedure for causing a computer to execute a first storage process in which a local ID as an identifier is associated with attribute information unique to the object and stored in a first storage area of a database;
  • the local ID of the object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal that is a computer device for browsing, the local ID is associated with the information viewer and stored in the second storage area of the database.
  • a second storage procedure for causing the computer to execute a second storage process to be stored; and the second storage procedure stored in the second storage area A web page for displaying attribute information unique to the object associated with the local ID based on the local ID and attribute information unique to the object stored in the first storage area and associated with the local ID
  • the local ID is a node ID that uniquely identifies a node assigned to each object.
  • the second storage area is a node table that stores the node ID for each node.
  • the information providing method using the physical medium refers to the data of the node table, and based on the reading operation of the node ID, the new node generation process and the node table A node management procedure for realizing update processing is provided.
  • the node management procedure creates a node table unique to the information viewer as a user and assigns a node ID to the node table when the information viewer first accesses and logs in to the information providing system. Store.
  • An information providing method using a physical medium is an ID assigned to an object including attributes related to people, things, things, and places, and is a unique ID for identifying the object.
  • a first storage procedure for causing a computer to execute a first storage process in which a local ID as an identifier is associated with attribute information unique to the object and stored in a first storage area of a database;
  • the local ID of the object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal that is a computer device for browsing, the local ID is associated with the information viewer and stored in the second storage area of the database.
  • a second storage procedure for causing the computer to execute a second storage process to be stored; and the second storage procedure stored in the second storage area A web page for displaying attribute information unique to the object associated with the local ID based on the local ID and attribute information unique to the object stored in the first storage area and associated with the local ID
  • the information viewer further reads a local ID of one object and stores the local ID of the one object in the second storage.
  • various physical media having article properties (properties as articles) and object properties (properties as objects) such as merchandise and advertisement paper media.
  • predetermined information including a series of information having temporal and / or locational and / or contextual relevance using a display of a liquid crystal screen as a physical medium such as an information terminal device having a liquid crystal screen Information can be provided.
  • FIG. 1 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 1 of the present invention (which embodies the invention of the first aspect) by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 2 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a detailed configuration of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention by using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 3 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of a “user registration page” (available in the primary user system and the secondary user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is.
  • FIG. 1 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 1 of the present invention (which embodies the invention of the first aspect) by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 2 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a detailed configuration of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention by using
  • FIG. 4 illustrates an information exchange operation between the main user system and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 5 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of a “main information registration page” (available in the main user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 6 shows an example of the configuration of the “main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page” (corresponding to the main information registration page in FIG. 5) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing.
  • FIG. 5 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of a “main information registration page” (available in the main user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 6 shows an example of the configuration of the “main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page”
  • FIG. 7 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the main user process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 8 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of the URL issuing process following the main user process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 9 illustrates an information exchange operation between the slave user system and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 10 shows a “subordinate information registration page (detailed registration) as a first example of the subordinate information registration page (available in the subordinate user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 3 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of “version)”.
  • FIG. 11 shows an example of the configuration of the “subordinate information confirmation page (detailed registration version)” (corresponding to the subordinate information registration page in FIG. 10) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing.
  • FIG. 10 shows a “subordinate information registration page (detailed registration) as a first example of the subordinate information registration page (available in the subordinate user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 3 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of “version)”.
  • FIG. 11 shows an example of the configuration of the “subordinate information confirmation page (detailed
  • FIG. 12 illustrates an example of the configuration of a “subordinate information confirmation page (simple registration version)” as a second example of the subordinate information registration page of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. FIG. 13 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the slave user process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 14 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the normal approval routine (as one step of the secondary user processing in FIG. 12) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 15 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the deletion approval routine (as one step of the secondary user processing in FIG.
  • FIG. 16 illustrates an information exchange operation between the information viewer terminal and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 17 shows a configuration of a “guide page (detailed version)” as a first example of a guide page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example.
  • FIG. 16 illustrates an information exchange operation between the information viewer terminal and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 17 shows a configuration of a “guide page (detailed version)” as a first example of a guide page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example.
  • FIG. 18 shows a configuration of “guidance page (simplified version)” as a second example of the guidance page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example.
  • FIG. 19 is an explanatory diagram showing a first example of a bookmark display area in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. In this example, the location of the corresponding article is automatically displayed when a specific bookmark is selected and executed.
  • FIG. 19 is an explanatory diagram showing a first example of a bookmark display area in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. In this example, the location of the corresponding article is automatically displayed when a specific bookmark is selected and executed.
  • FIG. 20 is an explanatory diagram showing a second example of the bookmark display area in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is.
  • FIG. 21 shows the internal structure of the bookmark display area of the second example in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating.
  • FIG. 22 is an explanatory diagram showing a third example of the bookmark display area in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is.
  • FIG. 21 shows the internal structure of the bookmark display area of the second example in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing
  • FIG. 23 shows, for each date, when the bookmark display area in the “bookmark pane” of the browsing page (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention is displayed. It is explanatory drawing which shows the example in the case of displaying a browsing list automatically.
  • FIG. 24 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of bookmark processing (BM processing) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to Embodiment 1 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 25 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the detailed configuration of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 26 illustrates the information exchange operation between the main user system and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 27 illustrates an information exchange operation between the slave user system and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 28 illustrates an information exchange operation between an information viewer terminal and an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 27 illustrates an information exchange operation between the slave user system and the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention, and elements related to the information exchange operation. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 28 illustrates an information exchange operation between an information viewer terminal and an administrator system of an information providing system
  • FIG. 29 shows an example of a link structure (a tree structure between a physical medium ID as a parent node and a URL as a child node) created by the information providing system using the physical medium according to the first embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing shown.
  • FIG. 30 shows an example of a link structure (a network structure between a physical medium ID as a primary node and a URL as a secondary node) created by an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing shown.
  • FIG. 31 shows the link strength in the link structure created by the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention (in the network structure between the physical medium ID as the primary node and the URL as the secondary node).
  • FIG. 32 shows another link structure (network structure between a physical medium ID as a primary node and a URL as a secondary node) created by an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example.
  • FIG. 33 is a link for constructing the link structure of the information providing system using the physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention (network structure between the physical medium ID as the primary node and the URL as the secondary node). It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating the construction method (network construction method).
  • FIG. 32 shows another link structure (network structure between a physical medium ID as a primary node and a URL as a secondary node) created by an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example.
  • FIG. 33 is a link for constructing the link structure of the information providing system using the physical medium according to Embodiment 2 of the present invention (network structure between
  • FIG. 34 illustrates a specific example of links between nodes in the link structure (network structure) constructed by the link construction method (shown in FIG. 33) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for doing.
  • FIG. 35 shows one new node (URL node) linked to each of two existing nodes (NFC nodes) in the link structure (network structure) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating the change of the link strength between nodes at the time of adding.
  • FIG. 35 shows one new node (URL node) linked to each of two existing nodes (NFC nodes) in the link structure (network structure) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating the change of the link strength between nodes at the time of adding.
  • FIG. 36 shows two new nodes (URL nodes) respectively linked to the existing two nodes (NFC nodes) in the link structure (network structure) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating the change of the link strength between nodes at the time of adding.
  • FIG. 37 shows two existing nodes (URL nodes) linked to one existing node (NFC node) in the link structure (network structure) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing for demonstrating the process in the case of deleting the link of one of these nodes (URL node).
  • FIG. 38 schematically shows a detailed configuration of another example of an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention (particularly, another example of a system configuration related to link strength) by function blocks. It is explanatory drawing shown.
  • FIG. 39 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the link strength calculation processing according to another example of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 39 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps in the link strength calculation processing according to another example of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 44 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 3 of the present invention (which embodies the invention of the second aspect) by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 45 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a detailed configuration of an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention by function blocks.
  • FIG. 46 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of a “main information registration page” (available in the main user system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 47 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of an “advertisement information registration page (detailed information registration version)” (available in the advertiser system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention. It is.
  • FIG. 48 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of the configuration of “guidance page (detailed version)” (available on the information browsing terminal) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 49 is an explanatory diagram showing a first example (classification based on behavior and context) of the data classification method of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 48 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a configuration of an “advertisement information registration page (detailed information registration version)” (available in the advertiser system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 48 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of the
  • FIG. 50 is an explanatory diagram showing a second example (classification by situation) of the data classification method of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 51 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of a bookmark browsing display screen according to a second example of the data classification method of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 52 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of an advertising medium sales screen for each period using the second example of the data classification method of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 53 is an explanatory diagram showing an example of the relationship between the advertising space of the information providing system using the physical medium according to Embodiment 3 of the present invention and individual advertisements.
  • FIG. 54 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a detailed configuration of an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the fourth embodiment of the present invention by function blocks.
  • FIG. 55 is an explanatory view schematically showing an example of an outdoor signboard as a physical medium of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 5 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 56 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of a signboard as a physical medium of the information providing system using the physical medium according to Embodiment 6 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 57 is an explanatory view schematically showing an example of a display board as a physical medium of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 7 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 58 is an explanatory view schematically showing an example of the advertising medium sales screen after reading the ID on the display board of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the seventh embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 59 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a first specific example (net shop cooperation type information providing system) of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention by using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 60 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing, by functional blocks, an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 61 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of assigning a physical ID of an information providing system (net shop cooperation type information providing system) using a physical medium according to a first specific example of the eighth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 62 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of assigning a physical ID of an information providing system (information guide cooperation type information providing system) using a physical medium according to a second specific example of the eighth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 63 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing bookmark processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 64 is an explanatory view schematically showing browsing processing after bookmark registration in the information providing system using the physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 65 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of a time-series display update process when browsing information related to a specific bookmark in the browsing process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention. is there.
  • FIG. 66 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 9 of the present invention, using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 67 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing various processes (my memory process and memory service process) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 68 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing my memory processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 69 is an explanatory view schematically showing the memory service processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 70 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a part of the data structure of the management database of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 71 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing another part of the data structure of the management database of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention, using an ER diagram.
  • FIG. 72 is an explanatory view schematically showing memory registration processing of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 9 of the present invention, using functional blocks and the like.
  • FIG. 73 is an explanatory diagram for schematically explaining my memory processing of the information providing system using a physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention on the processing screen.
  • FIG. 74 is an explanatory diagram for schematically explaining the memory service processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention on the processing screen.
  • FIG. 75 is an explanatory diagram for schematically explaining the memory creation processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention on the processing screen.
  • FIG. 76 is an explanatory diagram for schematically explaining the calendar process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention on the processing screen (by year).
  • FIG. 77 is an explanatory diagram for schematically explaining the calendar process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention on a processing screen (monthly).
  • FIG. 78 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of the first read process in the memory of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 79 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of post-login processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 80 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of my memory processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 81 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of the memory service process (memory creation process) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 82 is a flowchart showing a series of information processing steps of the memory service process (memory management process) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 83 is a diagram for explaining an example of forming a data structure with a subject / predicate / object relationship in the link structure (network structure) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the ninth embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing.
  • FIG. 84 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention, using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 85 shows the detailed configuration of the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention (particularly, the configuration of the link strength calculation means and the content management as a partial module of the main information registration management means)
  • FIG. 3 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a configuration of (editing) means by functional blocks.
  • FIG. 86 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a memory registration process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention, using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 87 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the story cooperation process of the information providing system (story cooperation type information providing system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 88 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a story (historical information) linkage process of an information providing system (an example of a story linkage type information providing system) using a physical medium according to Embodiment 10 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 89 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the story (traditional story information such as folktale) linkage processing of the information providing system (another example of the story linkage type information providing system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 90 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a link process between stories using a stub for the story linkage process of the information providing system (story linked information providing system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention. It is.
  • FIG. 91 is a set of two sheets as a link process between stories using a stub for the story linkage process of the information providing system (story linked information providing system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows roughly an example in the case of performing the link process (cooperation process) using (a pair of) stubs used as the relationship between a node and an edge.
  • FIG. 91 is a set of two sheets as a link process between stories using a stub for the story linkage process of the information providing system (story linked information providing system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • It is explanatory drawing which shows roughly an example in the case of performing the link process (cooperation process)
  • FIG. 92 shows a set of two links as a linking process between stubs for a story linkage process in the information provision system (story linkage type information provision system) using a physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows roughly an example (in the aspect which simplified FIG. 91) in the case of performing the link process (cooperation process) using (a pair of) stub which becomes.
  • FIG. 93 is a link process between stories using stubs for story linkage processing in the information provision system (story cooperation type information provision system) using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 94 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of a stub for story linkage processing of an information providing system (story linked information providing system) using a physical medium according to Embodiment 10 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 95 is a set of two sheets as an example of a stub for story cooperation processing of an information provision system (story cooperation type information provision system) using a physical medium according to Embodiment 10 of the present invention ( It is explanatory drawing which shows roughly a pair of digital stub (a stub as digital information displayed on the display screen etc. of a portable terminal device).
  • FIG. 96 is a diagram schematically showing a link process between stories using a digital stub (shown in FIG. 95) in the information providing system (story-linked information providing system) using a physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. FIG. 97 is a digital stub having two or more options as an example of a stub for story linkage processing of an information providing system (story linked information providing system) using a physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention. It is explanatory drawing which shows an example of. FIG.
  • FIG. 98 is a diagram schematically showing a story (creative story information such as novel) linkage processing of another example (story linkage generation type information provision system) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. FIG. 99 is an explanatory diagram for explaining a hub type network structure as an example (another example) of a link structure (network structure) of an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 10 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 100 is an explanatory diagram for explaining the link application / approval processing of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 101 is a series of information processing in the user processing (registration processing of user information corresponding to the main user information processing in FIG.
  • FIG. 102 shows a mutual link process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention (a process corresponding to the slave user process in FIG. 13). It is a flowchart which shows a series of information processing steps in the information registration process including the link application for the applicant who applies for a link to a node.
  • FIG. 103 shows a normal approval routine (a routine corresponding to the normal approval routine in FIG. 14) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention (as a step of the mutual link process in FIG. 102).
  • FIG. 104 shows a deletion approval routine (a routine corresponding to the deletion approval routine in FIG. 15) of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention (as a step of the mutual link process in FIG. 102). It is a flowchart which shows a series of information processing steps.
  • FIG. 105 shows a series of information processing steps in the link strength calculation processing (processing corresponding to the link strength calculation processing in FIG. 39) by the administrator system of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention. It is a flowchart.
  • FIG. 106 shows a link structure (a link structure corresponding to the link structure of FIG.
  • FIG. 31 is between a pair of nodes (via an edge) created by the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention.
  • FIG. 108 is an explanatory diagram showing an information card used in an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 11 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 109 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the overall configuration of an information providing system using a physical medium according to another example of the tenth embodiment of the present invention using functional blocks.
  • FIG. 110 is a detailed configuration of an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to another example of the tenth embodiment of the present invention (particularly, a configuration of link strength calculation / management means and a partial module of information registration management means)
  • FIG. 2 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing a configuration of content management (editing) means as functional blocks.
  • FIG. 111 shows a detailed configuration of an administrator system of an information providing system using a physical medium according to the twelfth embodiment of the present invention (particularly, a configuration of link strength calculation / management means and a link as a partial module of information registration management means).
  • FIG. 4 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing functional blocks of the configuration of condition management / determination means and content extraction / display means.
  • FIG. 112 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of a network structure with nodes and edges generated by an information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 12 of the present invention.
  • FIG. 113 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing an example of another network structure with nodes and edges generated by the information providing system using the physical medium according to the twelfth embodiment of the present invention.
  • the information providing system may include an administrator system (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “administrator SYS”) 100 and a main user system (hereinafter referred to as “main user SYS”). 200), a secondary user system (hereinafter also referred to as "secondary user SYS") 300, a physical medium providing place 400, an information viewer terminal 500, and a Web server 600.
  • administrator SYS an administrator system
  • main user system hereinafter referred to as “main user SYS”
  • secondary user system hereinafter also referred to as "secondary user SYS”
  • the administrator system 100 is a system owned and managed by an administrator (such as a management company) that manages the information providing system.
  • the main user system 200 is a system owned and managed by a main user who is the main user of the information providing system.
  • the owner of an actual store that displays a specific actual product hereinafter sometimes referred to as “actual product” in the sense of contrasting with a product virtually displayed on the net
  • responsible persons such as managers and operators (hereinafter referred to as “store managers”) are users of the main user system 200 (that is, main users), but content related to specific products and services (hereinafter referred to as “main users”).
  • the secondary user system 300 is a system owned and managed by a secondary user who is a secondary user of the information providing system.
  • the same product / service hereinafter simply referred to as “the same product”
  • the related product / service that is the same as the product / service published in the article of the main user's actual store or information printed matter.
  • a business owner of a store handling services (hereinafter simply referred to as “related product”) (including a virtual store in addition to a physical store) or an address in the vicinity of the physical store of the main user, and the same product
  • the sales owner of a store or the like that provides a product or service associated with the related product is a user (that is, a secondary user) of the secondary user system 300.
  • the physical medium providing place 400 is a case where the main user installs an information printed matter in which the article is posted in the actual store when the actual product is displayed in the actual store or the information installation location. This is the place where the information is installed.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 sets information on a person who has actually contacted the actual product in the actual store of the main user (typically, a final consumer who purchases the actual product, etc.) and information on the main user.
  • An information terminal device such as a smartphone owned by a person who has actually contacted an article of information printed matter at a place (typically, a final consumer who viewed the article of the printed matter of information), and those persons (hereinafter, It is simply an information terminal device used by an “information viewer”.
  • the primary user, the secondary user, and the information viewer are, of course, not fixed to their respective roles, but can have other roles, for example,
  • a primary user related to specific primary information becomes a secondary user for a primary user related to other primary information, or a primary user related to specific primary information
  • the secondary user can be a primary user with respect to its own primary information.
  • the information viewer can be a main user or a sub user.
  • the main user system 200, the sub user system 300, and the information viewer terminal 500 are also computer devices, and have different roles (the main user system 200 is the sub user system 300). Etc.) can also be used.
  • the information providing system can be configured by a general client server system or a cloud computing system.
  • the information providing system uses the administrator system 100 as a service provider side system (for example, a service provider side system using IaaS, PaaS, SaaS, etc. in cloud computing, or a client / server system).
  • the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300 are each a service user side system (for example, a cloud client or a client / server system as a service user side system in cloud computing).
  • Client device The administrator system 100 is a system on the service provider side who has management authority over the entire information providing system.
  • the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300 are systems on the service user side who are responsible for a part of the information processing operation of the information providing system under the management of the administrator system 100.
  • the administrator system 100 includes hardware resources (CPU, ROM, RAM, HDD, network device, I / O, etc.) and software resources (server 0S, middleware, DBMS, API) of the computer device.
  • hardware resources CPU, ROM, RAM, HDD, network device, I / O, etc.
  • software resources server 0S, middleware, DBMS, API
  • a unique function as the administrator system 100 is realized by using various applications on the server side.
  • the main user system 200 and the sub user system 300 are respectively a hardware resource (CPU, ROM, RAM, HDD, network device, I / O, etc.) and a software resource (0S, browser) of the computer device.
  • the unique functions of the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300 are realized using various applications on the client side.
  • the administrator system 100, the primary user system 200, and the secondary user system 300 use the hardware resources and software resources of the computer device to realize unique functions and cooperate with each other.
  • various function realizing means for realizing various functions of the information providing system described later are configured.
  • the details of the function realizing means of the administrator system 100 and the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300 will be described later.
  • the administrator system 100 is configured by a computer device that functions as a so-called server device
  • the main user system 200 and the secondary user system 300 are personal computer devices (functions as so-called client devices).
  • the computer device may be configured by other types of computer devices such as a mobile terminal device such as a tablet.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 is typically a computer device including a smartphone as a mobile terminal device, a tablet as a mobile terminal device, and the like, using predetermined hardware resources and software resources, A function as an information browser terminal 500 to be described later is realized.
  • the Web server 600 is a computer device that implements a known web server function using predetermined hardware resources and software resources.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 forms a client-side system in the information providing system, like the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300.
  • a function for the main user system 200 and the sub user system 300 to perform a process of exchanging a predetermined type of information (main information and sub information described later) with the administrator system 100, respectively.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 is configured to realize a function of browsing the content of a predetermined guide page via the Web server 600.
  • the guide page is based on the main information and the sub information stored by the main user system 200 and the sub user system 300 via the administrator system 100.
  • This is a web page created by processing the system 100 to be a predetermined content, and is information that the administrator system 100 uploads and stores to a Web server.
  • the Web server 600 can be provided inside the administrator system as a part of the administrator system 100, for example. However, the Web server 600 is provided outside the administrator system 100 to provide a network environment such as the administrator system 100 and the Internet. It is also possible to configure such that predetermined information is exchanged. In FIG.
  • the Web server 600 is illustrated as a system separate from the administrator system 100, but in reality, as described above, the Web server 600 is provided inside the administrator system 100 or the administrator It is provided outside the system 100 so as to be able to communicate with the administrator system 100, and exhibits a predetermined web server function under the management of the administrator system 100.
  • the information providing system cooperates with network resources such as a mobile phone network and the Internet, so that the management system 100 and the primary user system 200 and the management system 100 and the secondary user system 300 are connected. The main information and sub information transfer processing is performed. In addition, this information providing system cooperates with a network resource such as a mobile phone network or the Internet, thereby exchanging information between the information viewer terminal 500 and the Web server 600 (that is, from the information viewer terminal 500). Information transmission / reception operations such as transmission of a request to the Web server 600 and transmission of the guide page from the Web server 600 to the information viewer terminal 500 corresponding to the request are executed.
  • the primary user system 200, the secondary user system 300, and the information viewer terminal 500 each have an Internet connection environment, and the administrator system 100 and the administrator system 100 via a network including the Internet by a browser, Information is exchanged with the Web server 600.
  • the information providing system includes an administrator system, and the administrator system is information between the primary user system, the secondary user system, and / or the information viewer terminal. Based on the exchange, the following first to twelfth processes / procedures (all or some of them) are executed by the computer apparatus or computer system.
  • (1) A unique identifier for identifying a specific object belonging to a specific location is readable from the outside to the specific object via the ID storage medium, and is stored in the database.
  • Process / procedure (ID assignment storage process / procedure).
  • the identifier corresponds to an “article ID” described later including an NFC-ID, a barcode, or the like, or corresponds to an ID corresponding to the article ID in a “node ID” described later.
  • this identifier is referred to as “local ID”.
  • the local ID as the identifier is typically given in response to a request from an owner (main user) of a specific target object.
  • the specific object is, for example, (a) a commodity for sale such as a specific commodity displayed at a store located at a specific address or an article for non-trading purposes.
  • Information display object such as a building or the like located at a specific address, or a printed matter such as a poster provided on the installation (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “information display object”) Or a content display field such as an advertisement display field provided in a manner that partitions the information display object (hereinafter, also referred to as “information display field”), or (c) a specific address or a specific Advertisement display objects (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “advertisement display objects”) such as outdoor signboards and indoor signboards located at a place, or a plurality of advertisement displays provided in a manner to partition the advertisement display objects Column (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “advertising display column”) .), Etc.
  • the local ID is given to the object via a predetermined ID medium (that is, by storing in the ID medium and storing it).
  • a predetermined ID medium can typically be any ID medium as long as ID can be stored, such as NFC tag, barcode (one-dimensional barcode or two-dimensional barcode), RF-ID tag, etc. .
  • Second process / procedure main information storage process / procedure for storing main information, which is information specific to the specific location and / or specific object, in the database in association with the local ID of the object ).
  • the main information is attribute information of the specific object.
  • article information of the specific article if the article is a commodity, for example, a commodity of the specific commodity Information.
  • the article information for example, a combination of an article name of a specific article and its attribute (when the article is a commodity, for example, a brief description of the commodity name and the commodity, or a combination of the commodity name and the commodity price)
  • main link information which is link information to a guide page that is a web page having the main information as content, is associated with the local ID of the object related to the main information.
  • Third processing / procedure to be stored in the database main information link information storage processing / procedure).
  • the main ID associated with the local ID is read.
  • 4th process / procedure main information output process which outputs the guide page of the main information which is the link destination of the main link information to the computer apparatus for browsing information in a mode that can be browsed / listened based on the link information /procedure).
  • the guide page is typically a web page stored in a web server. In this case, the guide page is provided via a network typified by the Internet (via network communication). External information acquisition processing).
  • the guide page typically uses the function of a web browser mounted on a computer device such as a smartphone as a device for displaying the guide page, and the computer device Can be displayed on the display device (display).
  • the guide page can be provided by storing the main information in the ID medium together with the local ID of the object related to the main information.
  • the guidance page stores the main information together with the local ID of the object related to the main information in the data storage area of the NFC tag as the ID medium, or the two-dimensional barcode as the ID medium. It can also be provided via the ID medium by writing it in the data storage area (internal information acquisition process via the ID medium).
  • the guidance page uses the function of a web browser implemented on a computer device that displays the guidance page, as in the case of external information acquisition processing via network communication. Can be displayed on the display device of the computer device.
  • the guide page may be a web page newly created when the main information is registered, or may be a web page using (or edited) an existing web page as it is.
  • the main link information is typically a URL used as an identifier for uniquely identifying a web page, and is a URL assigned to the guide page (hereinafter referred to as the guide page). In the sense of a URL that uniquely identifies the main information to be posted, it may be referred to as “main URL”).
  • the browsing / listening information unique information acquired corresponding to browsing / listening of the main information guide page (hereinafter, referred to as “viewing / listening information”). Is stored in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object related to the browsing / listening (viewing / listening information storage processing / procedure).
  • viewing / listening information As the browsing / listening information, the time when the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reading unit is acquired as the browsing / listening time of the guide page of the main information related to the object. Then, a process / procedure 5-1 for storing in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object (browsing / listening time storage process / procedure).
  • the browsing / listening time of the guide page substantially coincides with the time when the local ID is read, it can be used in the subsequent processing by equating it with the reading time of the local ID of a specific object. it can. (5-2)
  • the browsing / listening information the number of times the guide page related to the main information about the specific object is browsed / listened in the fourth process / procedure (that is, the number of accesses by the information processing terminal) 5-1 is stored in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object (access count information storage process / procedure).
  • the browsing / listening information the location information of the information viewer terminal when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of the specific object in the fourth process / procedure
  • the position information of the specific object (hereinafter also referred to as “object position information”)
  • the fifth process / procedure (object position information) stored in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object Storage process / procedure).
  • the position information of the information processing terminal can be typically acquired by using a position information acquisition function such as GPS installed in the information viewer terminal.
  • the position information of the information processing terminal when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of the specific object matches the position information of the specific object itself, the position of the specific object in the subsequent processing It can be used as information (object position information).
  • terminal identification information Information for identifying the information viewer terminal that has browsed / listened to the main information guide page related to the specific object in the fourth process / procedure (hereinafter referred to as the browsing / listening information) , Or “terminal identification information”), or information for identifying an information viewer who has browsed / listened to the main information guide page related to a specific object in the fourth process / procedure (hereinafter referred to as “terminal identification information”).
  • “Browser identification information” is stored in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object related to the browsing / listening (viewer / terminal identification information) Storage process / procedure).
  • the terminal identification information of the information viewer terminal includes a terminal ID transmitted from the information viewer terminal when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of the specific object.
  • the administrator system can communicate with the information viewer terminal by setting the authority to provide the information viewer terminal authority.
  • the terminal ID of the information viewer terminal can be acquired.
  • user information is registered in advance in the administrator system (member registration) by the information viewer, and the user ID (user ID) for the administrator system (and usually associated with the user ID).
  • the password when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of a specific object, it consists of the user ID transmitted from the information viewer terminal.
  • the sub information is, for example, basic information in product information of a complementary product of a specific product as a specific object, or store information of a specific store that handles a specific product as a specific object.
  • sub link information which is link information to a sub information detailed page, which is a web page having detailed information about the sub information as content, is an object related to the main information.
  • the sub information detail page is a web page stored in a web server, and is provided via a network typified by the Internet.
  • the sub information detail page is displayed on the display device (display) of the computer device using the function of the web browser mounted on the computer device such as a smartphone.
  • the sub information detail page may be a web page newly created at the time of sub information registration, or may be a web page using (or edited) an existing web page as it is.
  • the slave link information is typically a URL that is an identifier for uniquely specifying the slave information detail page as a web page (hereinafter referred to as a URL that uniquely specifies slave information). In this sense, there is a link information to “subordinate URL”). For example, link information using a hyperlink in HTML language can be used.
  • a bookmark means for realizing a management function of bookmark information including link information is provided, and the information viewer terminal identifies a specific object related to main information of an arbitrary guide page browsed / listened in the past.
  • a tenth process / procedure for enabling bookmarking based on the local ID of the object (bookmark function providing process / procedure).
  • the bookmark means can be embodied as a GUI having the same basic configuration as a bookmark manager implemented as a function of a general web browser.
  • the bookmark manager of the conventional web browser is configured to store the URL of a specific web page desired by the user, typically linked to the title of the web page, and select and execute the title ( The web page can be accessed via the URL.
  • a bookmark manager of a conventional web browser allows a user to quickly access a specific web page by bookmarking it (by bookmarking).
  • the bookmark means of the present invention is not mainly intended for access to a guide page as a web page (of course, although a function for accessing the guide page is usually provided), it relates to the main information of the guide page.
  • the main information of the specific article or representative information of the main information, hereinafter sometimes referred to as “representative main information”. It is the structure which enables quick access to.
  • the bookmark means converts the main URL as the main link information of the main information guide page of a specific article to be bookmarked into a title (typically, a product name or an article) that is representative main information of the specific article.
  • a title typically, a product name or an article
  • name of object such as name is linked and memorized, so that it is possible to quickly access the guidance page (up to here, the same function as normal bookmark manager), but other than this function
  • the position information and the time information in the browsing / listening information can be referred to as representative main information of the specific article, and a specific function can be exhibited. It has a configuration.
  • the bookmark means interface when displaying the bookmarked specific article as a list, it is configured to display the time information in chronological order or the location of the specific article. Can be configured to display (as address information or map information).
  • the browser function (book manager function) of the information viewer terminal can be used.
  • Each function such as a bookmark access function is provided.
  • it can be implemented as a partial function of the guide page.
  • the location of the specific object related to the guide page and the time when the local ID of the object is actually read can be acquired.
  • a bookmark is attached to a specific object itself that is a real presence in a physical media provider outside the web. By doing so, it is possible to acquire information on the location and access time, which is information on the object itself.
  • the bookmark title is, for example, a title used in a bookmark such as an icon (Favicon) or a page title for linking to the guide page, and is typically a page title described by a title element.
  • a title can be a word or word described with an arbitrary element.
  • this title may be referred to as “bookmark title”.
  • the bookmark means can be mounted on a predetermined browsing web page (hereinafter referred to as “browsing page”). That is, the bookmark means can be implemented as a client-side program such as a script or as link information that can call a server-side program. Further, the browsing page can be composed of the guide page, or can be composed of a browse page that is a web page different from the guide page. (11) When the information viewer terminal accesses the browsing page, the bookmark title bookmarked by the information viewer terminal is displayed on the browsing page in which the bookmark means is mounted, and the bookmark is associated with the bookmark title.
  • An eleventh process / procedure for displaying browsing / listening information about a specific article related to the bookmark title (bookmark related information display process / procedure).
  • the information viewer terminal is based on the terminal identification information of the information viewer terminal or regardless of the terminal identification information of the information viewer terminal.
  • the bookmark information by the information viewer terminal or the bookmark information by the user ID By specifying the bookmark information by the information viewer terminal or the bookmark information by the user ID based on the user ID in the registered information of the user, for example, browsing by clicking the BM icon for bookmark operation
  • Bookmark titles bookmarked by the information viewer terminal are typically displayed as a list on a bookmark manager or the like as a bookmark display area displayed on the page, and all or one of the displayed bookmark titles is displayed.
  • Bookmarks for parts or only selected items In association with the title, browsing / listening information (stored in the fifth process / procedure) about a specific article related to the bookmark title can be displayed.
  • the BM related information display process is executed through the local ID of the specific article, and is executed by extracting browsing / listening information associated with the local ID associated with the URL of the bookmarked guide page. . (11-2) Further, in the eleventh process / procedure, the browsing / listening information (hereinafter referred to as “BM related information”) displayed in association with the bookmark is the information about the specific article related to the bookmark title (the above-mentioned It consists of the browsing / listening time (stored in the fifth process / procedure) and the object position information.
  • a browsing history means for realizing a browsing history function including link information is provided, and a specific object related to main information of an arbitrary guide page browsed / listened to by the information viewer terminal is specified as the specific object.
  • a twelfth process / procedure that enables browsing based on the local ID viewing history function providing process / procedure).
  • the main information output means is typically configured to execute a processing operation in which ID reading is an event and main information is displayed when the event occurs.
  • the geography / address information storage process is typically a process at the time of registration of main information, but when accessing from the information viewer terminal, the location information of the information viewer terminal may be acquired and converted into an address as geographic information. Is possible.
  • the main information related information output means can display only the total number of sub information as an output mode of sub information, but is configured to display a list of sub information by mouse over the total number. Is done. In other words, the sub information is finally referred to via the total number.
  • the main information related information output means is preferably statistical information although the access history information is the total number of accesses in the simplest case.
  • the information providing system of the present invention can be embodied as the following embodiment.
  • the main information is product information of a specific product at a specific location
  • the sub information is a store related to the product (handles the product) or a complementary product of the product
  • (Interest-oriented) (Embodiment 3) Advertising information of products whose main information is a specific real estate (building or structure) at a specific location and whose subordinate information is related to the location information of the real estate (targeting customers at that location) .
  • BM business model
  • the identifier (local ID) given to the specific object means an ID unique to the specific object associated with the specific location and specific time information (or the specific ID). This is referred to as “local ID” in the sense of location information of a specific place to which the object belongs or ID having relevance to the place information).
  • the local ID corresponds to a specific product as an article or a specific information printed article as an article in a one-to-one relationship. Therefore, it is referred to as “article ID” in the sense that it is issued in a one-to-one relationship with a specific “article”.
  • time means “time” as a computer term (not “time” in the normal sense), and means time information specifying the date and time. .
  • terminal identification information that can be used differs depending on the type of OS (operating system), but among the main OSs, the first OS is IdentifierForVendor. (IDFV) and AdvertisingIdentifier, and the second OS has a device ID (IMED / MEID / ESN), serial number, and AdvertisingID.
  • the information providing system uses various physical media having article properties and object properties such as products, and the location / object specific information as the physical medium specific information unique to the physical medium, the physical medium Construct information systems and information networks centered on physical media, consisting of location / object-related information as physical media-related information related to, and useful information provision services that utilize the physical properties and physical properties of physical media Can be built.
  • the present information providing system associates the object location information, which is the location information of the specific location and / or the specific object, with the local ID. It is also possible to cause the computer apparatus or computer system to execute the process / procedure stored in the computer. In this way, in addition to the above-mentioned specific effects, this information providing system uses various physical media having article properties and object properties such as products, and the main information and physical media as the physical media specific information In addition to the sub information as the related information, the physical information is not related to the physical medium but includes information specific to geographical information and position information where the physical medium is arranged or object position information as related physical medium position information.
  • the local ID itself consists of information for identifying a specific object (unique identification information), and does not have position information of the location where the specific object is located, but the specific object belongs (or is located)
  • the location information of a specific place is stored in a database in association with the local ID, or when the local ID of a specific object is read by the ID reading means of the computer device for browsing information, Using the position information acquisition function of the computer device (for example, the position information acquisition function by the GPS receiver built in the computer device for browsing the information), the position information (for example, latitude and Longitude), and the position information is stored in the database in association with the local ID. It is possible to run.
  • the information providing system reads the local information of the specific object by the ID reading unit of the computer device for browsing information, thereby obtaining the main information.
  • the storage location information of the main information for example, URL on the Internet
  • the process / procedure of storing can be executed by a computer device or computer system. In this way, in addition to the above-mentioned specific effects, the present information providing system can quickly and easily call up any main information that has been browsed / listened before through the information browsing computer apparatus.
  • the physical medium providing place 400 that is indispensable for configuring the information providing system will be described in more detail.
  • the physical medium providing place 400 is a place having specific geographical information or position information, that is, an address, a store name, or geographical coordinates such as a combination of latitude and longitude. It is a place that is uniquely specified and is a place where a specific physical medium is provided or presented to the outside by exhibiting, displaying, selling, or the like.
  • the physical medium providing place 400 is an actual store such as a restaurant or an article store that exists in a specific place, and as a physical medium, a product 410A composed of various actual products such as liquor and watches, And / or a place where various information printed matter 410B such as a poster, a flyer, a pamphlet, a catalog or the like on which an article relating to a specific product / service is posted is provided or presented.
  • a product 410A any product that exists or is provided or presented in the future is a target, and not only a product to be sold at a store but also a post-sale product (for example, purchased by the store) ) Products that include products that are displayed in the store.
  • product in the present application document, it may be used to mean a product in a broad sense that includes services that are intangible goods in addition to goods in a narrow sense that are tangible goods, depending on the context. Only when it is unclear whether it is a product in a broad sense or a product in a narrow sense, it is clearly indicated as “a product in a broad sense” or “a product in a narrow sense” and its distinction from the context. When it is clear, the distinction is not clearly indicated.
  • the information printed matter 410B any information printed matter existing or provided in the future is an object. Further, in the present application documents, the term “article” may be used as a concept term encompassing these products 410A and printed information 410B.
  • physical media that can be used for the present information providing system with the local ID are physical advertisement media such as signboards, and buildings or structures such as houses, in addition to the articles. Therefore, the term “object” is used to include physical media other than such articles.
  • the term “provide” in the present application document may be used to have a meaning of “presentation” in addition to a general meaning of “provide”.
  • the product 410A which is a product in a narrow sense
  • an article ID medium 411 as a local ID medium is attached and attached to the product 410A so that it can be read from the outside.
  • the article ID medium 411 provides the article ID as a local ID that is a unique ID (identifier) such as an NFC tag, an RFID tag, or a barcode (one-dimensional barcode or two-dimensional barcode). It consists of an arbitrary ID providing medium that is stored in association with a specific product 410A that is a unique identification target in the system and is provided so as to be readable from the outside.
  • the article ID medium 411 is attached to a package, a container, a label, or the like of a specific product 411A displayed at a specific store, and uniquely identifies the specific product (article). The ID is provided so that it can be read from the outside. Then, the article ID medium 411 is associated with the specific product 410A in a one-to-one relationship by being attached to the specific product 410A.
  • the article ID medium 411 is attached to the specific product 410A as described above, thereby associating a specific product ID with the specific product 410A, and the product information of the specific product 410A as described above.
  • the item ID can be associated with a specific physical store where the specific product 410A is provided.
  • the attribute of the actual store to which the specific product 410A belongs (contact information such as store address, store name, telephone number, store photo, etc.)
  • Store information such as a store image of the store, map information around the store, etc.) in association with the product ID of the product ID medium 411 and stored in a storage area such as a predetermined database so that it can be acquired from the outside.
  • the specific article 410A to which the particular article 410A belongs via the particular article 410A associated with the article ID of the article ID medium 411
  • Store information of a real store can be acquired.
  • the geographical information (address, etc.) of the physical medium providing place 400 such as an actual store to which the specific product 410A associated with the article ID medium 411 belongs is, for example, a portable terminal device such as a smartphone incorporating a GPS receiver.
  • a portable terminal device such as a smartphone incorporating a GPS receiver.
  • it can be easily obtained by mounting the map API on the portable terminal device. That is, an ID reading means (for example, an NFC reader, an RFID reader, a barcode reader, etc.) that realizes a reading function of the article ID medium 411 is mounted on a mobile terminal device having a GPS receiver, and a map API is mounted.
  • an ID reading means for example, an NFC reader, an RFID reader, a barcode reader, etc.
  • the product ID of the product ID medium 411 of the product 410A is acquired, and the product information of the specific product 410A associated with the product ID is acquired.
  • the geographical location information latitude and longitude as the current location of the mobile terminal device
  • the location information / address conversion function of the map API By converting the geographical location information (latitude and longitude) into the corresponding address by reverse geocoding function) Of geographic information of the actual store that particular product 410A that is associated belongs to the article ID (ie, address) can be obtained.
  • the geographical information of the actual store is acquired in a manner associated with the article ID of the specific product 410A, and the geographical information of the actual store is displayed together with the product information of the product 410A. It is possible to perform processing using. Note that the actual store information acquisition process (particularly, geographic information acquisition process) using such an article ID medium 411 will be described in detail later.
  • the printed information 410B includes posters, flyers, pamphlets, catalogs, and the like that are displayed, installed, and distributed in a specific store or house, and a corresponding area of the specific location (for example, content display of the specific location of the poster)
  • a specific article is printed in a column or a content display column of a specific part of a cover page of a pamphlet).
  • the specific article is, for example, an article such as an introduction column that introduces a specific product (a product in a narrow sense) or a specific service, and is displayed as article 1,..., Article n in FIG. Has been.
  • article ID media 411a to 411n are respectively located in the vicinity of the specific article (article 1 to article n) of the information printed matter 410B (right side portion in FIG. 1). It is attached by printing or sticking (sticker or tag sticking).
  • each of the article ID media 411a to 411n has the same configuration as that of the article ID medium 411 for the product 410A, and uniquely identifies a specific product or service related to a specific article of the specific information printed matter 411B.
  • An article ID as a local ID for identification (similar to the article ID of the article ID medium 411) is provided so as to be readable from the outside. Then, the article ID media 411a to 411n are associated with a specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B, and are associated with the specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B in a one-to-one relationship.
  • the specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B is composed of, for example, a description column (product name, product image, product price, etc.) of a specific product (similar to the specific product 410A) or a specific service.
  • the specific information printed matter 410B provided with the article ID media 411a to 411n can be an NFC smart poster.
  • the article ID media 411a to 411n are attached in a one-to-one relationship with the posted contents of the NFC smart poster as a specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B.
  • the posting content of the NFC smart poster is a single content
  • one item ID medium 411a to 411n is attached to the NFC smart poster
  • the posting content of the NFC smart poster is composed of a plurality of contents
  • the article ID media 411a to 411n are respectively attached to the plurality of contents of the NFC smart poster in a one-to-one relationship.
  • Product / service related information can be acquired. Note that the product / service related information acquisition processing using such product ID media 411a to 411n is the same processing as the product information acquisition processing related to the product 410A, and is therefore combined with the description of the product information acquisition processing related to the product 410A. This will be described in detail later.
  • the article ID media 411a to 411n are attached to correspond to a specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B, thereby associating the article ID with the specific article of the information printed matter 410B.
  • the product ID can be associated with the product / service information such as the product or service published in the specific article of the specific information printed matter 410B as in the case of the product 410A. It can also be associated with a physical medium providing place 400 such as a specific actual store or house where a specific information printed matter 411B on which a specific article is posted is installed.
  • the geographical information (address, etc.) of the physical medium providing place 400 of the physical store or the like to which the specific information printed material 410B associated with the article ID media 411a to 411n belongs (that is, the actual store or the like where the information printed material 410B is installed). ) Can be obtained in the same manner as in the case of the product 410A.
  • a service name of a specific service or a combination of a service name and a brief description is described, and in the information printed matter 410B, an article ID of the specific service is provided in the vicinity of the specific article.
  • the article ID media 411a to 411n are stored.
  • a specific menu item for example, a specific dish name or a combination of a specific dish name and its dish photo
  • article ID media 411a to 411n having a corresponding article ID are attached.
  • the physical media 411a to 411n corresponding to the product ID corresponding to a specific service constituting a part of the product in a broad sense are transmitted via the information printed matter 410B as the product (and corresponding to the specific article).
  • the information linkage target is a service
  • An article ID medium can be indirectly attached.
  • the product ID is provided on the product ID medium 411 attached to the packaging, container, label, or the like of the specific product 411A displayed at a specific store, and uniquely identifies the specific product (article).
  • the configuration of the article ID may be a configuration using an ID system unique to the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n according to the type of the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n.
  • the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n can be constituted by NFC tags.
  • the article ID can be constituted by using an ID system used in the NFC technology.
  • the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n can be constituted by a two-dimensional barcode.
  • the article ID is constituted by using an ID system used in the two-dimensional barcode C technique. Can do.
  • the information providing system provides information about a specific article using the article ID configured as described above, and performs the following operation with the following configuration (that is, a computer device).
  • the following processing is executed using the following function realization means).
  • the administrator system 100 responds to a request from the main user system 200, and an article ID (that is, a local ID) unique to an article (that is, a specific object) of the physical medium providing place 400 related to the main user. Is attached. (Article ID assignment processing by article ID management means) Along with the article ID assigning process, the administrator system 100 stores the main information related to the specific article in a predetermined storage unit in association with the article ID. (Main information storage processing by main information management means) Further, in response to a request from the secondary user system 300, the administrator system 100 stores the secondary information related to the primary information related to the specific article in a predetermined storage unit in association with the article ID of the specific article. To do.
  • the administrator system 100 stores an arbitrary number of sub information in association with one main information, but counts (counts) the number of sub information (the number of sub information links) associated with the one main information.
  • the latest count result (latest sub information link number) is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the main information, and the sub information link number for the main information is updated in real time.
  • the administrator system 100 displays the main information of the specific article and the sub information associated with the main information as the information viewer.
  • Output to terminal 500 (transmit via network) (this enables information viewer terminal 500 to acquire the main information and sub information (display on the display screen, etc.)).
  • the administrator system 100 counts (counts) the number of accesses to the main information from the information viewer terminal 500, and displays the latest count result (latest access count) as the main information. Is stored in a predetermined storage means, and the access count number of the information viewer terminal 500 for the main information is updated in real time.
  • the administrator system 100 when the article ID of the specific article is read by the information viewer terminal 500, in the form associated with the main information, both the sub information link number and the access count number, The information is output to the information viewer terminal 500 as an index representing the degree of association determined by the amount of sub information and the number of accesses to the main information.
  • the number of accesses represents the level of interest of general users, while the number of links represents the level of interest of traders.
  • bookmarks of articles as physical media [Bookmarks of articles as physical media (physical bookmarks)] Further, in the access counting process, the administrator system, in response to a request from the information viewer terminal 500, as information for bookmarking a specific article related to the article ID read by the information viewer terminal 500, A bookmark title composed of title information of a specific article (typically, information that becomes the title of the main information of the main information of the specific article.
  • the product For example, if the specific article is a product, the product The title of the article is displayed as a bookmark at the time of re-access, and is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the article ID of the particular article.
  • a bookmark ID for identification typically, an article ID of the specific article, but a web page of main information of the particular article
  • the bookmark ID only the article ID is stored in the information viewer terminal, and the title of the article is also stored in the information viewer terminal, so that the information can be called up.
  • Information that combines the time of reading and the location of the specific article may be used in association with the information viewer terminal 500 that has read the article ID or the user who has read the article ID. And storing the bookmark title by selecting and executing the bookmark title.
  • the administrator system 100 stores the terminal identification information of the information viewer terminal 500 that has read the article ID in a predetermined storage unit in association with the article ID and the bookmark information.
  • Terminal Identification Processing (Thus, the information viewer terminal 500 is the bookmark title)
  • the administrator system 100 may use the user information (registered user) input when the article ID is read by the information viewer terminal 500. Is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the article ID and the bookmark information. (User identification processing)
  • the administrator system 100 uses the user information input when the article ID is read by the information viewer terminal 500 (user information of registered users, typically Is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the article ID and the bookmark information. (Terminal / user identification processing) (Thus, even when the user is not logged in, when the terminal is accessed, it can be identified by the terminal identification information. If the user logs in, the terminal is changed. But it can be identified by user information.)
  • the administrator system 100 obtains the time when the article ID of the specific article is read by the information viewer terminal 500 and the position information of the specific article when the article ID is read.
  • the information is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the terminal identification information or user information of the information viewer terminal 500 (user ID of the user of the information viewer terminal 500).
  • the bookmark information of the user of the information viewer terminal 500 is stored in a predetermined storage means in association with the information viewer terminal or the user. Further, by updating to the latest reading time, the bookmark information is arranged and displayed along the time axis.
  • the information providing system includes an administrator system 100, a primary user system 200, a secondary user system 300, a physical medium providing place 400, an information viewer terminal 500, And a Web server 600.
  • the administrator system 100 is a system owned and managed by an administrator (such as a management company) that manages the information providing system.
  • the main user system 200 is a system owned and managed by a main user who is the main user of the information providing system.
  • the owner of an actual store that displays a specific actual product (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “actual product” in the sense of contrasting with a product virtually displayed on the net)
  • responsible persons such as managers and operators (hereinafter referred to as “store managers”) are users of the main user system 200 (that is, main users), but content related to specific products and services (hereinafter referred to as “main users”).
  • “Articles” Owners and operators of installation locations of real stores and houses (hereinafter referred to as "information installation locations") where posters and flyers are printed May be a user of the main user system 200 (that is, the main user).
  • the secondary user system 300 is a system owned and managed by a secondary user who is a secondary user of the information providing system.
  • the same product / service (hereinafter simply referred to as “the same product”) and / or the related product / service that is the same as the product / service published in the article of the main user's actual store or information printed matter.
  • a business owner of a store handling services (hereinafter simply referred to as “related product”) (including a virtual store in addition to a physical store) or an address in the vicinity of the physical store of the main user, and the same product
  • the sales owner of a store or the like that provides a product or service associated with the related product is a user (that is, a secondary user) of the secondary user system 300.
  • the physical medium providing place 400 is a case where the main user installs an information printed matter in which the article is posted in the actual store when the actual product is displayed in the actual store or the information installation location. This is the place where the information is installed.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 sets information on a person who has actually contacted the actual product in the actual store of the main user (typically, a final consumer who purchases the actual product, etc.) and information on the main user.
  • An information terminal device such as a smartphone owned by a person who has actually contacted an article of information printed matter at a place (typically, a final consumer who viewed the article of the printed matter of information), and those persons (hereinafter, It is simply an information terminal device used by an “information viewer”.
  • the administrator system 100 includes information management means 110.
  • the information management unit 110 realizes a function of managing various information including the main information of the main user system 200, the sub information of the sub user system 300, and other information.
  • the administrator system 100 also includes a management information database (hereinafter referred to as “management information DB”) 120.
  • the management information DB 120 realizes a function of storing various information including the main information of the main user system 200, the sub information of the sub user system 300, and other information in cooperation with the information management unit 110.
  • the administrator system 100 includes a management screen 130.
  • a user interface (GUI) for managing the various types of information is displayed on the management screen 130, and a person in charge can manage the management information via the management screen 130.
  • GUI user interface
  • the management information DB 120 can typically be configured by a relational database (RDB).
  • RDB relational database
  • the management information DB 120 can be configured to have a data structure (data schema) as shown in FIG.
  • the management information DB 120 is a master file (that is, a master table in the case of RDB), an article ID table 121 as an article ID file, a basic information table 122 as a basic information file, and a URL file.
  • a URL table 123 and a user information table 125 as a user information file.
  • the management information DB 120 includes a browsing history table 124 as a browsing history file as a transaction file (that is, a transaction table in the case of RDB).
  • the article ID table 121 is a table for storing and managing the article ID and related information, and has an article ID, a user ID, an issue date, and a valid flag as field names (column names or column names). Each value is stored in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple). Further, the article ID table 121 further has geographic information (for example, location information of the article location of each article ID) as a field name, and stores the value in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple). It may be.
  • the article ID of the article ID table 121 is a unique identifier (ID) given to each specific article as the local ID as described above.
  • the article ID may have an arbitrary configuration similar to a normal unique ID, and may include a character string, a numeric string, a combination of letters and numbers, a combination of letters, numbers, and symbols.
  • the user ID is basically a unique identifier (ID) assigned to each primary user, each secondary user, and each information viewer. This is a table for managing article IDs and related information, and the article ID is a unique ID assigned to each article belonging to a specific main user, and thus the user ID stored in the article ID table 121. Basically, only the user ID (main user ID) assigned uniquely for each main user is provided.
  • the issue date is the date on which the item ID was issued.
  • the validity flag is a flag for determining validity or invalidity of an article ID assigned to a specific article.
  • the valid flag is set to valid (for example, “1”) when the product ID is assigned to the specific product 410A or the like, while the specific product 410A or the like to which the product ID is assigned is suspended. If the issued item ID becomes unnecessary or unusable, such as when it becomes non-existent due to the above, etc., it is managed without deleting the item ID by setting it to invalid (for example, “0”). Only the relationship (link) with a specific physical medium is disconnected (deleted) while being maintained on the information DB 120.
  • the basic information table 122 is a table for storing and managing basic information (hereinafter referred to as “main information”) relating to a specific article to which an article ID is assigned (belonging to the main user), and field names (columns). (Name or column name) has an article ID, user ID, product name, image (product image), category, attribute 1, attribute 2 (and other attribute 3, if necessary) Each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the article ID of the basic information table 122 is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the article ID of the article ID table 121, and the article ID of one table is the main ID.
  • Predetermined relational calculation selection, projection, combination, etc. between the stored data of the article ID table 121 and the stored data of the basic information table 122).
  • the user ID in the basic information table 122 is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the user ID in the article ID table 121, and the user ID is the same as described for the article table 121.
  • a predetermined relational calculation is executed between the stored data of the article ID table 121 and the stored data of the basic information table 122, and desired data can be acquired.
  • the basic information table 122 is a table for managing main information related to a specific article ID belonging to the main user
  • the user ID stored in the basic information table 122 is basically an article ID. Similar to the user ID of the table 121, only the user ID of the main user is provided.
  • the product name is a name given to a specific product to which the product ID is assigned (belonging to the main user). If the product is a product in a narrow sense, the product name is the product name, and the product is a service (service). In that case, it will be the service name.
  • An image is an image of a specific article (belonging to the main user) to which an article ID is assigned, and typically includes a product image.
  • the category is a category to which a specific article (belonging to the main user) to which an article ID is assigned belongs (classification name under classification based on a predetermined standard), and typically a product category to which the product belongs (for example, Japanese standard product) Medium classification and small classification classification names).
  • Attributes such as attribute 1 and attribute 2 are attribute information specific to a specific article (belonging to the main user) to which the article ID is assigned, and are information such as a product price and a product manufacturer.
  • attribute 1 and attribute 2 are exemplified as the attribute information.
  • the attribute information is not limited to this, and any number and types of attribute information are stored. be able to.
  • the URL table 123 when an article ID is assigned to a specific article, is a unique URL assigned to the article ID (hereinafter also referred to as “main URL”) and related information of the main URL. (Hereinafter also referred to as “main URL related information”), a unique URL (hereinafter also referred to as “subordinate URL”) linked to the main URL, and related information (hereinafter referred to as “subordinate URL”). “Subordinate URL related information”), and a field name (column name or column name) as URLID, article ID, URL, title, user ID, usage The user URL and the last viewing time are stored, and each value is stored in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • this information system assigns a unique article ID to each specific article, and at the same time, a web page (basis information described later) having basic information (main information) of the specific article as content.
  • Page 150 a web page having basic information (main information) of the specific article as content.
  • Page 150 a web page having basic information (main information) of the specific article as content.
  • Page 150 a web page having basic information (main information) of the specific article as content.
  • Page 150
  • the URL (main URL) of the URL table 123 is a unique identifier associated with the guide page 150.
  • this information system links the main page of each article with a web page (hereinafter, referred to as “subordinate information detail page”) having detailed information of subordinate information related to the main information as content.
  • the user URL (subordinate URL) of the URL table 123 is the subordinate information detailed page. It is also a unique identifier associated with.
  • the URL of the URL table 123 is a main URL that is the URL of the main information guide page 150 related to a specific article
  • the user URL is a sub information detail page in which link information is posted on the guide page 150. It is a sub URL that is a URL.
  • These URLs (main URL and sub URL) have the same configuration as a general URL, and are a combination of a scheme name, a host name, and a path name (typically “http://host.com). / Path01 ”).
  • the URL table 123 stores a URLID uniquely corresponding to a URL (main URL) for convenience as an identifier (in relational calculation processing), and associates a unique URLID with each URL (main URL).
  • This URLID is a unique identifier that is automatically assigned to each main URL, and can have any configuration as long as the main URL can be uniquely identified.
  • the article ID of the URL table 123 is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the article ID of the article ID table 121 and the basic information table 122, and the article ID is the same as described for the article table 121.
  • the title is the title of the sub information detail page. As this title, for example, the title specified by the title element of the head element of the web page can be used.
  • the user ID is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the user ID in the article ID table 121 and the basic information table 122.
  • the URL table 123 is a table for managing the sub URLs of all the sub information linked to the main URL of the main information of each item ID (that is, one or more ( Normally, a plurality of subordinate URLs are associated in a one-to-many relationship), but the user ID stored in the URL table 123 is an ID uniquely corresponding to the user URL (subordinate URL). Therefore, the user URL in the ULR table 123 is basically only the user ID of the secondary user.
  • the slave URL (user URL) of the slave information will be specifically described.
  • the master user restaurants etc.
  • main information store information of a restaurant, product name of liquor, etc.
  • article alcohol provided at a restaurant, etc.
  • a secondary user is provided for the information page 150 of the main information.
  • liquor stores that sell liquor can use the secondary user system 300 to register their secondary information (basic information such as store information of the liquor store) in association with the primary information (for example, The sub user can post the sub information on the main information guide page 150). At this time, the sub user further adds the sub information to the sub information registered on the guide page 150.
  • the sub URL is the link destination information. Can be registered as, follow URL of the sub information detailed page of this case is the user URL.
  • the sub information posted on the main information guide page 150 includes, for example, a sub information detail page title and sub URL as link information (typically, a link element using the sub URL as a title and a link)
  • link information typically, a link element using the sub URL as a title and a link
  • basic information name, location, basic attributes, etc.
  • the last browsing time is the browsing time of the latest browsing history among the browsing history of the sub information detail page.
  • the last browsing time is the latest time when the link information of the sub information related to the sub information detail page is selected and executed.
  • the sub information can be displayed in order from the latest last viewing time (that is, in the order related to the latest viewing).
  • the registered sub information can be displayed in order from the latest one over time (along the time axis).
  • the viewer's interest in the web page is expected to be higher.
  • the display order of the items with the highest degree of interest for the viewer can be arranged higher, and the willingness to access the viewer can be enhanced.
  • the URL table 123 stores the main URL of the main information and associates the user URL of the sub information
  • the URL table 123 may be configured to store the main URL of the main information and the URL ID thereof in the article ID table.
  • the URL table 123 stores only the user URL (subordinate URL) as the URL.
  • the main URL is uniquely associated with the article ID in the article ID table 121 and managed in the article ID table 121.
  • the browsing history table 124 is a table for storing and managing browsing history information on the main information guide page 150 by the information viewer terminal 500, and the article ID is used as a field name (column name or column name). , Browsing time (browsing start time and browsing end time), and browsing location, each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the browsing history table 124 further has a browsing user ID (for example, a user ID of user information registered in the administrator system 100 by the owner of the information browsing terminal 500) as a field name, and the value is recorded in each record. You may make it store in the field corresponding to (each tuple).
  • the browsing user ID can be stored in the user information table 125 as the user ID (user ID for browsing).
  • the article ID of the browsing history table 124 is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the article ID of the article ID table 121 and the like.
  • a predetermined relational calculation is executed between the stored data such as the ID table 121 and the stored data of the browsing history table 124 so that desired data can be acquired.
  • the browsing location is the location information of the location where the article ID of the specific article was read by the information viewer terminal 500 (typically, the location information of the information viewer terminal 500 when reading the article ID, This is position information made up of latitude / longitude information acquired by GPS installed in the browser terminal 500).
  • the user information table 125 is a table for managing users of the information providing system, and has a user ID and a user name as a field name (column name or column name). Store in the corresponding field of the record (each tuple).
  • the user ID is a unique ID (having the same configuration) corresponding to the user ID in the article ID table 121 or the like. Since the user information table 125 is a table for managing users, the user ID includes at least the user ID of the primary user and the user ID of the secondary user. In addition, when registering an information viewer as a user, the user ID of the information viewer is included.
  • the primary user ID there are a user ID of the primary user (primary user ID) and a secondary user ID (secondary user ID) as the user ID.
  • primary user ID the primary user
  • secondary user ID secondary user ID
  • the user ID and the browser ID can be configured to distinguish the primary user, the secondary user, and the viewer, respectively.
  • the primary user ID, the secondary user ID, and the viewer ID are created with different ID creation rules, or when these are created with the same creation rules, the same as when different authority is given to each user
  • it is possible to store a field representing each authority in association with the user ID so that the primary user, the secondary user, and the viewer can be distinguished.
  • the relationship between the item ID table 121 and the URL table 123 is one-to-one.
  • the relationship between the article ID table 121 and the URL table 123 is also a one-to-one relationship.
  • the relation between the article ID table 121 and the browsing history table 124 is 1 It becomes a many-to-many relationship.
  • the information management unit 110 includes an article ID management unit 111, a main information management unit 112, a sub information management unit 113, a browsing management unit 114, and a guide page creation unit 115.
  • the information management means 110 can be configured as shown in FIG. 2, for example.
  • the article ID management unit 111 includes an article ID issuing unit 111a, a corresponding URL issuing unit 111b, and an ID / URL management unit 111c.
  • the main information management unit 112 includes a main information GUI (Graphical User Interface) 112a and a main information registration management unit 112b.
  • the sub information management unit 113 includes a sub information GUI 113a, a sub information registration management unit 113b, and a link URL counting unit 113c.
  • the browsing management unit 114 includes a guide page transmission unit 114a, a browsing counting unit 114b, and a bookmark management unit 114c. Details of each of these means will be described in detail below.
  • the article ID management means 111 is a function realizing means for issuing and managing an article ID, and includes an article ID issuing means 111a, a main URL issuing means 111b, and an ID / URL management means 111c. ing.
  • the article ID management unit 111 includes a position information management unit 111d.
  • the article ID management means 111 can include means for realizing other functions for issuing and managing article IDs.
  • the article ID issuing unit 111 a issues an article ID corresponding to a specific article (for example, a product provided or sold at its own store) to the administrator system 100 by the main user system 200.
  • a request is made (that is, when a request is made to use the information providing system as a main user)
  • a corresponding article ID is issued for the specific article, and the article ID is assigned to the article.
  • a function to be given to the ID medium 411 is realized.
  • the article ID issuing unit 111a specifies the specific product 410A or the specific information printed matter 410B.
  • a unique article ID to be associated with the specific article is issued, and the article ID is assigned to the article ID mediums 411, 411a to 411n such as NFC tags. That is, the article ID issuing unit 111a stores the article ID as the article ID medium 411, 411a to 411n of the type of the article ID medium 411, 411a to 411n that stores / stores the article ID in a predetermined storage area like an NFC tag. For the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n, which are stored in the storage area 411n and print the article ID on a paper medium like a barcode, the article ID is printed on the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n.
  • article ID media 411, 411a to 411n of the type in which the article ID is printed on a paper medium such as a barcode can be printed directly in the vicinity of the article of the information printed matter 410B, but information such as tags and labels can be printed.
  • Article ID media 411, 411a to 411n are configured by printing the article ID on a print medium separate from the printed matter 410B, and the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n are pasted in the vicinity of the article of the information printed matter 410B. May be.
  • the issue ID issue process is executed by the administrator system 100.
  • the issuer ID assignment process (storage, printing, etc.) to the issue ID media 411, 411a to 411n is performed by the main user system 100. May be executed by using a predetermined ID writing means (NFC writer, barcode writer, etc.).
  • the ID writing means may be transferred or lent by the administrator of the administrator system 100 to the main user of the main user system 200. At this time, it is written and stored in a storage area (for example, a payload in the case of an NFC tag) of the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n in a format or format corresponding to the type of the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n.
  • the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n are NFC tags
  • the article ID is a unique ID consisting of a numeric string, an alphanumeric string, etc.
  • NDEF NFC Data Exchange Format
  • the data is written and stored in a predetermined storage area of the NFC tag (for example, the payload of the short record (SR)).
  • the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n are barcodes
  • the article ID is a unique ID consisting of a numeric string (in the case of a one-dimensional barcode), or a unique ID consisting of a numeric string, an alphanumeric string, or the like.
  • the article ID issuing unit 111a Each time the article ID issuing unit 111a issues the article ID, the article ID issuing unit 111a writes the article ID, the user ID of the main user related to the article ID, and the issue date of the article ID in the article ID table 121. Then, the validity flag of the article ID is set to be valid.
  • the article ID issuing unit 111a When geographic information is stored in the article ID table 121, the article ID issuing unit 111a writes the geographic information (position information) of the article ID in the article ID table 121 every time the article ID is issued. (For example, it may be configured to write geographic information registered by the main user when the main information is registered).
  • the article ID management unit 111 includes a main URL issuing unit 111b.
  • the main URL issuing unit 111b realizes a function of issuing the main URL. Specifically, when an article ID is issued for a specific article, the URL (Uniform Resource Locator) uniquely corresponding to the article ID is issued. ) Is newly issued.
  • the main URL issuing means 111b when issuing a new URL instead of issuing a new URL, already has a main information guide page 150 related to the article ID, and there is an existing URL of the guide page 150. This existing URL can also be assigned.
  • the guide page 150 to which the main URL is assigned is a specific web page provided for posting predetermined content consisting of main information (basic information) regarding the article associated with the article ID.
  • main information basic information
  • the main URL issuing unit 111b realizes a function of issuing a main URL corresponding to the article ID by the main URL issuing process (first step of the URL issuing process) shown in FIG.
  • the article ID management unit 111 includes an ID / URL management unit 111c.
  • the ID / URL management unit 111c realizes a function of managing the article ID issued by the article ID issuing unit 111a and the main URL issued by the main URL issuing unit 111b in association with each other.
  • the ID / URL management unit 111c realizes a function of executing a predetermined relational calculation between the article ID table 121 and the URL table 123 using the article ID and the URL ID of the main URL.
  • the article ID management unit 111 includes a position information management unit 111d.
  • the location information management unit 111d acquires the location information of the information viewer terminal 500 when the information viewer terminal 500 reads the product ID of the specific product 410A, 410B and accesses the corresponding guide page 150. Realize the function to manage. Thereby, the administrator system 100 can manage the position information of the information viewer terminal 500 acquired by the position information management unit 111d as the position information of the article from which the information viewer terminal 500 has read the article ID.
  • the main information management unit 112 is a function realizing unit for managing main information, and includes a main information GUI (Graphical User Interface) unit 112a and a main information registration management unit 112b.
  • the main information management means 112 can include means for realizing other functions for managing the main information.
  • the main information GUI unit 112 a realizes a function of providing a user interface (GUI) for the main user to register the main information in the administrator system 100 using the main user system 200.
  • GUI user interface
  • the main information GUI means 112a may be configured to display a main information registration web page (main information registration page) shown in FIG. 5 or FIG.
  • the main information registration confirmation / ID issue application page) is transmitted from the administrator system 100 to the main user system 200 and provided.
  • the main information registration management unit 112b receives the main information input by the main user from the main user system 200 using the main information registration GUI (main information registration page and main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page). A function for registering in the administrator system 100 is realized. For example, the main information registration management unit 112b registers the main information transmitted from the main user system 200 in the administrator system 100 by the main information registration process (main user process) shown in FIG. Is realized.
  • the main information registration managing means 112b stores the article ID and the main user related to the article ID in the basic information table 122.
  • the product ID Is input to the basic information table 122, the product ID, the user ID of the main user related to the product ID, the product name of the product related to the product ID (product name in the case of a product), The article image of the article, the category of the article, and other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2,%) Are written.
  • the sub information management unit 113 is a function realizing unit for managing sub information, and includes a sub information GUI unit 113a, a sub information registration management unit 113b, and a sub URL counting unit 113c.
  • the sub information management means 113 can include means for realizing other functions for managing the sub information.
  • the sub information GUI means 113a realizes a function of providing a user interface (GUI) for the sub user to register the sub information in the administrator system 100 using the sub user system 300.
  • GUI user interface
  • the sub information GUI means 113a displays the sub information registration web page (sub information registration page) shown in FIG. 10 or FIG. 12 and the sub information confirmation web page (sub information check page) shown in FIG.
  • the function to be transmitted and provided from the administrator system 100 to the slave user system 300 is realized.
  • the subordinate information registration management unit 113b uses the subordinate information input by the subordinate user from the subordinate user system 300 using the subordinate information registration GUI (subordinate information registration page and subordinate information confirmation page). Realize the function to register with.
  • the sub information registration management unit 113b has a function of registering the sub information transmitted from the sub user system 300 in the manager system 100 by the sub information registration process (sub user process) shown in FIG. Is realized.
  • the main URL issuing unit 111b of the article ID management unit 111 issues a main URL corresponding to the article ID, and associates the main URL and the URL ID with the article ID in the URL table 123.
  • the user ID of the sub information (sub user ID)
  • the user URL of the sub information (URL of the sub information detail page)
  • the sub information registration management unit 113b uses the sub information GUI unit 121a to display sub information from the sub user system 300 as sub information related to (to be linked to) an article ID related to one specific article.
  • the title, user ID (subordinate user ID), and user URL are input, the title, user ID, and user URL are written in the URL table 123 in association with the article ID.
  • the slave information registration management unit 113b further receives the slave information that the slave user has input from the slave user system 300 using the slave information registration GUI (the slave information registration page and the slave information confirmation page). It is determined whether or not to register in the system 100, and a function for approving or rejecting the registration is realized.
  • the slave information registration management unit 113b performs the slave information registration approval process (normal approval routine) shown in FIG. 14 or the slave information registration approval process (deletion approval routine) shown in FIG.
  • the sub information transmitted from the main information is registered in association with the main information (that is, whether the sub information is linked and posted on the main information guide page 150), and the sub information determined to be registered
  • the function of registering only in the administrator system 100 is realized.
  • the sub-URL counting unit 113c adds the number of sub-information to be linked to the main information guide page 150 related to one specific article (that is, the total sub-URLs of the sub-information details page that is the number of sub-information sub-page links).
  • the function of counting the number) and storing it in a predetermined storage means is realized. That is, the sub URL counting unit 113c realizes a function of counting only sub information registered and approved by the sub information approval processing by the sub information registration managing unit 113b and storing the sub information in a predetermined storage unit.
  • the browsing management unit 114 is a function realizing unit for managing browsing information, and includes a guide page transmission unit 114a, a browsing counting unit 114b, and a bookmark management unit 114c. Although not shown in FIG. 2, as shown in FIG. 16, the browsing management unit 114 includes a time information management unit 114d and an access ID management unit 114e. In addition to the above, the browsing management means 114 can include means for realizing other functions for managing browsing information.
  • the guide page transmitting unit 114a realizes a function for transmitting, from the administrator system 100, the information viewer terminal 500, the main information guide page 150 for the information viewer to browse using the information viewer terminal 500. To do.
  • the guide page transmitting unit 114a realizes a function of transmitting and providing the guide page 150 shown in FIG. 17 or 18 from the administrator system 100 to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the browsing counting means 114b is the number of information viewers browsing the information page 150 of the main information related to one specific article using the information viewer terminal 500 (that is, the number of accesses from the information viewer terminal 500). A function of counting and storing the data in a predetermined storage means is realized.
  • the bookmark management unit 114 c provides the information viewer terminal 500 with a bookmark function for bookmarking an article related to the guide page 150 when the information viewer browses the guide page 150 with the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the bookmark function is used to realize a function of managing information related to bookmarks stored in the information viewer terminal 500 (hereinafter also referred to as “bookmark information”).
  • the bookmark management means 114c is implemented as a bookmark means (a bookmark menu or the like in the browsing page) shown in FIG. 19, 20, 20, 22 or 23 by the bookmark means providing process (BM process) shown in FIG. A function of providing the bookmarker manager) to the information viewer terminal 500 is realized.
  • the bookmark management means 114c on the administrator system 100 side and the bookmark means (FIG. 16) on the information viewer terminal 500 side will be described in detail in the description of the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the time information management unit 114d has a time information management unit 114d that responds to a page transmission request from the information viewer terminal 500 (request for a guide page 150 or the like related to a specific article).
  • a guide page 150 or the like is transmitted, a function of acquiring and managing the request time or the time information at the transmission time is realized.
  • the access ID management unit 114e of the browsing management unit 114 uniquely identifies the information viewer terminal 500 or the viewer related to the access.
  • a function for acquiring and managing an ID (hereinafter also referred to as an “access ID”) for the purpose is realized.
  • the access ID is a terminal ID that can uniquely identify the information viewer terminal 500 (such as IDFV as the terminal identification information), or a user ID that can uniquely identify the user of the information viewer terminal 500 (management For example, a unique user ID given when a user is registered in the user system 100.
  • the browsing management means 114 uses the time information management means 114d when transmitting the guidance page 150 in response to a request from the information viewer terminal 500 (request for the guidance page 150 relating to a specific article), In association with the article ID related to the guidance page 150, the transmission time is stored in the browsing history table as the browsing time.
  • the bookmark management means 114c displays the bookmark in the bookmark menu shown in FIG. 19 or the like by using the browsing time, the bookmark is arranged in the order of the browsing time and displayed as a list, or as shown in FIG.
  • the bookmarks of the guide page 150 browsed on a specific date of the calendar can be displayed in a list by arranging them in order of browsing time.
  • the browsing management means 114 transmits the guidance page 150 to the information browser terminal 500
  • the location information of the information browser terminal 500 for example, location information from a GPS or the like installed in the information viewer terminal 500. May be obtained, and the positional information may be stored in the browsing history table as a browsing location in association with the article ID related to the guide page 150.
  • the browsing management unit 114 includes a location information management unit that realizes such location information acquisition and management functions (not shown). That is, as described above, in addition to the configuration in which the article ID management unit 111 includes the location information management unit 111d, the browsing management unit 114 may include the location information management unit.
  • the bookmark management unit 114c uses the information on the browsing location to When displaying a bookmark in the bookmark menu shown in 19 etc., displaying the location of the bookmarked specific article using the geocoding function of the map API, or displaying a bookmark in the bookmark menu shown in FIG.
  • the address of the bookmarked specific item can be displayed using the reverse geocoding function of the map API.
  • the browsing management unit 114 realizes a function of specifying the access ID of the information viewer terminal 500 when there is an access from the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the guide page creation unit 115 realizes a function for transmitting a guide page 150 of main information for the information viewer to browse using the information viewer terminal 500 from the administrator system 100 to the information viewer terminal 500. To do.
  • the guide page transmission unit 114a realizes a function of creating a guide page 150 having the items shown in FIG. 17 or FIG. 18 as contents.
  • the guide page creation unit 115 realizes a function of creating the guide page 150 related to the issued main URL by the process for issuing the main URL shown in FIG. 6 (the latter half step of the URL issuing process).
  • the guide page creating means 115 is constant.
  • the product name of the product (product name in the case of a product), the product image of the product, the category of the product, and other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2, ..)) (That is, using them as contents)
  • the guide page 150 is created.
  • the guide page creation unit 115 extracts the URL (main URL) related to the article ID from the URL table 123 and associates it with the created guide page 150 URL.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 makes a request for the corresponding guide page 150 via the main URL, and the guide page decoration means 114a of the browse management means 114 displays the URL guide page 150 related to the request.
  • the information is transmitted to the information viewer terminal 150.
  • the user management unit 140 is a function implementation unit for managing user information, and includes a user GUI unit 141 and an information registration management unit 142. In addition to these, the user information management means 140 can include means for realizing other functions for managing user information.
  • the user GUI means 141 is used by the primary user and secondary users to register their primary information and secondary information in the administrator system 100 using their primary user system 200 and secondary user system 300.
  • a function for providing a user interface (GUI) for realizing the above is realized.
  • the user GUI means 141a transmits the user information registration web page (user registration page UI10) shown in FIG. 3 from the administrator system 100 to the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300.
  • the user GUI means 141 uses the information browsing terminal 5 to allow the information viewer to use his / her information browsing terminal 5 to manage his / her information.
  • a function for providing a user interface (GUI) for registering to the server is realized.
  • the information registration management means 142 is a system for managing user information input by a primary user or a secondary user from the primary user system 200 or the secondary user system 300 using the user information registration GUI. A function for registering to 100 is realized.
  • the information registration management unit 142 writes the user ID and the user name in the user information table 125 each time the main user or the subordinate user registers his / her user information. That is, the information registration management unit 142 receives a user ID, a user name, and the like of one user from the main user system 200 and the sub user system 300 by the user GUI unit 141. The user ID, user name, etc. are written in the user information table 125.
  • the user registration page UI10 is a user interface (GUI) for a main user or the like to register his / her user information using the main user system 200 or the like.
  • An information input area UI11 and a content confirmation button UI12 are provided.
  • the user information input area UI11 includes input fields for user ID, user name, E-Mail, address, telephone, and FAX as input fields.
  • the user ID may be given a unique ID, but may be an email address.
  • For the user name for example, a company name or the like is input.
  • the user registration information page UI10 can be used in common by the primary user and the secondary user for registration of the user information, and the registration screen 240 of the primary user system 200 and the secondary user system 300.
  • the content confirmation button UI12 When the content confirmation button UI12 is pressed, the content confirmation page of the input items in the user information input area UI11 is displayed on the registration screen 240 of the primary user system 200 (or the registration screen 340 of the secondary user system 300).
  • each data of the input contents is selected and executed by selecting and executing a button such as “Send” provided on the contents confirmation page. And registered in the user information table 125 of the administrator system 100.
  • the main user system 200 includes information registration means 210.
  • the information registration unit 210 realizes a function of registering main information of the main user system 200 with respect to the administrator system 100 and applying for issue of an article ID.
  • the information registration unit 210 includes a main information registration unit 211 and an article ID application unit 212.
  • the main information registration unit 211 uses the GUI (the main information registration page shown in FIGS. 6 and 7) provided from the main information GUI unit 112a of the management system 100 as described above to store the main information. Implement the function to input and register.
  • the article ID application unit 212 applies the article ID to the administrator system 100 using the GUI (main information registration page in FIG. 6 or 7) provided from the main information GUI unit 112a. To achieve the function.
  • the main user system 200 includes an ID assigning unit 250.
  • the ID assigning unit 250 realizes a function in which the main user assigns an article ID issued by the administrator system 100 to his / her specific article.
  • the ID assigning unit 250 includes an ID writing unit 251 and a tag attaching unit 252.
  • the ID writing means 251 realizes a function of writing a unique ID (an ID for NFC, a barcode, etc.) to each of the article ID media 411, 411a, and 411n to which the article ID is to be written.
  • the article ID media 411, 411a, and 411n are NFC
  • the article ID is written to the storage area of the NFC tag according to the ID system unique to NFC
  • the article ID media 411, 411a, and 411n are two-dimensional barcodes.
  • the article ID is written (that is, printed) on a tag for barcode (a barcode tag made of printed matter) according to an ID system unique to the two-dimensional barcode.
  • the tag attaching unit 252 realizes a function of attaching a tag (NFC tag or barcode tag) in which an article ID is written to a specific target article.
  • the tag attaching means 252 can be configured by an apparatus having a structure in which an adhesive or an adhesive is applied to the back surface of a tag on which an article ID is written and is attached to the surface of the article or the package of the article.
  • the main user system 200 includes a main browsing information database (DB) 220 and an internal information database (DB) 230.
  • the main browsing information DB 220 can typically be configured from a relational database (RDB) and includes a main browsing information table 221.
  • the main browsing information table 221 is a table for storing and managing information corresponding to the main information.
  • the field ID includes a product ID, a product name, a product image, a price, and other attributes (attribute 1,. ..) and stores each value in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the main user can obtain basic information on his / her product (similar to the main information on the article registered in the administrator system 100), detailed information on his / her product, etc. It can be managed by the main user system 200, which is a system, and can be used for browsing and editing as required.
  • the main browsing information DB 220 is used, for example, by a main user as a web page content providing unit (similar to the guide page 150 provided by the administrator system 100) for a viewer who is interested in his / her product. It can also be used to provide information.
  • the internal information DB 230 can typically be configured from a relational database (RDB) and includes an internal information table 231.
  • the internal information table 231 is a table for storing and managing the internal information of the main user (especially confidential information such as personal information).
  • data relating to personal information for example, own company or product
  • data related to transaction information for example, the company name of the supplier or the company name of the seller
  • other internal information is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the internal information DB 230 includes, for example, user information (information such as user personal information, user preferences, etc.) of the article (product) as accompanying information and related information related to the article registered by the main user in the administrator system 100. , Other related information), and transaction information (customers, transaction results, etc.) related to the article are managed by the main user system 200 as its own system, and viewed or edited as necessary. Can be used in In this information providing system, by providing the internal information DB 230 in the main user system 200, it is not necessary to manage the internal information in the administrator system 100, and the security of the internal information in the administrator system 100 is ensured. The need for means and the like can be eliminated.
  • FIG. 4 An information processing operation between the main user system 200 having the above configuration and the administrator system 100 will be described.
  • the main user uses the main user system 200 to manage the administrator.
  • the main information is input and transmitted to the system 100 (that is, as described above, the main information is input to the main information registration page of FIG. 5 and transmitted to the administrator system 100).
  • the main user also applies to the administrator system 100 for an article ID related to the article (that is, as described above, the ID type of the article ID is selected on the main information registration page of FIG.
  • the administrator system 100 registers the main information as described above, issues an article ID corresponding to the article, and transmits information on the fact to the main user system 200. .
  • the main information registration page UI20 is a user interface (GUI) for the main user to register the main information related to his / her item (usually a product) via the main user system 200. Yes, it includes a first pane (first display area) PN1 and a second pane (second display area) PN2.
  • the first pane PN1 has a main information input area UI21 and a content confirmation button UI25.
  • the main information input area UI21 has, as input fields for main information, a user ID, a user name, an ID type of an article ID, an article name, an attribute 1 (for example, a product price), and an attribute 2 (for example, a product quality display).
  • the user ID and the user name are the user ID and the user name registered on the user registration page UI10, and the user ID and the user name are respectively entered in the user ID and user name input fields.
  • the ID and registered user name are automatically displayed.
  • the ID type has check columns for NFC, barcode, and two-dimensional barcode, and the type of article ID desired by the user is checked using this check column. Other input items are input directly.
  • the main information input area UI21 is further provided with an input field for geographic information as an input field, and the geographic information input field includes the geographic information (location information, address, map, map API) of the main user store. Geographic information etc.) can be entered and registered as main information.
  • the main information input area UI21 further includes an input field for a detailed information URL as an input field, and a web page (for example, the detailed information URL for the article related to the main information is included in the detailed information URL input field).
  • the URL of a company-operated web page that publishes data in the main browsing information DB 220 provided on the main user system 200 side as content can be input.
  • the main information input area UI21 has an approval mode input field UI21A.
  • the main information registration page UI20 has an article image link input field UI22 for an article related to the main information.
  • the article image link input field UI22 is an input field for path information as link information of an article image to be displayed as an article image related to main information on the guidance page.
  • the file reference button UI23 is used to select a storage destination image file in which the article image is stored in the same manner as in the normal file reference function, and the image addition button UI24 is selected and executed. By doing so, the path of the selected image file is automatically input.
  • the approval mode input column UI21A has check columns for normal approval and deletion approval, and any one of the check columns is checked.
  • a function hereinafter referred to as “link approval function” for allowing the user to select whether or not the sub information may be linked to the main information related to his / her item (that is, to approve the link). (That is, providing an approval means with a link that realizes a function for that purpose), and as an approval function with a link (an approval mode with a link), a normal approval function (a normal approval mode) is provided.
  • a deletion approval function (deletion approval mode) (that is, a normal approval means and a deletion approval means for realizing those functions are provided). That is, the information providing system includes a normal approval unit for executing the process shown in FIG. 14 and a deletion approval unit for executing the process shown in FIG. I have. Therefore, the approval mode input column UI21A checks the check column of either the normal approval or the deletion approval, so that the main user related to the main information is allowed to enter the normal approval function as an approval function with a link. Alternatively, one of the deletion approval functions can be selected.
  • the main information registration page UI20 has a registered article number display field UI26, a total link number display field UI27, and a total access number display field UI28 as display fields in the second pane PN2.
  • the registered article number display column UI26 displays the total number of articles that have been registered in the manager system 100 so far by the main user who has applied for registration of main information (and application for issuing an article ID).
  • the administrator system 100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the number of registered articles by the total number of article IDs, and sets the number of registered main articles on the main information registration page UI20 of the main user of the user ID.
  • a function for displaying the number of registered articles is realized in the registered article number display column UI26 in the second pane PN2 (that is, a registered article number display means for realizing such a function is provided). Further, the total link number display column UI27 displays the total number of links of sub information linked to the main information related to all registered articles of the main user. That is, the administrator system 100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the total number of links of the sub information by the sub URL counting means 1113c, and registers the main information of the main user of the user ID.
  • a function of displaying the total number of links in the total link number display field UI27 of the second pane PN2 of the page UI20 is realized (that is, a total link number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the total access number display column UI28 displays the total number of accesses from the information viewer terminal 500 for all guide pages for main information related to all registered articles of the main user. That is, the administrator system 100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the total access count of the main information guide page by the browsing counting means 114b, and determines the main user's main user of the user ID.
  • a function of displaying the total access number in the total access number display field UI28 of the second pane PN2 of the information registration page UI20 is realized (that is, a total access number display means for realizing such a function is provided). .
  • the main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page UI30 includes a first pane PN1 and a second pane PN2 corresponding to the configuration of the main information registration page UI20.
  • the first pane PN1 has a main information confirmation area UI31 and an ID issuance application button UI33 as the structure of confirmation items and the like corresponding to the structure of input items and the like of the main information registration page UI20.
  • the main information confirmation area UI31 includes display fields for user ID, user name, article ID, issue URL, article name, attribute 1, attribute 2, and other necessary attributes as display fields. Note that the user ID and user name registered in the user registration page UI10 are displayed in the user ID and user name display fields, respectively.
  • the article ID display column the article ID automatically issued by the article ID issuing unit 111a of the administrator system 100 is displayed according to the type of the article ID checked by the ID type of the main information registration page UI20.
  • a URL main URL automatically issued for the main information guide page related to the issued article ID is displayed.
  • the main information confirmation area UI31 may display the type of approval mode (normal approval mode or deletion approval mode) selected in the approval mode input field UI21A of the main information registration page UI20.
  • the main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page UI30 has an article image display field UI32.
  • the article image display field UI32 displays the article image of the path input in the article image link input field UI22 of the main information registration page UI20. Then, as shown in FIG.
  • the ID issuance application button UI33 provided on the main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page UI30 is selected and executed, so that each of the data is It is transmitted to the administrator system 100 and registered in the basic information table 122 of the administrator system 100.
  • the issue ID can also be issued at this timing.
  • the main information registration process (main user process) will be described with reference to the flowchart of FIG. First, as shown in FIG. 7, when the main user accesses the administrator system 100 from the main user system 200 as shown in FIG. 7, the main user system performs the main user process in STEP2.
  • the GUI information of the initial screen is transmitted to 200, and the initial screen is displayed on the registration screen 240 of the main user system 200. Note that STEP2 may be omitted.
  • STEP 3 it is determined whether or not the accessed main user is a legitimate main user based on user information such as a user ID input from the main user system 200. If it is determined, an error is displayed in STEP4.
  • the administrator system 100 transmits the GUI information on the main information registration screen (main information registration page UI 20) to the main user system 200, and the main user system 200.
  • a main information registration screen is displayed on the registration screen 240.
  • the administrator system 100 confirms the data of each input item.
  • STEP 7 If it is determined in STEP 7 that necessary basic information has not been input, an error display is executed in STEP 8, STEP 5 is executed again, and this series of steps is performed until necessary basic information is input on the main information registration screen. The processing (STEP 5 to STEP 7) is repeated.
  • STEP 9 the type of article ID related to the application is determined. If the type of the article ID determined in STEP 9 is NFC, an NFC-ID is issued in STEP 10. If the article ID type determined in STEP 9 is BC (one-dimensional barcode), a one-dimensional barcode ID is issued in STEP 11.
  • a 2D barcode ID is issued in STEP 12.
  • the administrator system 100 creates a main information confirmation page (main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page UI 30) and transmits it to the main user system 200.
  • the confirmation information is transmitted to the administrator system 100 by the ID application button UI33 on the main information registration confirmation / ID issue application page UI30, the administrator system 100 stores the main information as the confirmation information in the basic information table. The data is stored in 122 and registered to complete the main user process.
  • the main URL issuing process (URL issuing process) associated with the main information guide page will be described with reference to the flowchart of FIG.
  • the administrator system 100 sets the article ID in STEP 15.
  • a URL main URL
  • main URL uniquely corresponding to the guide page related to the issued main information article is issued by the main URL issuing means 111b, and the main URL is stored in the URL table 123 and registered.
  • the administrator system 100 creates a guide page 150 corresponding to the main URL using the guide page creation means 115 based on the main information in the basic information table 122, and completes the URL issuing process. To do.
  • the secondary user system 300 includes information registration means 310.
  • the information registration unit 310 realizes a function of registering the sub information of the sub user system 300 to the administrator system 100 and linking the sub information to the main information.
  • the information registration unit 310 includes a sub information registration unit 311 and a position information unit 312.
  • the sub information registration unit 311 uses the GUI provided from the sub information GUI unit 113a of the management system 100 as described above (the sub information registration page of FIG. 10, FIG. 11 or FIG. 12), and A function for inputting and registering sub information is realized.
  • the location information means 312 realizes a function for the secondary user to register geographical information (location information, address, etc.) of his / her own store or the like in the administrator system 100.
  • the position information unit 312 may be omitted.
  • the slave user system 300 also includes information management means 350.
  • the information management unit 350 displays the URL (subordinate URL) of the web page to be posted as the link information of the sub information according to the main information guide page when the sub user associates the sub information with the main information.
  • a function for registering in the subordinate information registration management unit 113b of the system 100 and managing the subordinate URL and subordinate information is realized.
  • the information management unit 350 includes a URL registration unit 351.
  • the URL registration means 351 is the URL (main URL) of the main information guide page or the main information item.
  • a function for registering the URL of the subordinate information (subordinate URL) in the subordinate information registration management unit 113b of the administrator system 100 is realized.
  • the URL registration unit 351 realizes other functions for managing the slave URL after the slave user associates the slave URL of the slave information of the user with the master information via the slave user system 300. Means to do this may be provided.
  • the information management unit 350 may include a time series display unit 352. The time-series display unit 352 displays a main information guide page 150 related to a specific article in order to determine whether or not the sub user uses the sub user system 300 to link his sub information.
  • the browsing history is stored in the browsing history table 124 by the browsing management means 114 of the administrator system 100, and based on the browsing history, information on a specific article related to the guidance page 150 browsed in the past (information browsing)
  • the time-series display unit 352 can be configured in the same manner as the time-series display unit 514 of the information viewer terminal 500 to be described later. Substituting with the explanation.
  • the secondary user system 300 includes a secondary browsing information database (DB) 320 and an internal information database (DB) 330.
  • the secondary browsing information DB 320 can typically be configured from a relational database (RDB), and includes a secondary browsing information table 321.
  • the sub-browsing information table 321 is a table for storing and managing information corresponding to the sub-information.
  • the field ID includes a product ID, a product name, a product image, a price, and other attributes (attribute 1,. ..) and stores each value in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the sub-browsing information DB 320 allows the sub-user to obtain basic information related to his / her product or store (similar to the sub-information registered in the administrator system 100) or detailed information about his / her product or store.
  • the system can be managed by the secondary user system 300, which is a system, and can be used for viewing and editing as required.
  • the sub-browsing information DB 320 can also be used, for example, by a sub-user as a web page content providing means for providing information to a viewer who is interested in his / her product.
  • the internal information DB 330 can typically be configured from a relational database (RDB) and includes an internal information table 331.
  • the internal information table 331 is a table for storing and managing internal information (especially, confidential information such as personal information) of subordinate users, and data relating to personal information (for example, own company or product) as a field name.
  • data relating to personal information for example, own company or product
  • each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the internal information DB 330 is, for example, the product information or store information related to the slave information registered in the administrator system 100 by the slave user, such as the product or store user information (user personal information, user preferences, and the like, and , Other related information) and transaction information (customers, transaction results, etc.) related to the product or store are managed in the sub-user system 300 which is its own system, and can be viewed or edited as necessary. Can be used for In this information providing system, by providing the internal information DB 330 in the secondary user system 300, it is not necessary to manage the internal information in the administrator system 100, and the security of the internal information in the administrator system 100 is ensured. The need for means and the like can be eliminated.
  • the subordinate user also transmits to the manager system 100 a subordinate URL (URL of the subordinate information detail page of the product to be linked or the store) used when linking the subordinate information to the main information ( That is, as described above, the link information of the slave information desired by the user is transmitted to the administrator system 100 by inputting the slave URL as the link destination URL on the slave information registration page of FIG.
  • the administrator system 100 registers the sub information as described above, and the main ID of the main information item ID or main information guide page corresponding to the sub URL corresponding to the sub information. Link to URL.
  • this link application can be made using, for example, a guide page 150 shown in FIG. That is, in this case, when there is main information linked with its own sub information or an article related to the main information, the sub user uses the information viewer terminal 500 to use the article IDs 411, 411a, By reading 411n, the guide page 150 of the main information of the article ID is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the own information viewer terminal 500.
  • the secondary user system 300 is the secondary user information viewer terminal 500.
  • the link application information is transferred from the information viewer terminal 500 to the sub information management means 113 of the administrator system 100.
  • the sub information management unit 113 transmits the sub information registration processing operation as described above.
  • the subordinate information registration page UI40 is a user interface (GUI) for the subordinate user to register subordinate information related to his / her product or store via the subordinate user system 300.
  • GUI user interface
  • a first pane PN1 and a second pane PN2 are provided.
  • the first pane PN1 has a sub information input area UI42 and a content confirmation button UI46.
  • the sub information registration page UI40 has a main information display field UI41 as a display field.
  • the main information display column UI41 automatically displays the main information to which the sub information is to be linked.
  • the administrator system 100 uses the main information registration management means 112b for a part of the main information corresponding to the article ID (for example, representative information). Then, it is extracted from the basic information table 122 and displayed on the main information display column UI41.
  • the sub information input area UI42 is an input field for user ID, user name, link destination URL, link destination explanation, supplementary explanation, and other necessary attributes (not shown) as sub information input fields. Is provided.
  • the user ID and the user name are the user ID and the user name registered on the user registration page UI10, and the user ID and the user name are respectively entered in the user ID and user name input fields.
  • the ID and registered user name are automatically displayed.
  • the link destination URL is the URL of the sub information detail page of the sub information linked to the main information.
  • the link destination description is a simple description of the sub information detail page that is the link destination (for example, the name of the related product or the name of the related store that is the title of the web page).
  • the supplementary explanation is, for example, an introduction section (PR sentence) such as a product of sub information or a store. These input items are input by direct input or the like.
  • the sub information input area UI42 is further provided with an input field for geographic information as an input field, and the geographic information input field is based on the geographic information (location information, address, map, map API) of the main user's store. Geographic information etc.) can be input and registered as sub information.
  • the sub information input area UI42 has a thumbnail image input field UI43.
  • the thumbnail image input field UI43 links the path information of the thumbnail image storage destination and the sub information for displaying thumbnails of images such as products related to the sub information on the guide page related to the main information to link the sub information.
  • An API key of a map API for displaying a map of a store or the like related to the sub information is input to a guide page related to the main information to be attached.
  • the API key can be automatically input by selecting the API key or the like.
  • the sub information registration page UI40 has a current access number display field UI47 and a current link number display field UI48 as display fields in the second pane PN2.
  • the current access number display column UI47 displays the total number of accesses to the main information guide page 150 to which the sub information is to be linked up to the present. That is, the administrator system 100 specifies the total access number of the guide page of the main information by the browsing counting means 114b, and the second pane PN2 of the sub information registration page UI40 that is to be linked to the main information.
  • a function for displaying the current access number is realized in the current access number display column UI47 (that is, a current access number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the current link number display column UI48 displays the total number of links of the current (registered) sub information in the main information guide page 150 to which the sub information is to be linked. That is, the administrator system 100 specifies the total number of sub links of the sub information on the main information guide page by the sub URL counting means 1113c and links the main information to the main information registration page UI 40 that is to be linked to the main information.
  • a function for displaying the current link number is realized in the current link number display field UI48 of the pane PN2 (that is, a current link number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the sub user can determine how many accesses the main information to link his / her sub information at the time of linking (that is, from the viewpoint of information viewers, mainly general consumers, From the B2C point of view, the degree of popularity and interest level (hereinafter referred to as “consumer interest level information”) and the number of links (i.e. It is possible to grasp information about the degree of popularity and interest level (hereinafter, also referred to as “commercial interest level information”) from the perspective of a business centered on users and the B2B perspective. In consideration of both the consumer interest level information and the merchant interest level information, it is possible to determine whether or not to link the slave information to the main information.
  • the sub information confirmation page UI50 includes a first pane PN1 and a second pane PN2 corresponding to the configuration of the sub information registration page UI40.
  • the first pane PN1 includes a main information display field UI51, a sub information confirmation area UI 51, and a link application button as the configuration of confirmation items corresponding to the configuration of the display items and input items of the sub information registration page UI 40. It has a UI 54.
  • the main information display column UI51 has the same configuration as the main information display column UI41.
  • the sub information confirmation area UI51 includes display fields such as a user ID, a user name, a link destination URL, a link destination description, and a supplementary description as display columns.
  • the user ID and user name registered on the user registration page UI10 are displayed as the user ID and user name.
  • the link destination URL display column the sub URL input in the link destination URL input column of the sub information registration page UI 40 is displayed.
  • the link destination description display column the description input in the link destination description input column of the sub information registration page UI40 is displayed.
  • the supplementary explanation display field displays the explanation entered in the supplementary explanation entry field of the sub information registration page UI40.
  • the sub information confirmation page UI50 has a thumbnail image display area UI53.
  • the thumbnail image display area UI53 displays the thumbnail image (or map based on the map API) input in the thumbnail image input area UI43 of the sub information registration page UI40.
  • the link application button UI 54 provided on the sub information confirmation page UI 50 is selected and executed so that each data is transmitted to the administrator system 100. And registered in the URL table 123 of the administrator system 100.
  • the sub information registration page UI40A employs a simple configuration as another example of the sub information registration page UI40. That is, in the sub information registration page UI 40A, the sub information input area UI 41A has only the user ID, the link destination URL, and the link destination description.
  • the processing for the secondary user is performed in STEP 21, where the secondary user uses the article ID reading means of the secondary user system 300 to link the secondary information to the article related to the primary information.
  • the administrator system 100 transmits the information on the guide page 150 of the main information to the slave user system 300, and displays the guide page 150 on the registration screen 340 of the slave user system 300 ( For example, for displaying main information).
  • STEP 22 may be omitted.
  • STEP 23 it is determined whether or not the accessed secondary user is a regular secondary user based on the user information such as the user ID input from the secondary user system 300. If it is determined, an error is displayed in STEP24.
  • the administrator system 100 transmits the GUI information on the information registration screen (subordinate information registration page UI 40) according to the subordinate user system 300, and The information registration screen is displayed according to the registration screen 340.
  • the administrator system 100 checks the data of each input item.
  • STEP 27 it is determined whether or not the sub information URL (sub URL) for linking to the main information is input. If it is determined in STEP 27 that the sub URL has not been input, an error display is executed in STEP 28, STEP 25 is executed again, and this series of processing (STEP 25 to STEP 25) is performed until the sub URL is input on the sub information registration screen. STEP 27) is repeated. On the other hand, if it is determined in STEP 27 that a sub URL has been input, in STEP 29, the administrator system 100 creates a sub information confirmation page (sub information confirmation page UI50) and transmits it to the main user system 300. .
  • the administrator system 100 approves the approval method when the sub information is linked in STEP 31.
  • (Approval mode) is determined based on the approval mode selected on the main information registration page UI20.
  • the normal approval routine shown in FIG. On the other hand, if it is determined in STEP 31 that the approval method is the deletion approval mode, the deletion approval routine shown in FIG. 15 is executed by the deletion approval unit in STEP 50.
  • the sub information as the confirmation information is stored and registered in the URL table 123 and registered in the main information in the link registration / page update routine of STEP 60.
  • the slave information is registered as a link, and the content of the guide page (subordinate information-related content) is updated to complete the slave user process.
  • the approval page displays a secondary information detail page (displayed by clicking the secondary URL of the secondary information on the guidance page) for confirmation by the primary user (or an overview of the secondary information detail page).
  • a link approval button (link approval means) such as a delete button and an approval button.
  • the main user determines whether to approve the link application. That is, when the main user does not approve (reject) the link of the sub information applied for the link to his / her main information, the main user selects and executes the delete button or the like on the approval page (that is, , Execute a link approval means for rejection). As a result, the link application is rejected in STEP 45, and the sub information is not linked to the main information. In addition, for the slave information for which the link application has been rejected, even if the link application for the same slave information is subsequently made, the master information in the past based on the slave URL of the slave information in the same URL rejection routine of STEP 46.
  • the deletion approval routine will be described with reference to the flowchart of FIG. First, in the normal approval routine, when there is an application for a link of sub information to specific main information from the sub user system 300, the administrator system 100 provides an approval page to the main user, Whether or not to approve the linking of the subordinate information of the other person to the main information is voluntarily determined before linking the subordinate information, and the main user intends to approve via the main user system 200. Only the subordinate information displayed is registered in the main information as a link to update the guide page.
  • the deletion approval routine when there is an application for subordinate information to the specific main information from the subordinate user system 300, the administrator system 100 does not obtain the approval of the main user, and all of the link applications are received. While the secondary information of the link is registered with the primary information and the guidance page is updated, the third party (usually the primary user or someone other than the secondary user) who viewed the primary information guidance page Provide a function for requesting (applying) link deletion of one (or more) of subordinate information linked to the main information (that is, the administrator system 100 implements such a function as a “link”. It is possible to allow a third party to determine whether or not specific sub information is appropriate as a link target of specific main information. Specifically, in the deletion approval routine, as shown in FIG.
  • step 51 when an application for linking the sub information with respect to specific main information is made from the sub user system 300 to the management system 100, Unlike the normal approval routine, in step 52, the administrator system 100 uses the secondary information registration management means 113b to display the secondary information of the secondary user related to the application (before obtaining the primary user's approval). Immediately register the link to the information, and update the sub-information portion of the main information guide page to include the sub-information applied for the link (that is, the same routine as the link registration / page update process of STEP 50). Process).
  • the administrator system 100 monitors the output from the link deletion application unit for the guidance page whose sub information has been updated, and whether or not a link deletion application for the main information of the sub information has been made. Judging.
  • the link deletion application means can be realized by, for example, a “link deletion application button” or the like provided in the vicinity of the link of each sub-information on the guidance page (for example, on the right side).
  • the sub information registration of the information management system 100 is performed from the information browsing terminal 500 by selecting and executing the link deletion application button.
  • the deletion information may be transmitted to the management unit 113b, and the sub information registration management unit 113b may execute the deletion application process.
  • the administrator system 100 deletes the link of the sub information to the main information related to the application in STEP 55, and updates the guide page of the main information in STEP 56 ( That is, the sub information is deleted and the current link number is decremented and updated).
  • STEP 57 the administrator system 100 transmits a link confirmation mail with a URL return page (for restoring the deleted link) to the main user system 200.
  • the URL restoration page (web page) is displayed on the registration screen 240 of the main user system 200.
  • the URL return page displays the subordinate detailed information page with the link deleted for confirmation by the main user (or a web page on which an outline of the subordinate detailed information page is posted). It has a link deletion approval / return button (link deletion approval / return means) such as a return button.
  • the main user determines whether to approve the deletion of the target sub information link or to restore the link of the sub information whose link has been deleted. That is, when the main user approves the deletion of the link of the sub information whose link has been deleted with respect to his own main information, the main user selects and executes the delete approval button on the URL return page (or The URL return page is terminated without pressing the return button). Thereby, in STEP60, the link deletion state by the administrator system 100 is maintained, and the deleted sub information is not linked to the main information again.
  • the administrator system 100 deletes the specific sub-information whose link to the specific main information has been restored (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “link deleter”) as the same main information.
  • a process of stripping (same deletion main authority stripping process) is executed.
  • the administrator system 100 determines that the link deletion applicant is the one related to the main information in the deletion request determination step of STEP 53. It is determined whether or not the authority to delete the link of the sub information is deprived (for example, based on the user ID of the object), and the link deletion request from the same deletion owner is rejected.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 includes an information browsing unit 510 and an ID reading unit 520.
  • the ID reading means 520 realizes a function of reading the article IDs 411, 411a to 411n attached to the articles 410A, 410B.
  • the information browsing unit 510 realizes a function of displaying the guidance page 150 associated with the article ID read by the ID reading unit 520 on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 510.
  • the ID reading unit 520 includes a decoding unit 521 and a browser activation unit 522.
  • the decoding unit 521 realizes a function of decoding the article ID read by the ID reading unit 520 into data that can be processed by the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the browser activation unit 522 implements a function of activating the web browser (application) of the information viewer terminal 500 using the decoding of the decoding unit 521 as a trigger.
  • the information browsing unit 510 includes a page request unit 511, a page display unit 512, a bookmark unit 513, and a time series display unit 514.
  • the page request unit 511 realizes a function of requesting the page information of the guidance page 150 associated with the article ID read by the ID reading unit 520 to the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100.
  • the page display unit 512 realizes a function of displaying the guidance page 150 on the browsing screen 530 based on the page information transmitted from the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100.
  • the functions of the page request unit 511 and the page display unit 512 can be realized by using the function of the web browser of the information viewer terminal.
  • the bookmark unit 513 is a bookmark unit provided from the bookmark management unit 114c of the administrator system 100.
  • the bookmark unit 513 is a bookmark unit provided from the bookmark management unit 114c of the administrator system 100.
  • the guide page 150 is displayed.
  • a function for managing bookmarks of articles related to the above is realized.
  • the function of the bookmark means 513 can also be realized using the function of the web browser of the information viewer terminal.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 further includes position information providing means 525, time information providing means 526, and access ID providing means 527.
  • the position information providing means 525 is the position information such as GPS installed in the information viewer terminal 500, the position information of the information viewer terminal 500 when the information reader terminal 500 reads the article ID by the ID reading means.
  • a function provided to the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100 is realized using the providing unit.
  • This position information providing function is a function provided by the article ID management means 111 or the browsing management means 114 of the administrator system 100 (for functions other than the position information acquisition function by GPS or the like) (function on the administrator system 100 side). ).
  • the time information providing unit 526 implements the time information (information specifying the year, month, day, hour, minute, and second) at the time when the information reader terminal 500 reads the article ID by the ID reading unit in the information viewer terminal 500.
  • a function provided to the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100 is realized using a clock function or the like. This time information providing function can also be realized by using a function (such as a clock function on the administrator system 100 side) provided from the time information management unit 114d of the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100.
  • the access ID providing unit 527 realizes a function of providing the access ID (terminal ID or user ID) for specifying the information viewer terminal 500 or the viewer.
  • the guide page 150 is a web page that publishes the main information related to one specific article and publishes all sub information linked to the main information related to the article.
  • the guidance page 150 is a user interface (GUI) UI 60 that can be browsed by the information viewer using the information viewer terminal 500, and includes a first pane PN1 and a second pane PN2.
  • the first pane PN1 has a main information display column UI61 and a sub information display column UI62.
  • the main information display column UI61 displays a product image or product description of a product as the specific product as the main information.
  • the sub information display column UI62 displays information such as a store linked to the main information and related products as the sub information.
  • the display information only needs to have at least a link to the sub information detail page having the detailed information of the sub information, and this link is configured, for example, as a link to the title of the sub information detailed page. You can also.
  • store x, store y, etc. are displayed as titles with links to the sub information detail pages. By selecting and executing (clicking etc.) this link, the corresponding sub information details page is displayed. It can be displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the browser terminal 500.
  • a link registration button UI63 is arranged at the lower end of the first pane PN1.
  • the link registration button UI63 displays a signal that becomes the starting point (event trigger) of the subordinate information registration processing operation by the subordinate user system 300 by selection execution (clicking or the like). Realize the function to send to.
  • the current access number display field UI47 and the current link number display field UI48 described in the sub information confirmation page UI50 are displayed as display fields. Then, when the information viewer reads the article IDs 411, 411a, and 411n of the specific articles 410A and 410B of interest by the ID reading unit 520 of the information viewer terminal 500, the decoding unit 521 reads the article IDs 411, 411a, 411n is decoded, and the browser activation unit 522 activates the browser of the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the page requesting unit 511 of the information browsing unit 510 requests the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100 for the main information guide pages 150a, 150b,..., 150n related to the article IDs 411, 411a, and 411n.
  • the page display means of the information viewer terminal 500 is displayed. 512 displays the guide page 150 on the browsing screen 530.
  • the administrator system 100 causes the current access number display column UI47 to display the current access count display field UI47 so that the access count of the information viewer terminal 500 is incremented (by 1) by the browsing counting means 114b of the browsing management means 114.
  • the information page is updated, and the guide page 150 with the updated current access number is transmitted to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the information browsing unit 510 further includes article list display units 513 and 514.
  • the article list display means 513, 514 has a function of displaying a list of specific articles (article groups) related to the main information of the guidance page 150 that the information viewer has browsed (viewed) in the past via the information viewer terminal 500. Is realized.
  • it comprises bookmark means 513 and / or time series display means 514.
  • both the bookmark means 513 and the time-series display means 514 as the article list display means are such that the information viewer reads the article ID of the particular article using the information viewer terminal 500, and the particular article is displayed.
  • the bookmark means 513 and the time-series display means 514 as the article list display means realize a function on the guide page 150 (implement a function corresponding as a client-side or server-side program in a predetermined script language or the like). Provided as implemented as a means.
  • the bookmark means 513 reads the specific article when the information viewer reads the article ID of the specific article by the information viewer terminal 500 and browses the guide page 150 related to the main information of the specific article.
  • a function of bookmarking and managing main information (specifically, representative main information) of a specific article as a physical medium via the bookmark is realized.
  • a bookmark icon BMI is arranged at a predetermined portion (for example, a title bar portion) of the guidance page 150 (UI 60), and the bookmark icon BMI is selected and executed (by clicking or the like).
  • a predetermined bookmark menu (for example, as shown in FIG. 20) is displayed on the guide page 150 (or a bookmark display unit displayed in a separate window or pane from the guide page 150).
  • the bookmark means 513 is a registration function for registering a specific article related to the main information of a specific information page selected by the bookmark unit (registration) in the same manner as a bookmark manager implemented in a normal web browser. Button), list display function (drop-down list, etc.) for displaying registered (bookmarked) items as a list, and selecting and executing a desired item (by mouse click, etc.) from the displayed items.
  • a predetermined function such as an access function for accessing the guide page 150 related to the main information of the article is provided (that is, a function realization means for realizing these functions is provided).
  • the individual function realizing means of the bookmark means 513 will be described in more detail when the bookmark menu is described with reference to FIG.
  • the time series display means 514 displays all the specific articles related to the main information of the guidance page browsed by the information viewer in the past by the information viewer terminal 500 on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 500 in time series. Realize the function. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 17, a time-series display icon TDI is arranged at a predetermined portion (for example, a title bar portion) of the guidance page 150 (UI 60), and the time-series display icon TDI is clicked (by clicking or the like). ) By selecting and executing, an article list as a predetermined time series display list (for example, shown in FIG. 19 and the like) is displayed in a guide window 150 (or a window or a pane separate from the guide page 150).
  • a time-series display icon TDI is arranged at a predetermined portion (for example, a title bar portion) of the guidance page 150 (UI 60), and the time-series display icon TDI is clicked (by clicking or the like).
  • the time-series display means 514 selects and executes one desired article from the displayed articles in the article list as the time-series display list (for example, by clicking with a mouse), thereby obtaining main information of the article.
  • a predetermined function such as an access function for accessing the guide page 150 is provided (that is, a function realization means for realizing those functions is provided).
  • the individual function realizing means of the time series display means 514 will be described in more detail when the article list as the time series display list is described with reference to FIG.
  • the guide page 150 can be embodied as a simple guide page 150 (UI 60A) in which the number of display items is smaller than the guide page 150 (UI 60) in FIG.
  • the guidance page 150 (UI 60A) has a main information display field UI61A of the first pane PN1 that has a smaller number of information items (a smaller amount of information) than that of the guidance page 150 (UI 60).
  • Display information For example, the main information display column UI61A displays a typical attribute description (product name, price, etc.) of an image (product image) of a specific article (product) related to the main information and an attribute (product description). To do.
  • the guidance page 150 displays sub information having a smaller number of information items (a smaller amount of information) than the case of the guidance page 150 (UI 60) in the sub information display field UI 62A of the first pane PN1.
  • the sub information display column UI62A displays a representative attribute description (store name, etc.) of attribute descriptions (product descriptions, etc.) of articles, etc. (products, etc.) related to the sub information.
  • the other configuration of the guidance page 150 (UI 60A) is the same as that of the guidance page 150 (UI 60).
  • the time-series display unit 514 is embodied by an article browsing page TD10 as a GUI displayed in a separate window from the guide page 150 as an example.
  • the article browsing page TD10 is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information browsing terminal 500 when the information browsing terminal 500 accesses the administrator system 100.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 reads the article ID of a specific article and accesses the guidance page 150 of the article, the information viewer terminal 500 displays a window separate from the guidance page 150 (for example, an overlapping display on the guidance page 150)
  • the article browsing page TD10 may be displayed on the browsing screen 530.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 when the information viewer terminal 500 reads the article ID of a specific article and accesses the guide page 150 of the article, the information viewer terminal 500 displays the time series display icon TDI on the guide page 150 and the time series display icon TDI.
  • the article browsing page TD10 may be displayed on the browsing screen 530 by selecting and executing.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 accesses the administrator system 100 without reading the article ID of a specific article (for example, when accessing the administrator system 100 by entering its own user information on the home page of the administrator system 100)
  • the article browsing page TD10 may be displayed on the browsing screen 530.
  • the time series display means 514 realizes a function of displaying the article list TD11 as the time series display list on the article browsing page TD10.
  • information specifying an article related to main information on the guidance page 150 browsed in the past by the information viewer terminal 500 (hereinafter, sometimes referred to as “article specifying information”) is time-series. Is displayed as a list.
  • the article list TD11 may display the article specifying information of the articles related to all the guidance pages 150 browsed in the past. Information (typically, item identification information of only items that are considered most interesting to the viewer) can be displayed.
  • the new browsing time is more. It is preferable to arrange and display so as to be higher.
  • information for specifying an article for example, there is an article name (product name) of the article (for example, a product). Therefore, mixed information combining the article name and the location of the article (the address of the location, etc.) can be used as the article specifying information.
  • the location of the product can be the address of a store or the like that handles the product, but the address information has a large amount of information (number of characters) as the title information, so it is shown as “location A” in FIG.
  • the location information that simply represents the location (for example, address information that can easily grasp a rough location such as a town name or a block name in the address).
  • the time-series display unit 514 as shown in the upper drawing (screen configuration diagram) in FIG. 19, any one item specifying information of the item specifying information listed in the item list TD11. It is also possible to display the detailed information of the location of the item specifying information (that is, the entire address) by specifying the item with mouse over. Further, as shown in the lower drawing (screen configuration diagram) in FIG. 19, the time-series display unit 514 uses any one of the item identification information items listed in the item list TD11 as a mouse. It can also be configured to display the map information MP of the location of the article specifying information by specifying by over.
  • the time-series display means 514 displays the address of the location OB in a map of a certain range including the location of the location of the product (that is, the location of the place where the product is placed, such as a store) OB. It can be configured to be identified and displayed by the pin PN.
  • the time series display means 514 refers to the time when the information viewer terminal 500 browsed the main information guide page related to the article when displaying the article specifying information in the article list TD11, and the new browsing time is displayed.
  • the items specifying information are listed and displayed in order (that is, the one with the most bounced browsing time is displayed at the top, and the browsing times are displayed in the newest order thereafter).
  • the time series display unit 514 can be embodied as a function implementation unit provided from the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100. In this case, the administrator system 100 relates to a specific article.
  • the access ID management unit 114e of the browsing management unit 114 specifies the access ID (user ID or terminal ID) of the information viewer or the information viewer terminal 500 that is the access source. Then, the access time is specified by the time management unit 114d, and the combination information of the access ID and the access time is stored in the browsing history table 124 in association with the product ID of the product. Thereby, when the administrator system 100 is accessed from the information viewer terminal 500 thereafter, the administrator system 100 uniquely identifies the information viewer terminal 500 by the access ID, and assigns it to all the article IDs associated with the access ID.
  • the article specifying information of the article can be displayed in the article list TD11 in time series.
  • the information viewer selects and executes the article specifying information related to the desired article (for which information is desired) from the article specifying information in the article list TD11, the information page 150 of the main information related to the article is displayed. Displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the user terminal 500.
  • the bookmark means 513 is embodied by an article browsing page BM20 as a GUI displayed in a separate window from the guide page 150, like the time-series display means 514.
  • the article browsing page BM20 is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 500 when the information viewer terminal 500 accesses the administrator system 100, as with the time-series display unit 514.
  • the bookmark means 513 realizes a function of displaying the bookmark menu BM21 on the article browsing page BM20.
  • This bookmark menu BM21 is a time series of information (article specifying information) for specifying an article registered as a bookmark among articles related to main information of a guidance page browsed in the past by the information viewer terminal 500. List display.
  • article specifying information the same article specifying information as in the article list TD11 can be used.
  • the bookmark unit 513 displays any one item identification information among the item identification information listed in the bookmark menu BM21 as shown in FIG. By specifying with a mouse over or the like, detailed information on the location of the article specifying information (that is, the entire address) can be displayed. Further, as in the case of the time-series display unit 514, the bookmark unit 513 specifies any one item specifying information among the item specifying information displayed in the list in the bookmark menu, so that the location of the item specifying information is determined. The map information can be displayed.
  • the bookmark unit 513 displays the item identification information in a list in order of new browsing time when displaying the item identification information in the bookmark menu BM21.
  • the information viewer selects and executes the article specifying information related to the desired article (to obtain information) from the article specifying information of the bookmark menu BM21, the information page 150 of the main information related to the article is displayed. Displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the user terminal 500.
  • the article browsing page TD10 shown in FIG. 20 is configured to display the article specifying information of the article related to the main information in the article list TD11 so that the article guide page 150 can be accessed with one click.
  • the article browsing page TD30 shown in FIG. 22 allows the article list TD31 to be accessed with one click to the article information page 150 related to the main information, and is linked to the main information of each article.
  • the sub information detail page of the sub information can be accessed with one click.
  • the time-series display means 514 specifies any one item specifying information among the item specifying information displayed in the list in the item list TD31 by, for example, mouse-over, so that the location of the item specifying information is determined.
  • subordinate information specifying information specifying the sub information linked to the main information of the article related to the article specifying information
  • subordinate information specifying information specifying the sub information linked to the main information of the article related to the article specifying information
  • the time-series display unit 514 is configured to display the address information and the map information MP of the location of the subordinate information specifying information such as a product or a store in the subordinate information list TD32 in the same manner as the article list TD11.
  • the article browsing page CA is configured to display article specifying information related to the specific article in a calendar format.
  • the time-series display unit 514 is based on the access time to the guide page 150 of a specific article registered by the administrator system 100 in association with the access ID of the specific information viewer or the information viewer terminal 500.
  • an article browsing page CA which is a calendar-type user interface (GUI) is created and displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the time-series display unit 514 displays a list of the article specifying information of the article related to the guide page 150 viewed by the information viewer of the access ID or the information viewer terminal 500 in each date column of the article browsing page CA.
  • GUI calendar-type user interface
  • the time-series display means 514 browses the guidance page 150 browsed on the date by the information viewer of the access ID or the information viewer terminal 500 in each date column of the article browsing page CA.
  • the number is displayed (for example, the number of browsing is “1” on January 5th, the number of browsing is “2” on January 13th), and the number of browsing is selected and executed by clicking the mouse etc.
  • the article specifying information of the article related to the guided page 150 can be configured to be displayed as the browse list L. This configuration can be embodied as the same configuration in the bookmark menu by the bookmark means 513.
  • the bookmark process executed using the bookmark means 513 will be described.
  • the administrator system 100 uses the information viewer terminal 500 in STEP 72.
  • the information viewer determines whether or not he / she has logged in by inputting his / her registration information (user ID, etc.) in the case of a registered user.
  • the user is identified based on the ID.
  • the administrator system 100 determines the presence / absence of the terminal ID of the information viewer terminal 500. Identify uniquely.
  • the administrator system 100 executes exception processing in STEP 76.
  • the bookmark unique to the user or the information viewer terminal 500 is specified.
  • Means 513 that is, bookmark means 513 for displaying the bookmark menu of the article specifying information unique to the user or the information viewer terminal 500 is provided to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • This bookmark process can also be applied to the article list display process (time series display process) by the time series display means 514. That is, in the time series display processing in this case, the same processing is executed from the above STEP 71 to STEP 76.
  • the time series display means 514 that is, the user or information
  • the information viewer terminal 500 is provided with time series display means 514) for displaying the article list of the article specifying information unique to the browser terminal 500.
  • the display order of the item identification information in the item list by the time series display unit 514 or the bookmark unit 513 is basically such that, as described above, the browsing time of the guide page 150 related to the item identification information is higher than the latest one. Display order. Moreover, even if the information page displayed in the lower order in this display order with respect to the guidance page 150 browsed in the past by the information viewer or the information viewer terminal 500, the article specifying information related to the guidance page 150 browsed again most recently is the most It can be configured to display at the top (that is, to perform processing that pushes the rank higher).
  • the information page 150 that has been browsed in the past by the information viewer or the information viewer terminal 500 is displayed in the upper order in this display order, even within the latest fixed period (for example, the most recent month, the most recent week) Etc.), the item specifying information related to the guidance page 150 that has not been browsed again can be displayed at a lower level or excluded from the display target.
  • the latest information among the item specifying information related to the guide page 150 that the information viewer or the information viewer terminal 500 has browsed in the past is used. It is preferable to display only those items (for example, for the most recent month, for the most recent one week, for the most recent three days, for the most recent one day, etc.).
  • the data stored in the browsing history table 124 by the browsing management unit 114 of the administrator system 100 includes the most recent fixed period (for example, the most recent one year, the most recent six months, the most recent three months, the most recent one month, etc.). can do.
  • Embodiment 2 [Overview of configuration of administrator system of this information provision system] As shown in FIG. 25, the information providing system using the physical medium according to the second embodiment of the present invention is different from the information providing system according to the first embodiment in the configuration of the administrator system 1100.
  • the administrator system 1100 includes information management means and a management information database 1120, as with the administrator system 100 of the first embodiment.
  • the information management unit of the second embodiment has basically the same configuration as the information management unit 110 of the administrator system 100 of the first embodiment, but the information management database 1120 is the management of the first embodiment.
  • a node table 1121 is provided instead of the article ID table 121 of the person system 100, and a link table 1123 is provided instead of the URL table 123.
  • the information management means of the administrator system 1100 includes NODE_ID management means 1111 instead of the article ID management means 111 of the information management means 110 of the administrator system 100 of the first embodiment.
  • the administrator system 1100 also includes a basic information table 1122 corresponding to the basic information table 122 of the administrator system 100 according to the first embodiment, and a browsing corresponding to the browsing history table 124 of the administrator system 100 according to the first embodiment.
  • a history table 1124 is provided.
  • the node table 1121 is a table for storing and managing a local ID (article ID) such as an article related to the main information, a sub URL of sub information, and related information thereof.
  • Column name includes NODE_ID (hereinafter also referred to as “node ID”), user ID, NODE_TYPE (hereinafter also referred to as “node type”), URL, issue date, and valid flag.
  • NODE_ID hereinafter also referred to as “node ID”
  • user ID hereinafter also referred to as “node type”
  • URL issue date
  • Each value is stored in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the user ID, issue date, and valid flag are the same information as the user ID, issue date, and valid flag in the article ID table 121 of the first embodiment.
  • the node table 1121 may further store the value of geographic information in the article ID table 121 of the first embodiment.
  • Embodiment 1 a local ID (article ID) is assigned to each specific object in order to uniquely identify a specific object (specific article, specific product, etc.) that is the main information providing source.
  • a URL is assigned according to each sub information. That is, IDs of different systems (that is, two types of IDs including an item ID and a sub URL) are assigned to an article or the like related to main information and a web page related to sub information.
  • the article ID of the article (product etc.) related to the main information is the parent node, and the child ID is placed under the article ID as each parent node.
  • a node a tree-structured data structure is formed in which subordinate URLs constituting subordinate information (URLs of subordinate information detail pages of related stores and the like) are linked in a tree shape.
  • a child node (secondary URL) linked to the same article ID (parent node) is a sibling node.
  • a child node (store A) N12a, a child node (store B) N13a, and a child node (store C) N14a are linked under the parent node (product X) N11a.
  • FIG. 29 shows an example in which an NFC tag is used as an ID medium to be attached to an article, and NFC_ID is used as the article ID.
  • the ID medium is another medium (for example, a two-dimensional barcode) ID) corresponding to the ID medium.
  • a node ID that is, one type of ID
  • a node type is assigned to the article related to the main information and the web page related to the sub information. That is, the article related to the main information and the web page related to the sub information are identified by the composite key based on the node ID and the node type. Specifically, as shown in FIG.
  • node IDs are assigned in the order in which the main user registers the article related to the main information in the administrator system 100.
  • NFC_ID is used as an ID for the article.
  • the ID medium is another medium (for example, a two-dimensional bar).
  • the ID corresponds to the ID medium.
  • a node ID given to the article related to the main information is an ID corresponding to the local ID
  • a node ID given to the URL related to the sub information is an ID corresponding to the URL ID and Become.
  • the type name of the name corresponding to the type of the ID medium assigned to the article is assigned as the node type to the article related to the main information.
  • a type name such as “NFC” is assigned as a node type to an article.
  • a type name (for example, “2D_BC”) representing the ID medium is assigned to the article as a node type.
  • URL is assigned to the sub URL related to the sub information as the node type and the type name of the name corresponding to the type of the link information of the sub information.
  • a node ID for specifying one article (product or the like) constituting the main information becomes one node
  • the sub-URLs of one sub-information linked to the nodes of the articles related to the two main information become nodes that connect the nodes of the articles related to the two main information, and the nodes of these sub-URLs
  • a data structure having a network structure in which nodes of two articles are connected is formed.
  • the network structure N20 as an example shown in FIG. 30, there is a first node N21 composed of an article node (product X), and the secondary URL of the secondary information linked to the node N21 of the article.
  • a second node N22 consisting of a store node (store A) related to sub information
  • a third node N23 consisting of a store node (store B) related to another sub information
  • another sub information There is a fourth node N24 composed of the store node (store C).
  • a fifth node N25 consisting of an article node (product Y), and with respect to the article node N25, the second node N22, the third node N23, and the fourth node
  • the first node N21 and the second node N25 both of which are articles nodes, are connected to the second node N22 and the third node of the slave information.
  • a network structure connected by the node N23 and the fourth node N24 is formed.
  • a sixth node N26 composed of a store node (store D) related to another sub-information and a seventh node N27 composed of a store node (store E) related to another sub-information If present, and if these nodes N26, N27 are not linked to any article nodes N21, N25, these nodes N26, N27 are not involved in the network structure.
  • the information providing system between the main information of the article relating to the article ID as the parent node and the slave information relating to the slave URL (such as a store related to the article) as the child node.
  • a link is formed, but no link is formed between the parent node and another parent node.
  • a link is formed between the main information of the article related to the node ID as one node and the main information of the article related to the node ID as the other node.
  • a link is formed through the node ID of the slave information.
  • a node related to the main information (a node such as an NFC tag related to an article or the like) may be hereinafter referred to as a “main node”, and a node related to the sub information (node of a sub URL) ) May be hereinafter referred to as “secondary node”.
  • the node ID and the node type are unique data used to construct the network configuration of the second embodiment.
  • the URL of the node table 1121 is not the slave URL of the slave information as the node, but the master URL of the main information guide page.
  • the basic information table 1122 has the same configuration as the basic information table 122 of the first embodiment, except that the article ID of the basic information table 122 of the first embodiment is replaced with a node ID.
  • the link table 1123 indicates that when a node ID is assigned to a specific article, a main URL (URL of the node table 1121) assigned in correspondence with the node ID and a node ID are assigned to the sub URL of the sub information. It is a table for storing and managing link information with subordinate URLs assigned in correspondence with the node ID, and NODE_ID, LINK_ID (hereinafter referred to as “link ID”) as field names (column names or column names). ), The creation date and time, and the link strength, and each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple). Note that the link table 1123 may store a user ID (particularly, a user ID of a secondary user), as with the URL table 123 of the first embodiment.
  • the node ID of the link table 1123 is the node ID described in the node table 1121.
  • the link ID is an ID for uniquely identifying link information between the node of the article and the node of the sub information, and is associated with a node ID of one article (that is, a node ID related to one main information).
  • the node ID of the sub information is a unique ID that is assigned every time the sub information is linked, and each of the node ID related to the main information and the node ID related to the sub information linked to each other via the link ID.
  • the data is stored in the link table 1122 in association with each other. For example, as shown as an example in FIG.
  • the link ID is L01. Is assigned, and a link is established between the first node N21 and the third node N23 (node related to subordinate information), L02 is assigned as the link ID, and the first node N21 and the fourth node When a link is established with N24 (node related to sub information), L03 is assigned as a link ID, and a link is established between the fifth node N25 (node related to main information) and the second node N22.
  • L04 When a link is established, L04 is assigned as the link ID, and when a link is established between the fifth node N25 and the third node N23, L05 is assigned as the link ID. Devoted, if the link is established between the fifth node N25 and the fourth node N24, L06 is assigned as a link ID.
  • the link ID is stored in the link table 1122 in association with the node ID related to the main information, and is stored in the link table 1122 in association with the node ID related to the sub information.
  • the link ID (L01) is stored in association with the node ID of the first node N21 related to the main information and stored in association with the node ID of the second node N22 related to the sub information. .
  • the link ID for each of the node IDs (the node ID related to the main information and the node ID related to the sub information) (that is, the node ID of the main information and the node of the sub information having the same link ID)
  • the ID By extracting the ID, it can be determined that the node ID of the main information and the node ID of the sub information are linked to each other via the link ID, and which node the main information relates to It is possible to specify whether a link is established between the ID and the node ID related to which slave information.
  • one of the two linked node IDs is the node ID (NFC_ID etc.) related to the main information, and the rest It can be confirmed that the other is the node ID (URL) related to the slave information.
  • the creation date and time is the date and time when the node ID was created (allocated) (time information consisting of the year, month, day, and second), and is stored in the link table 1122 in association with each node ID.
  • the creation date and time of the node ID for example, when a plurality of sub information is posted on the main information guide page 150, refer to the creation date and time of the node ID related to each sub information.
  • These pieces of sub information can be arranged and displayed in order of new node ID creation date and time (that is, in the latest order of creation), and the sub information registered for each main information guide page 150 is changed over time. It can be displayed in order from the latest (along the time axis).
  • the link strength is an index indicating the strength of the link between the node IDs of the articles related to the two pieces of main information in which mutual links are formed by the node IDs of the sub information, and the nodes related to the two pieces of main information making a pair It is stored in the link table 1122 in association with each ID. For example, as shown in FIG. 31, when the node N31 of the article and the node N32 of the article are registered in the administrator system 100 (both as nodes related to the main information), both of the nodes N31 and N32 are registered.
  • the link strength of both the nodes N31 and N32 becomes zero (that is, the two nodes N31 and N32 are not indirectly connected via the subordinate information link). In the network structure, the nodes are not related to each other).
  • the article node N31 and the article node N32 are registered in the administrator system 100, one slave information node linked to both the nodes N31 and N32 is registered. Is registered in association with one link ID (L1) in both node IDs of both nodes N31 and N32, and the link strength is “1” (that is, both nodes N31 and N32 are 1).
  • ⁇ Example of link strength between main nodes 1> Specifically, as shown in FIG. 32, it is assumed that a mandarin orange node N40, an apple node N50, and a chocolate node N60 are registered in the administrator system 100 as article nodes. In this case, a specific supermarket that handles (sells) mandarin oranges and apples and a specific grocery store that handles (sells) mandarin oranges and apples respectively have their own slave information node N41 and slave information node N43. When linking and registering to both the orange node N40 and the apple node N50, the link strength between the orange node N40 and the apple node N50 is “2”.
  • the link strength between the node N50 and the chocolate node N60 is “1”.
  • a specific tangerine plant that handles (produces) mandarin orange registers its subordinate information node N42 by linking it to the mandarin orange node N40, the node N42 links to the node of another article. If not, the node N42 is not involved in the link strength of the article.
  • the node N61 links to a node of another article. If not attached, the node N42 is not involved in the link strength of the article.
  • the subordinate user when the subordinate user links his subordinate information to the main information of a specific article, the subordinate user does not need to be aware of the link of his subordinate information to the main information. It is only necessary to register the slave URL of the slave information in the master information related to the article. That is, in this case, the administrator system 100 executes the linking of the sub information to the main information as described above. In addition, it seems that the slave user has registered a new URL (subordinate URL) for the main information, but in actuality, only the link to the main information is executed using the existing URL. It is. Furthermore, in this case, two articles having a high link strength (a large number of links) do not need to be classified by category, and can be grouped as similar items via the link strength.
  • NFC tags which are physical media distributed in the real world, are connected to each other via existing Internet links.
  • the reason why the URL on the Internet is also a node is because an unrelated Internet URL is also connected through an NFC node or the like.
  • Example 2 of link strength between main nodes As an example of the sub information node that connects the nodes of the article related to the main information, as shown in FIG. 33, the node N70 of Ehime orange is registered in the administrator system 100 as the node related to the main information. In this case, the sub user uses “https://sample.com/shop/fruits/range/1” as the node N71 of his / her sub information (web page having contents of Ehime orange) related to Ehime orange. As a slave URL of slave information, an arbitrary URL (as shown in a broken-line rectangle) is registered as a slave URL between the upper hierarchy and the lowest hierarchy of the slave URL. It becomes possible.
  • the secondary user can download his / her sub information related to the San Fuji apple (San Fuji apple content).
  • the node N81 of the web page has “https://sample.com/shop/fruits/apple/2”
  • the slave URL of the slave information is the highest from the upper hierarchy of the slave URL.
  • Arbitrary URLs (as shown in the broken rectangle) can be registered as sub URLs up to the lower hierarchy.
  • sub users register and register sub URLs of their sub information about Ehime oranges and San Fuji apples as products, a maximum of five for each of Ehime oranges and San Fuji apples.
  • the sub URLs of the sub information can be linked.
  • the link ID for one article node of the slave URL is The link ID of the slave URL is different from the link ID for the other article node.
  • the link between two articles is linked by two link IDs, such as the link between the node N70 and the node N90 described below.
  • the sub user's sub information web site is a net shop of the domain “https://sample.com”
  • the operation of this net shop As a secondary user, who has purchased a mandarin orange at this net shop, can analogize when he wants to purchase an apple, naturally, Sea urchin the link strength as "3") to increase the mutual relevance.
  • the common URLs (“https://sample.com/shop” and “https://sample.com/shop”) are There are two (link strength “2”), and the degree of association is low.
  • the registration of the secondary URL to the administrator system 100 is registration based on input using the guide page 150 or the like, but the secondary information related to the primary information is automatically determined by artificial intelligence or the like. It can also be configured to automatically register (automatically link).
  • the administrator system 1100 forms a link between two nodes of the main information by the nodes of the sub information (that is, the total number of the links of the sub information connecting the nodes related to the two main information is determined as the specific main information. Contrary to the process of acquiring the link strength of the main node according to the above, the two sub information nodes paired via the main information node are connected to form a link between the sub information nodes (ie, It is also possible to obtain the total number of links of the main information that links the nodes related to the two subordinate information forming a pair as the link strength of the subordinate node related to the specific subordinate information or the subordinate URL).
  • the sub URL of the sub information is also a node, as shown in FIG. 36, the node N 110 of sub information (the sub user is a supermarket) and the node N 120 of sub information (the sub user is a convenience store) Can be linked to each other by nodes N70 and N80 (both related to the main information) as commodities nodes common to those sub users.
  • the field “valid flag” is set to “invalid”.
  • the node ID for the node N132 becomes invalid, and as a result, the link from the node N132 of the sub information to the node N130 of the main information is deleted.
  • the URL of the sub information (sub URL) itself is not deleted from the node table. Therefore, when it is desired to restore the link of the deleted secondary information node N132 to the primary information node N130 (before deletion) at a later date, the field “valid flag” in the node table data for the secondary information node N132 is set to “ Set it to Enabled again.
  • the node ID for the node N132 becomes valid, and as a result, the link from the node N132 of the sub information to the node N130 of the main information is restored.
  • the URL (sub URL) of the sub information node can be added to the black list (for example, entering the black list) It is also possible to provide a flag field in the node table for determining whether or not the flag is valid).
  • the browsing history table 1124 has the same configuration as the browsing history table 124 of the first embodiment, except that the article ID of the browsing history table 124 of the first embodiment is replaced with a node ID.
  • the NODE_ID management unit (node ID management unit) 1111 of the information management unit of the administrator system 1100 according to the second embodiment includes a NODE_ID issuing unit (node ID issuing unit) 1111a, a corresponding URL issuing unit 1111b, and a LINK_ID management unit (link). ID management means) 1111c.
  • the node ID issuing unit 1111a corresponds to the article ID issuing unit 111a of the first embodiment, and issues a unique node ID when a request for issuing an ID related to a specific article is received from the main user system 200.
  • the node ID is stored in the node table 1121 in association with the user ID of the main user of the main user system 200, and the node type of the node ID is set according to the type of the ID medium (for example, the ID medium is NFC).
  • the ID medium for example, the ID medium is NFC.
  • NFC NFC
  • the node ID (corresponding to the article ID) is attached to the article in the same manner as the article ID in the first embodiment.
  • the node ID issuing unit 1111a issues a unique node ID when the slave user system 300 requests to link the slave information related to the article related to the specific master information.
  • the node ID is stored in the node table 1121 in association with the user ID of the slave user of the slave user system 300, and the node type of the node ID is determined according to the type of link information of the slave information (ie, typically Since the link information is a URL, it is stored as “URL”) in the node table 1121 in association with the node ID.
  • Corresponding URL issuing means 1111b corresponds to main URL issuing means 111b of the first embodiment.
  • the corresponding URL issuing means 1111b is used for a guide page of main information of the article related to the node ID.
  • a new URL is issued (or an existing URL is used), and the URL is stored in the node table 1121 in association with the node ID.
  • the corresponding URL issuing unit 1111b issues a node ID for the sub information related to the specific article as described above, a new URL is added for the sub information detailed page of the sub information report related to the node ID. Is issued (or an existing URL is used), and the URL is stored in the node table 1121 in association with the node ID.
  • Link ID management means When the link ID management unit 1111c issues the node ID for the slave information related to the specific article as described above, the node ID of the master node related to the article and the node ID of the slave node related to the slave information And the link ID is associated with the node ID of the main node and stored in the link table 1123, and the link ID (same link ID) is stored as the node ID of the subnode. And stored in the link table 1123.
  • the link ID management unit 1111c stores the time when the link ID is issued for the link between the node ID of the main node and the node ID of the sub node in the link table 1123 in association with the node ID of the main node. And stored in the link table 1123 in association with the node ID of the slave node.
  • the main information management unit 112 executes the same process as the process related to the article ID in the first embodiment as the process related to the node ID of the main node related to the specific article. For each node ID of the main node, main information related to the article is stored in the basic information table 1122. Further, the slave information management unit 113 of the second embodiment executes the same process as the slave information in the first embodiment as a process related to the node ID of a specific slave node, and for each node ID of the slave node, The slave information is stored in the administrator system 1100 and registered.
  • the browsing management unit 114 of the second embodiment performs the same process as the browsing process of the guidance page related to the article ID of the specific article in the first embodiment.
  • the browsing process is executed, and the browsing information of the main information related to the article is stored in the browsing history table 1124 for each node ID of the main node.
  • the subordinate information management unit 113 of the second embodiment executes the same process as that of the subordinate information in the first embodiment. For example, for each node ID related to the subordinate information in the node table 1121, the existing self Processing such as providing the URL of the web page (as the URL of the secondary information detail page) for storing the URL in the node table 1121 is executed.
  • the network structure as the link structure can be applied as a recipe for cooking, for example.
  • a recipe carrots are registered as cooking ingredients in the first node, and recipe A (curry), recipe B (meat potato), recipe C (as a recipe using carrots) are registered in the second node.
  • recipe A curry
  • recipe B meal potato
  • recipe C as a recipe using carrots
  • the link strength is the thickness of the link, and the link strength 3 is the link thickness of “3”.
  • the “link strength” column is added to the link table 1123. Provide. Then, when the link is made for the first time, the first link strength is stored in the link table. Thereafter, the link strength is updated, and if the number of links increases, the link strength increases.
  • the administrator system 1100 for each node ID (main node ID) related to the main information, in the link table 1123, the node ID related to the sub information Whether or not there is a slave node ID linked to each of the node IDs (master node IDs) related to the two master information that make a pair, while storing the link ID representing the link with the slave node ID (And the number, if any) is determined, and the link strength is calculated based on the total number of links (that is, the total number of links is used as a link strength value). Yes.
  • the administrator system 1100 can also be configured to execute various predetermined processes based on the stored link strength value.
  • the administrator system 1100 has a function realization means necessary for executing the link strength storage processing and other processing. (Hereinafter, it may be referred to as “link strength management means.”),
  • the configuration shown in FIG. 38 is provided.
  • the configuration of another example of the second embodiment, such as the link strength management means, will be described in detail with reference to FIGS.
  • FIG. 38 mainly illustrates the configuration necessary for the description of the link strength management means in the configuration of the administrator system 1100 of the second embodiment shown in FIG. 25, and a part of other configurations (FIG.
  • the NODE_ID management unit 1111 and the basic information table 1122 shown in FIG. 25 are not shown, but the administrator system 1100 naturally has these configurations.
  • the administrator system 1100 stores a node table 1121A corresponding to the node table 1121 of the second embodiment. And a link table 1123A corresponding to the link table 1123 of the second embodiment. Further, the administrator system 1100 includes a strength table 1125 and a URL table 1126 in addition to the table configuration of the administrator system 1100 of the second embodiment.
  • the administrator system 1100 includes main information management means 112A corresponding to the main information management means 112 shown in FIG.
  • the main information management unit 112A further includes a link strength calculation unit 112c in addition to the configuration of the main information management unit 112.
  • the configuration of the strength table 1125, the URL table 1126, and the link strength calculation unit 112c will be described in detail.
  • the administrator system 1100 in FIG. 25 is configured to store the link strength value in the link table 1123. However, the administrator system 1100 in FIG. 38 does not store the link strength value in the link table 1123A.
  • An intensity table 1125 is provided for storing the values. Specifically, the strength table 1125 has NODE_ID (node ID) and link strength as field names (column names or column names), and stores each value in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple). To do.
  • the node ID is the node ID described in the node table 1121. As described above, a link is formed between the two main nodes of the main information paired by the sub nodes of the sub information, and the pairs are formed.
  • the strength table only the node ID of the main node (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “main node ID”) is stored in the strength table. Good.
  • main node ID the node ID of the main node
  • the strength table only needs to store the node ID of the slave node (hereinafter also referred to as “subordinate node ID”).
  • a link between two master nodes of the master information paired with the slave nodes of the slave information is formed, and the total number of links of the slave nodes that connect the two master nodes of the pair is determined (for the master node).
  • the link strength value In addition to setting the link strength value, a link between two slave nodes of a pair of slave information paired by the master node of the master information is formed, and the link of the master node connecting the two slave nodes of the pair
  • the strength table stores the primary node ID and the secondary node ID. Will do.
  • the administrator system 1100 of FIG. 25 is configured to store the URL (the main URL of the main information guide page and the sub URL of the sub information) in the node table 1121, but the administrator system 1100 of FIG. While the URL value is not stored in the node table 1121A, a URL table 1126 is provided for storing the URL.
  • the URL table 1126 has NODE_ID (node ID) and URL as field names (column names or column names), and stores each value in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the node ID is the node ID described in the node table 1121.
  • the URL is the main URL of the main information guide page and the sub URL of the sub information. In the configuration of FIG.
  • the node table 1121 is used to determine whether each node ID is a primary node or a secondary node according to its node type as described above.
  • the main URL or the sub URL is acquired by the associated URL.
  • the node table 1121A is used to determine whether each node ID is a primary node or a secondary node according to its node type.
  • the associated URL (main URL or sub URL) is acquired using the URL table 1126.
  • the link strength calculation means 112c is a link strength of the main node related to the main information (that is, the total number of links of the slave nodes that connect one specific main node to another specific main node), and / or A function of calculating the link strength of the slave node related to the slave information (that is, the total number of links of the master node connecting one specific slave node to another specific slave node) is realized.
  • the link strength calculating unit 112c is configured as a function realizing unit for calculating the link strength between two paired main nodes, a series of procedures (link strength calculating process) as shown in FIG. Cause the computer device to execute.
  • the link strength calculation process of FIG. 39 is an example, and the link strength calculation means 112c can also calculate the link strength by other link strength calculation processing.
  • Link strength calculation processing Specifically, as shown in FIG. 39, in the link strength calculation process, in STEP 81, node IDs of all the main nodes (for example, the product IDs of products with NFC tags attached) are acquired in the strength table 1125. In STEP 82, the link strength value of the main node of each node ID is set to “0” (that is, initialized) in the strength table 1125.
  • the link strength calculation means 112c may be referred to as a monitoring process (hereinafter referred to as “subordinate link monitoring process”) that determines at a predetermined timing whether or not a new subordinate node has been linked to one main node.
  • a new slave node is linked to the one master node, whether or not there is another master node to which the slave node is linked (that is, the master node is connected via the slave node).
  • To determine whether or not the main node and other main nodes are indirectly linked to each other (hereinafter, referred to as “indirect link determination processing”), and such other main nodes Exists (that is, when an indirect link is formed between one master node and another master node via its slave node), the link is established for one master node and the other master node, respectively.
  • Degrees to "1" increases processing (hereinafter sometimes referred to as "link strength increasing process”.) Is executed.
  • the link strength calculating means 112c is determined in STEP83 at a predetermined timing in the link table 1123A, the node ID (main node ID) and link ID of one main node. , It is determined whether or not there is a slave node linked to the one master node (that is, a slave node having the same link ID as the link ID of the one master node is searched). For example, the link strength calculating means 112c may change the slave node related to the new slave information to the master information of the one master node when a new slave node is linked to one master node (for example, in the process of FIG.
  • the link strength calculating means 112c determines whether or not there is another master node to which the slave node is linked in the link table 1123A (that is, the same link as the node ID of the slave node). Search for other main nodes with ID). If the link strength calculation means 112c determines in STEP 85 that there is no other main node linked to the slave node, the link strength calculation processing ends. On the other hand, when the link strength calculating unit 112c determines in STEP 85 that there is another main node linked to the slave node, the link strength calculating unit 112c determines in STEP 86 that the node ID (main node ID) of the other main node is used. ) To get. In STEP 87, the link strength calculating unit 112c sets the link strength value of each node ID to “1” for the two main nodes (one main node and the other main node) acquired in the strength table 1125. To increase.
  • the link strength calculation means 112c executes the processing of STEP 84 to STEP 87 each time a new slave node is linked to one main node. This allows two master nodes in a pair (one master node and another master node) to be indirectly linked to each other via one or more slave nodes linked to each of them.
  • One or two or more indirect links will be formed between two paired main nodes (one main node and another main node). For example, in the example of FIG. 30, three indirect links are formed between one master node N21 and another master node N25 via three slave nodes N22, N23, and N24.
  • the link strength calculation means 112c is configured to replace the main node portion and the subordinate node portion with each other in the series of steps shown in FIG. It can be configured as a function realization means for calculating the intensity.
  • Examples of link strength of indirect link between main nodes are shown in FIGS.
  • the strength table 1125 indicates that different physical nodes (n1, n2) as two paired main nodes are not directly linked.
  • the physical nodes (n1, n2) are only indirectly linked through links from the websites (s1, s2) that are the slave nodes.
  • the link between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 is linked by forming a new link of the website s2 from the link strength “1” by the link of only the website s1 at the beginning. It shows that the strength is “2”.
  • the total number of links between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 (the total number of link IDs via the slave nodes) is four, but each of the websites s1 and s2 has two links.
  • the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 are linked, and as a result, the link strength between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 is “2”.
  • the physical link strength between them is “1”. It becomes.
  • the physical link strength between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 since the indirect link between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 does not have a link by the website s1 or the website s2, the physical link strength between them is “0”. .
  • the physical link strength between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 is “0” because there is no link by the websites s1, s2, etc.
  • the physical node n2 has one link to the website s1 and the website s2, and the physical node n1 has two links to the website s3 and the website s4, respectively. Since there is no website that links the physical node n1 and the physical node n2, the physical link strength between the physical node n1 and the physical node n2 is “0”.
  • the link between the master node and the slave node is a direct link (that is, link information between the master node and the slave node can be directly obtained from the link table 1123A.
  • the link between the two master nodes that make a pair becomes an indirect link via the slave node (that is, the two master nodes that make a pair are the first by the above link strength calculation processing based on the link information of the link table 1123A).
  • Link information between nodes can be obtained indirectly).
  • the physical node is a main node related to the article described in the first embodiment and the like, and is created for a physical medium made of an article such as a product.
  • the information indicating the link strength between the physical nodes can be the above strength table or logical expression. However, when the logical expression is used, the (physical) access speed is high. Therefore, it is preferable to use an intensity table because the processing becomes complicated.
  • Embodiment 3 [Overview of the comparison with Embodiments 1 and 2]
  • the information providing system using the physical medium according to the third embodiment of the present invention includes the administrator systems 100 and 1100, the primary user system 200, the secondary user system 300, and the physical system according to the first and second embodiments.
  • an administrator system 2100, an advertising medium main system 2200, an advertiser system 2300, and an advertising medium providing place 2400 are provided. That is, in the information providing system according to the first and second embodiments, basic information about a specific article placed in a store or the like in a specific place is provided as main information, and a specific article is used as subordinate information.
  • the administrator system 100, 1100 gives an article ID as a unique local ID to the specific article, and information browsing of general consumers, etc.
  • the user can acquire the main information of the article by reading the article ID of the article using the information viewer terminal 500, and the sub user who is the owner of the sub information is assigned to the specific article.
  • information subordinates who have viewed the main information of the article can be provided with the subordinate information, and as described above, To demonstrate the effect of the species.
  • the information providing system provides, as main information, medium information related to an advertising medium that is a specific physical medium arranged at a specific location, and advertisement related to a specific product or service as subordinate information.
  • the information is provided, and the administrator system 2100 assigns a place ID as a unique local ID to the specific advertisement medium, and an information viewer such as a general consumer uses the information viewer terminal 500 to specify a specific advertisement.
  • the main information of the advertisement medium can be obtained, and the advertiser who is the owner of the sub information posts his / her advertisement information in the medium information related to the specific advertisement medium.
  • the administrator system 2100 includes an information management unit 2110 and a management information database 2120, similar to the administrator systems 100 and 1100 of the first and second embodiments.
  • the information management unit 2110 has basically the same configuration as the information management unit of the administrator system 1100 of the second embodiment shown in FIG. Node management unit 2121 corresponding to the node ID management unit 1111, main information management unit 2122 corresponding to the main information management unit 112 of the second embodiment, link information between the main node and the subnode, etc. of the second embodiment Advertisement space management means 2113 corresponding to the link table (as management means) and browsing management means 2114 corresponding to browsing management means 114 of the second embodiment.
  • the information management database 2120 has basically the same configuration as the information management database 1220 of the administrator system 1100 according to the second embodiment.
  • the advertisement space table 2123 is provided.
  • the configuration of the information management database 2120 will be described in detail.
  • the physical node table 2121 of the information management database 2120 corresponds to the node table 1121 of the second embodiment, and stores information on the physical node that is the main node in the third embodiment (specifically, an advertising medium as a physical medium). It is a table for storing and managing.
  • the physical node table 2121 includes a node ID that is a local ID of a physical medium (advertisement medium) as a main node related to the main information of the third embodiment, and related information such as a location of the advertisement medium.
  • the user ID, issue date, and valid flag are the same information as the user ID, issue date, and valid flag of the node table 1121 of Embodiment 2, and are used by the advertising media owner who is the main user.
  • the ID of the user, the issue date of the node ID related to the advertisement medium of the advertisement medium owner, and the valid flag of the node ID are stored.
  • the physical node table 2121 stores information related to a node (main node) related to an advertising medium belonging to the advertising medium owner as a main user, so that the node ID of the physical node table 2121 is basically an advertising medium. It consists only of what is given to the main advertising medium, and the user ID consists only of what is given to the advertising medium owner.
  • the node type is the same information as the node type of the node ID given to the main node among the node types of the node table 1121 of the second embodiment (for example, “NFC” indicating the type of ID medium of the field ID) Etc.).
  • the location is the location information where the advertisement medium exists, and preferably includes location information specifying the geographical location by latitude and longitude.
  • the URL is the same information as the URL (main URL) of the node ID assigned to the main node among the URLs of the node table 1121 of the second embodiment.
  • the other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2,%) Of the physical node table 2121 are, for example, the location conditions of the advertisement medium.
  • the basic information table 2122 corresponds to the basic information table 1122 of the second embodiment, and is associated with the node ID of the main node (related to the main information) as basic information of the advertising medium serving as the main information (as the main user)
  • the user ID of the advertisement medium owner the physical medium name (advertisement medium name) as data corresponding to the product name (article name) of the second embodiment, and the image of the physical medium name (store article image, etc.) And other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2, attribute 3,...) Of the physical medium are stored.
  • the basic information table 2122 is configured not to store the category of the basic information table 1122 of the second embodiment, but may store a category.
  • the advertisement node table 2124 of the information management database 2120 is a table for storing and managing information of advertisement information nodes (specifically, advertisement information web pages) which are subordinate nodes in the third embodiment. Specifically, the advertisement node table 2124 is used to store and manage a unique node ID assigned to one advertisement information related to the sub information according to the third embodiment and related information of the advertisement information in association with each other. It is a table, and as a field name (column name or column name), node ID, user ID, node type, URL, banner ID, issue date, valid flag, and other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2,... And each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the user ID, issue date, and valid flag in the advertisement node table 2124 are the same information as the user ID, issue date, and valid flag in the physical node table 2121, and are used by the advertiser who is the secondary user.
  • the ID of the user, the date of issue of the node ID related to the advertiser's advertisement information, and the validity flag of the node ID are stored. That is, since the advertisement node table 2124 stores information related to the node (secondary node) related to the advertisement information of the advertiser as a secondary user, basically, the node ID of the advertisement node table 2124 is the advertiser's advertisement. It consists only of information given to the information, and the user ID consists only of what is given to the advertiser.
  • the node type can be configured from the same information as the node type of the node ID given to the slave node among the node types of the node table 1121 of the second embodiment, but the node type is specified. Any information can be used.
  • the URL is the same information as the URL (subordinate URL) of the node ID given to the subordinate node among the URLs of the node table 1121 of the second embodiment.
  • the URL of the web page having the content of the advertisement information It can be a URL.
  • the banner ID is an ID uniquely assigned to each banner when the banner of the advertisement information is arranged on the guide page related to the main information.
  • the other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2,...) Of the advertisement node table 2124 are, for example, product descriptions of products related to the advertisement information.
  • one advertisement information constituting the advertisement information node can be configured to be assigned one advertisement information and posted. Usually, a plurality of advertisement frames are provided on one advertisement medium.
  • the advertisement information which is one advertisement node is assigned to each advertisement space and posted. Therefore, the advertisement space table 2123 is a table for assigning and storing and managing one advertisement information to each advertisement space when dividing one advertisement medium into a plurality of advertisement spaces.
  • the advertising space table 2123 has an advertising space ID, a node ID, a link ID, a situation, and a publication period as field names (column names or column names). Each value is stored in each record (each tuple). Store in the corresponding field.
  • the advertising space ID is a unique ID assigned to each advertising space of the advertising medium.
  • the node ID includes a node ID of the main node and a node ID of the slave node.
  • One master node has a plurality of advertisement space IDs (that is, a plurality of advertisement space IDs are assigned to the node ID of one main node), while one slave node has one advertisement space ID ( That is, one advertisement space ID is assigned to the node ID of one slave node). Therefore, by extracting the node ID of the master node and the node ID of the slave node having the same advertisement frame ID, the slave node (advertisement information) is assigned to which advertisement frame of which master node (advertisement medium). Can be specified.
  • each advertisement space for each advertising medium serving as the main node can be uniquely specified.
  • the advertising space ID becomes an ID for specifying link information between the main node and the subnode, similarly to the link ID in the link table 1123 of the second embodiment.
  • the situation of the advertising space table 2123 is information representing a specific scene or situation (Valentine's Day, Shichigosan, Christmas, etc.) associated with each advertising space, and the posting period is the posting of the advertising information in the advertising space. This is information representing a period set in advance as a period.
  • the node management unit 2111 includes a NODE_ID management unit 2111a, a corresponding URL issuing unit 2111b, an advertising space ID management unit 2111c, and a banner management unit 2111d.
  • the node ID management unit 2111a corresponds to the node ID issuing unit 1111a of the twenty-first embodiment, and when a request for issuing an ID related to a specific article is received from the main user system 2200, a unique node ID (node of the main node) ID) is issued, the node ID is stored in the physical node table 2121 in association with the user ID of the main user of the main user system 2200, and the node type of the node ID is set according to the type of the ID medium. (For example, “NFC” when the ID medium is an NFC tag) and the node ID is stored in the node table 2121 in association with the node ID.
  • the node management unit 2111a is unique when there is a request from the secondary user system 2300 to place (and link) advertising information (related to the secondary information) on a specific advertising medium (related to the primary information).
  • a node ID node ID of the slave node
  • the node ID is stored in the advertisement node table 2124 in association with the user ID of the slave user of the slave user system 2300, and the node type of the node ID Is stored in the advertisement node table 2124 in association with the node ID according to the type of the link information of the sub information.
  • Corresponding URL issuing unit 2111b corresponds to corresponding URL issuing unit 1111b of the embodiment, and when the node ID of the main node is issued to a specific advertising medium as described above, the main of the advertising medium related to the node ID A new URL is issued for the information guide page (or an existing URL is used), and the URL is stored in the physical node table 2121 in association with the node ID.
  • the corresponding URL issuing unit 2111b when the corresponding URL issuing unit 2111b issues a node ID of a node according to specific advertisement information, the corresponding URL issuing unit 2111b newly issues a URL for the web page of the detailed contents of the advertisement information related to the node ID (or an existing one) And the URL is stored in the advertisement node table 2124 in association with the node ID.
  • the advertising space ID management unit 2111c corresponds to the link ID management unit 1111c of the second embodiment, and when the node ID is issued for the advertising information to be posted in the specific advertising space of the specific advertising medium as described above. , Newly issuing the advertising space ID for linking the node ID of the main node related to the advertising medium and the node ID of the slave node related to the advertising information, and associating the advertising space ID with the node ID of the main node In addition to storing in the advertising space table 2123, the link ID (same link ID) is associated with the node ID of the slave node and stored in the advertising space table 2123.
  • the advertising space ID management unit 2111c stores the time when the link ID is issued for the link between the node ID of the main node and the node ID of the sub node in the advertising space table 2123 in association with the node ID of the main node.
  • the advertisement space table 2123 can be stored in association with the node ID of the slave node.
  • the banner management unit 2111d realizes a function of issuing and storing and managing a banner ID uniquely assigned to each banner when placing a banner of advertisement information on a guide page related to main information.
  • the main information management unit 2112 corresponds to the main information management unit 112 of the second embodiment, and performs the same processing as the processing related to the node ID of the main node by the main concession hot water management unit 112 for the main node related to the specific advertisement medium. This process is executed as a process related to the node ID, and main information related to the advertisement medium is stored in the basic information table 2122 for each node ID of the main node.
  • the main information GUI means 2112a displays a main information registration web page (main information registration page) shown in FIG. 46 and a main information confirmation web page (not shown) (main information confirmation page). A function that is transmitted from the administrator system 1200 to the main user system 2200 and provided is realized.
  • the main information management unit 2112 has a function for registering main information input by the main user from the main user system 2200 using the main information GUI for main information registration in the administrator system 2100. Realize.
  • the main information registration management unit 2112b receives the main information transmitted from the main user system 2200 by the same process as the main information registration process (main user process) shown in FIG. Realize the function to register in.
  • the advertisement management unit 2113 corresponds to the sub information management unit 113 of the first embodiment, and is a function implementation unit for managing the advertisement information as sub information and the information regarding the advertising space as main information.
  • the advertisement information management means 2113 can include means for realizing other functions for managing advertisement information and advertisement space information.
  • the advertisement information GUI means 2113a realizes a function of providing a user interface (GUI) for the sub user to register the ad information as sub information in the administrator system 2100 using the sub user system 2300.
  • GUI user interface
  • the advertisement information GUI means 2113a displays the advertisement information registration web page (advertisement information registration page) shown in FIG. 47 and the advertisement information confirmation web page (advertisement information confirmation page) shown in FIG. A function that is transmitted from the administrator system 2100 to the slave user system 2300 and provided is realized.
  • the advertisement information management means 2113b sends the advertisement information input by the slave user from the slave user system 2300 using the advertisement information registration GUI (advertisement information registration page and advertisement information confirmation page) to the administrator system 2100. Realize the function to register.
  • the advertisement information registration management unit 2113b receives the advertisement information transmitted from the secondary user system 2300 by the same process as the secondary information registration process (secondary user process) shown in FIG. Implement the function to store and register in.
  • the link URL counting means 2113c corresponds to the sub URL counting means 113c of the first embodiment, and the number of advertisement information linked to the main information guide page 2150 related to one specific advertisement medium (that is, the advertisement information).
  • the function of counting the total number of sub-URLs of the advertisement information detail page, which is the number of links of the detail page, and storing it in a predetermined storage means is realized. That is, the link URL counting unit 2113c realizes a function of counting only the advertisement information registered by the advertisement information registration process by the advertisement information managing unit 2113b and storing it in a predetermined storage unit.
  • the advertisement space management means 2113d has a function of assigning one advertisement information to each advertisement space and storing and managing it in the advertisement space table 2123 when dividing one advertisement medium into a plurality of advertisement spaces as described above. Realize.
  • the browsing management means 2114 performs the same processing as the browsing processing of the guidance page 115 related to the node ID of the main node related to the specific article in the second embodiment, and browses the guidance page related to the node ID of the main node related to the specific advertising medium.
  • the browsing information of the main information related to the advertisement medium is stored in the browsing history table 1124 for each node ID of the main node.
  • a guide page 2150 corresponding to the guide page 150 is created by the guide page creating means 2115 corresponding to the guide page creating means 115 of the first and second embodiments.
  • the portal creation means 2116 creates an advertisement medium portal 2160 that provides information on all advertisement media based on all the guide pages 2150.
  • This advertising medium portal 2160 displays, for example, the position information of all advertising media, the total number of advertising information posted on each advertising medium, and the total number of browsing (total number of accesses) of each advertising medium. It is provided for the purpose of facilitating selection of advertising media on which the user's own advertising information should be posted. For example, as shown in FIG.
  • the advertisement medium portal 2160 displays, for example, the positions of all advertisement mediums on a map with pins and the like, and the total number of advertisement information corresponding to the pins of each advertisement medium. And the total number of browsing (total number of accesses).
  • the information processing operation between the advertising medium main system 2200 and the administrator system 2100 configured as described above is the same as the information processing operation between the main user system 200 and the administrator system 100 according to the first embodiment. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 45, first, when the advertising media owner wants to register main information related to his / her specific article in the administrator system 2100, the advertising media owner uses the advertising media owner system 2200. Then, in the same manner as the main information registration in the first embodiment, the main information is input and transmitted to the administrator system 2100 (that is, the main information is input to the main information registration page of FIG. To system 2100).
  • the main user also applies to the administrator system 2100 for issuance of a node ID related to the main node in the same manner as the application for the article ID of the first embodiment.
  • the administrator system 2100 registers the main information as described above, issues a node ID corresponding to the main node, and transmits information on the fact to the main user system 2200. To do.
  • the main information registration page UI 2020 has a configuration change as described above due to different types of main information and sub information in the third embodiment. This is basically the same configuration as the main information registration page UI20 of the first embodiment, and the main user registers the main information related to his / her advertising medium via the main user system 2200.
  • the first pane PN1 has a main information input area UI2021 and a content confirmation button UI25.
  • the main information input area UI 2021 includes, as input fields for main information, a user ID, a user name, an ID type of a node ID, a medium main name, a physical medium name, an attribute 1 (for example, location conditions), and the like (illustrated) (Although not provided) Input fields for other required attributes.
  • the main information input area UI 2021 further has a detailed information URL input field as an input field, and the detailed information URL input field has a web page (detailed information of the advertising medium related to the main information as content). For example, it is possible to input the URL of a company-operated web page that publishes data in the medium main information DB 2220 provided on the main user system 2200 side as content.
  • the main information input area UI2021 has an approval mode input field UI2021A.
  • the main information registration page UI2021 has a store image link input field UI22 for an advertising medium related to the main information.
  • the store image link input field UI22 has the same configuration as the product image link input field UI22 of the first embodiment.
  • the approval mode input column UI2021A has check columns for normal approval and deletion approval, and any one of the check columns is checked.
  • the information providing system issues a request (application) for posting and associating (with a link) advertising information to the main information of a specific advertising medium from the secondary user system 2300 with respect to the secondary information of the specific secondary user.
  • a request application
  • a normal approval function normal approval mode
  • a deletion approval function deletion approval mode
  • a normal approval means and a deletion approval means for realizing these functions are provided. That is, the information providing system of the third embodiment, as these approval means with links, as in the first embodiment, a normal approval means for executing processing as shown in FIG. A deletion approval unit for executing the process.
  • the main information registration page UI2020 has a registered medium main number display field UI2026, a total advertisement number display field UI2027, and a total access number display field UI2028 as display fields in the second pane PN2.
  • the registered media number display column UI2026 is a total of advertising media registered by the manager system 2100 so far by the advertising media owner as the main user who has applied for registration of main information (and node ID issuance application). Display a number. That is, the administrator system 2100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the number of registration media by the total number of node IDs, and sets the number of registration information on the main information registration page UI2020 of the main user of the user ID.
  • a function for displaying the number of registered media is realized in the registered media number display field UI 2026 of the second pane PN2 (that is, a registered media number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the total advertisement number display column UI2027 displays the total number of links of sub information linked to the main information related to all registration media of the main user (that is, the total number of advertisements). That is, the administrator system 2100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the total number of links of the sub information by the link URL counting means 2113c, and registers the main information of the main user of the user ID.
  • the total advertisement number display field UI2027 of the second pane PN2 of the page UI2020 realizes a function of displaying the total number of links as the total number of advertisements (that is, provided with a total advertisement number display means for realizing such a function).
  • the total access number display column UI2028 displays the total access number from the information viewer terminal 500 for all guide pages for main information related to all registered media of the main user. That is, the administrator system 2100 specifies the main user by the user ID, specifies the total access count of the main information guide page by the browsing counting means 2114b, and determines the main user's main user of the user ID.
  • a function of displaying the total access number in the total access number display field UI2028 of the second pane PN2 of the information registration page UI20 is realized (that is, a total access number display means for realizing such a function is provided). .
  • the sub information registration page UI 2040 has a configuration change as described above due to different types of main information and sub information in the third embodiment. This is basically the same configuration as the sub information registration page UI 40 of the first embodiment, and the sub user registers the sub information related to his / her advertisement information via the sub user system 2300.
  • a first user interface which includes a first pane PN1 and a second pane PN2.
  • the first pane PN1 has a sub information input area UI2042 and a content confirmation button UI46.
  • the sub information registration page UI 2040 has an advertisement medium main information display column UI 2041 as a display column.
  • the advertisement medium main information display column UI2041 automatically displays the main information to which the sub information is to be linked. For example, when the secondary user selects the primary information to be linked with the secondary information of the secondary user via the secondary user system 2300 (for example, the node ID of a specific advertising medium is read as the ID of the secondary user system 2300). Based on the node ID of the main information, the administrator system 2100 stores a part of the main information (for example, representative information) corresponding to the node ID in the main information registration management unit 2112b. The information is extracted from the basic information table 2122 and displayed in the main information display column UI2041.
  • the sub information input area UI 2042 is an input field for user ID, user name, link destination URL, link destination explanation, supplementary explanation, and other necessary attributes (not shown) as sub information input fields.
  • the link destination URL is the URL of the advertisement information detail page as the sub information of the sub information linked to the main information.
  • the link destination description is a simple description (for example, the name of an advertisement target product) of an advertisement information detail page as sub information to be a link destination.
  • the supplementary explanation is, for example, the contents of the sub information or the advertisement content of the store.
  • the sub information registration page UI2040 has a current access number display field UI2047 and a current advertisement number display field UI2048 in the second pane PN2.
  • the current access number display column UI 2047 displays the total number of accesses to the main information guide page 2150 to which the sub information is to be linked up to now. That is, the administrator system 2100 specifies the total access count of the main information guide page 2150 by the browsing counting means 2114b and links the main information to the main information registration page UI 2040 in the second pane PN2.
  • a function for displaying the current access number is realized (that is, a current access number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the current advertisement number display column UI2048 indicates the total number of links (that is, the total number of advertisements) of advertisement information as current (registered) subsidiary information in the guide page 2150 of the main information to which the subsidiary information is to be linked. indicate. That is, the administrator system 2100 specifies the total number of sub links of the sub information of the main information guide page 2150 by the link URL counting means 2113c and links the main information to the main information registration page UI 2040.
  • a function for displaying the current number of advertisements in the current advertisement number display column UI2048 of the second pane PN2 is realized (that is, a current advertisement number display means for realizing such a function is provided).
  • the sub user has information on how many accesses the main information to link his / her sub information has at the time of linking, and information on how many advertisements the sub user has.
  • the sub user has information on how many accesses the main information to link his / her sub information has at the time of linking, and information on how many advertisements the sub user has.
  • the guide page 2150 publishes the main information related to one specific advertising medium, and also advertises advertising information as all the sub information linked to the main information related to the advertising medium. It is a web page to do.
  • the guidance page 2150 is a user interface (GUI) UI 60 that can be browsed by the information viewer using the information viewer terminal 500, and the advertising medium main information is posted as the main information and the advertising information as the sub information. Is the same configuration as the guidance page 150 of the first embodiment.
  • GUI user interface
  • the information providing system includes the information printed matter 410B (physical medium that provides information on a specific article or a specific article such as the commodity 410A as a physical medium.
  • the ID media 411, 411a to 411n are attached to the article), and the administrator system 100, 1100 prints an information printed matter as a physical medium that provides information on a specific article such as the article 410A as a physical medium or a specific article.
  • the main user system 200 acquires a local ID for its own specific physical medium.
  • ID medium assigned with the local ID is attached to the specific physical medium and placed in the physical medium providing place 400.
  • the administrator system 100 provides the main information of the physical medium, and the sub user system 300 uses the sub information of its own products and stores related to the main information of the specific physical medium as the main information of the physical medium.
  • the administrator system 100 provides the sub information, and the information viewer terminal 500 reads the local ID of the ID medium of the specific physical medium in the specific physical medium providing place 400 and acquires the main information.
  • it is configured to obtain sub information related to the main information.
  • the main information is used as basic information of a specific product
  • the sub information is used as information such as a store handling the product.
  • To the general consumer, etc. to obtain the main information of the specific article of the specific physical medium providing place 400 on which the user has stopped, and Convenience that the main information of this article can be confirmed later by time series display or the like is provided.
  • the information providing system according to the third embodiment is implemented on the store article 2410A such as a product serving as the advertising medium of the present embodiment and the information display object 2410B such as a signboard serving as the advertising medium of the present embodiment.
  • An ID medium 2411 similar to the ID media 411, 411a to 411n of the first embodiment is attached.
  • the advertising media owner as the main user uses the main advertising media owner system 2200 to acquire a unique local ID for his particular advertising media from the administrator system 2100, and the local ID is The assigned ID medium is attached to the specific advertisement medium and placed in the advertisement medium providing place 2400.
  • the administrator system 2100 manages the store article 2410A and the information display object 2410B as advertisement media with a local ID (place ID) that uniquely identifies the advertisement media.
  • the administrator system 2100 provides main information, which is information describing the advertisement medium, in the form of a guide page as a web page via a network (such as the Internet).
  • the advertiser as a secondary user uses the advertiser system 2300 to send his / her advertisement information from the administrator system 2100 to the advertisement medium owner system 2200 to the advertisement medium owner having a specific advertisement medium.
  • On the advertisement media guide page (or link the advertisement information web page to the advertisement media guide page).
  • the advertising media owner uses the advertising media owner system 2200 to determine whether to accept the advertiser's request and sends the result to the administrator system 2100, and if the request is accepted, the administrator system 2100 Posts the advertisement information on the guide page of the advertisement medium (or links the advertisement information web page to the guide page of the advertisement medium). Thereafter, the administrator system 2100 displays the advertisement information on a guide page of main information (advertisement medium information) related to the advertisement medium, or externally (Internet) in such a manner as to display the advertisement information via a link of the guide page.
  • main information advertising medium information
  • Internet Internet
  • the information viewer terminal 500 reads the local ID of the ID medium of the specific advertisement medium in the specific advertisement medium providing place 2400, so that the administrator system 2100
  • the advertisement medium guide page is provided so as to be freely displayed on the information viewer terminal, and the advertisement medium advertisement information is obtained.
  • the advertisement medium owner is in a specific place.
  • a specific advertisement medium in the advertisement medium provider site 2400 can be provided to promote an advertisement from an advertiser to the advertisement medium in the place.
  • the advertisement information on the specific advertisement place board of the specific advertisement medium providing place 2400 that the customer has visited on the spot It provides convenience such as being able to acquire and confirm the advertisement information of the advertisement medium at this place by time series display later.
  • the advertising media owner who is the user of the advertising media main system 2200 corresponds to the main user, for example, a place or a prime location with high customer-collection effect (Shinjuku, Ginza, Tokyo). , Shibuya, etc.), the owner of the store or building, etc., and using the store or building as the advertising medium providing place 2400, for example, an article (store article 2410A or the like) arranged in the store or building or its An information display object 2410B such as a signboard or bulletin board attached to a store or a building is provided as an advertising medium.
  • the advertiser who is a user of the advertiser system 2300 corresponds to the sub user, and is, for example, a business operator who expects an effect of attracting customers at the advertisement medium providing place 2400 in a specific place.
  • the local ID linked to the advertisement information related to the own product or store to be advertised is attached to the advertisement medium of the medium providing place 2400.
  • the user of the information viewer terminal 500 is a target of attracting customers by the advertiser's advertisement, and reads the local ID of a specific ID medium of the advertisement medium in the advertisement medium providing place 2400 at the place visited by the user. , Get that advertising information.
  • the medium main information corresponds to the main information of the information providing systems according to the first and second embodiments
  • the advertisement information corresponds to the sub information
  • the place ID corresponds to the article ID.
  • the types of information to be managed (and to be processed) are different, basically, the administrator system 2100, the advertisement medium main system 2200, the advertiser system 2300, and the advertisement medium provision place 2400 are The administrator systems 100 and 1100, the primary user system 200, the secondary user system 300, and the physical medium providing place 400 according to the first and second embodiments can be embodied as the same configuration.
  • the advertising media owner uses the advertising media owner system 2200 to issue a place ID for his advertising media (for example, a store at a specific location). Apply to the administrator system 2100 and register the main information of the advertisement medium (for example, the store name as the advertisement medium and the location of the store) in the administrator system 2100. At this time, the location of the advertisement medium is Is stored in the management information database 2120 of the administrator system 2100.
  • the location information may be, for example, the address of the advertising medium and the name of the store type (for example, “Shinjuku station square”), but is preferably location information consisting of latitude and longitude.
  • the administrator system 2100 provides a guide page (web page similar to the guide page of the first embodiment) having the main information of the advertisement medium as content and issues the URL of the guide page. .
  • the advertisement medium owner attaches the place ID of the advertisement medium to the physical medium belonging to the advertisement medium.
  • the physical medium is the store article 2410A or the information display object 2410B, and a typical example of the store article is, for example, a product arranged in the store, but other articles may be used.
  • the advertiser uses the advertiser system 2300 to manage the permission to place an advertisement of his / her own product or the like on the advertising medium at a specific location (for the advertising medium owner who owns the advertising medium).
  • the administrator system 2100 places the advertisement on the requested advertisement medium (that is, links the URL of the advertisement page to a predetermined area such as a banner of the guide page of the advertisement medium). Then, the information viewer reads the ID medium of the advertisement medium that he / she physically visited (in a specific place) by using the information viewer terminal 500, so that the specific advertisement page posted on the advertisement medium is read. browse.
  • the information providing system executes the classification based on the behavior and the context. Therefore, the information providing system having the configuration shown in FIG. 1 as an information providing system).
  • the information management database 2120A includes the physical node table 2121 (not shown in FIG. 49), the basic information table 2122, and the advertising space table 2123.
  • an advertisement node table 2124A is provided instead of the advertisement node table 2124, and a classification table 2115 is further provided.
  • the advertisement node table 2124A stores position information (for example, position information acquired by GPS) instead of the banner ID as data.
  • the classification table 2125 stores node ID, context, action, and the like as data.
  • the context CT1 is, for example, an event for each season, such as Christmas, Shichigosan, Valentine's Day, or the like, or may be a context representing a situation such as tiredness as another context.
  • the action CT2 is a specific action of a general consumer, such as eating, playing, spending together, watching, and the like.
  • the management system 2100 uses the information management database 2120A to execute the advertisement for each specific behavior CT1 and specific context CT2 for a specific advertisement medium. The information is classified and the related data is stored in the advertisement node table 2124A. Thereby, the management system 2100 can classify and provide advertisement information for each specific action CT1 and specific context CT2 for a specific advertisement medium.
  • the information providing system executes classification by situation, and therefore the information providing system having the configuration shown in FIG. 50 (second embodiment of the third embodiment) Example information providing system).
  • the information management database 2120 includes the physical node table 2121 and the like (not shown in FIG. 49), but an advertising space instead of the advertising space table 2123.
  • a table 2123A is provided, and a situation table 2117 is further provided.
  • the advertisement space table 2123A stores a situation ID instead of the situation as data, and also stores a banner ID of the advertisement node table 2124.
  • the situation table 2127 stores a situation ID and situation contents as data.
  • the situation can have the same contents as the context CT2, for example.
  • the management system 2100 uses the information management database 2120 to classify the advertisement information for each specific situation for a specific advertisement medium,
  • the situation ID is stored in the advertisement node table 2124, and the situation content of the situation ID is stored in the situation table.
  • the management system 2100 can classify and provide advertisement information for each specific situation for a specific advertisement medium.
  • a plurality of situations are set for one advertising space (being a one-to-n relationship).
  • the advertising space table 2123 is a table in which a plurality of advertising spaces are collected, but there may be one advertising space.
  • the situation table is a table in which the advertising space is collected for each situation.
  • one ID (banner ID) is assigned to the banner.
  • the banner and the banner ID disappear from the corresponding advertisement space.
  • a person who wants to place an advertisement as an advertisement purchases the advertisement space.
  • the advertisement can be permanently posted (a permanent posting period is provided) without providing a limited time advertising space. This is effective when a campaign is desired without a limited period.
  • the administrator system 2100 uses the data based on the classification to display advertisement information for each situation, for example, browsing the information viewer terminal 500 It can be displayed as history 2131A.
  • the browsing history 2131A displays the URL of the advertisement information in a list format for each situation (playing, eating, watching), for example, by performing a predetermined operation when the detailed contents are desired (for example, The detailed content screen 2131B of the advertisement information for each situation can also be displayed (by clicking an icon or the like provided in relation to the browsing history).
  • the history is generated from a new one. In this case, it can be classified by a combination of a constant campaign and a situation.
  • the administrator system 2100 uses the data according to the classification to make each advertisement medium as an advertisement medium sales screen for each situation for each situation.
  • the total number of accesses to the advertising medium along the time axis can be aggregated based on past access history information and displayed on the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the number of accesses to the advertisement medium can be displayed in a graph format along the time axis for each situation.
  • the administrator system 2100 can highlight a specific period TZ that is the total number of accesses on the time axis, and can display an advertisement space PR (n1, n2) that can be used in the period TZ. .
  • the secondary user for example, in an advertisement space of a specific advertisement medium, an advertisement that publishes his / her advertisement information during a period TZ in which access is peaked in a specific situation (for example, Christmas season) last year. Can be purchased as a frame. That is, in this case, the management system 2100 creates a campaign page for a specific situation, registers an advertising medium (including a banner etc.) on the page, displays the graph for each situation, and displays the period. TZ is displayed.
  • the number of accesses is graphed on the time axis, the physical medium (physical node) is posted in the peak period zone / time zone, and the period zone / time zone can be purchased.
  • the ID medium NFC or the like
  • the contents of the campaign associated with the physical node main node
  • 500 is displayed as an advertisement.
  • the person in front of Shinjuku station (such as the owner of a store or a house) registers his / her store or the like as an advertising medium, mainly as an advertising board.
  • the graph in this case produces a graph which changes with time. For example, in the case of a Christmas campaign, the number of accesses of the Christmas campaign last year is displayed as a graph. (To conduct a campaign before Christmas this year.)
  • the relationship between the specific advertisement space and the individual advertisements can be, for example, a tree structure shown in FIG. Specifically, a plurality of advertisements 1151A, 1151B, and 1151C can be associated with a specific advertisement frame 1151 in a tree shape.
  • Embodiment 4 The information providing system using the physical medium according to the fourth embodiment of the present invention uses the data generated by the administrator system 2100 of the information providing system according to the third embodiment as an external organization (for example, artificial intelligence).
  • This is a configuration provided to an ad server company or the like that provides advertisements.
  • the management system 2100 includes a data set table 2125 as the information management database 2120 in addition to the same configuration as the management system 2100 of the second embodiment.
  • the data set table 2125 stores, as data, node ID, node type, data type (DATA_TYPE), issue date, attribute 1, attribute 2,.
  • the management system 2100 includes a data setting unit 2116 as the information management unit 2110 in addition to the same configuration as the management system 2100 of the second embodiment.
  • the data setting unit 2116 includes a data management unit 2116a and a data providing unit 2116b.
  • the management system 2100 edits the data created as in the third embodiment as data of a specific format (for example, JASON) by the data management unit 2116a of the data setting unit 2116, and the data provision unit 2116b.
  • a specific format for example, JASON
  • the data management unit 2116a of the data set unit 2116 identifies, for example, the advertisement medium having the node ID that is most accessed at a specific time, while the external organization's (for example, A computer device (for AI advertising), designates and browses the condition, creates a data set that meets the condition, and provides the data set to the computer device of the external organization by the data providing means 2116.
  • the condition may be that the AI advertisement computer device automatically submits the data to the data set means 2116 of the administrator system 2100.
  • the administrator system 2100 confirms the time, the access number, and the node ID (of the main node related to browsing), who is performing the advertisement at which time, and in which segment (high school girl, housewife, etc.)
  • a parameter such as where is accessed is specified, an appropriate data set is created according to the parameter, and the data set is output in a specific format (for example, JASON). For example, in the 11:00 to 12:00 time zone, where is the highest access, which is 11:00 to 12:00 and which is ranked 1 to 10, and 11:00 to 12:00 is optional. Or other parameters.
  • the administrator system 2100 determines where to place the advertisement by the data management means 2116a, while the demand side (AI advertising agency) specifies the condition.
  • information may be collected by crawler patrol (for example, a time zone such as 12:00 to 13:00), and at this time, a data set relating to the remaining advertisement space may be provided.
  • crawler patrol for example, a time zone such as 12:00 to 13:00
  • a data set relating to the remaining advertisement space may be provided.
  • processing can also be performed for an advertising space with a certain number of accesses (for example, 10,000 accesses or more), a specific ranking, and an advertising space in a specific time zone.
  • Embodiment 5 The information providing system using a physical medium according to the fifth embodiment of the present invention is an implementation using an outdoor signboard as an example of a physical medium (advertisement medium) in the administrator system 2100 of the information providing system according to the third embodiment. It is a form. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 55, the outdoor signboard BB100 as the advertising medium of Embodiment 6 is provided with a plurality of advertising frames 410a and advertising frames 410b, and in the vicinity of the advertising frames 410a and 410b, ID media 411a and 411b (NFC tags or the like) are attached respectively.
  • ID media 411a and 411b NFC tags or the like
  • the person who looked at the outdoor signboard BB100 reads ID medium 411a, 411b by the information viewer terminal 500, and a corresponding advertisement is displayed. That is, by assigning different advertising space IDs to the ID media 411a and 411b, different advertising information can be provided for the advertising spaces 410a and 410b.
  • the ID media 411a and 411b store an advertisement space ID in addition to the node ID of the main node.
  • signboard advertisements by signboard companies have gradually disappeared in recent years, but signboard companies own signboards (outdoor signboards, etc.) By creating an advertising space on the signboard, it is possible to monetize using this information providing system.
  • advertisements that change with the seasons can be posted on a signboard in a certain place.
  • a conventional signboard is a physical medium.
  • different advertisement information can be freely changed by simply providing a link via specific ID information 411a and 411b for specific advertisement information. it can. For example, if you publish specific advertising information at a specific time, the uniform company will publish a uniform advertisement during this time (spring), and during this time (winter) there will be no need for uniform advertising.
  • the outdoor signage is fixed at a specific location, but according to the information providing system, the advertising content at a specific time (for example, spring time) is changed from the advertising content at another time (for example, winter time).
  • the same ID medium (same advertising space ID) signboard can be used at different times (for example, spring and winter). That is, in this case, the advertising space ID of one ID medium is the same, but specific advertising information is assigned to the advertising space ID at a specific time, and the same advertising space ID is assigned at another time. Assign different advertising information.
  • Embodiment 6 The information providing system using a physical medium according to the sixth embodiment of the present invention is an embodiment in which a signboard is used as an example of a physical medium (advertisement medium) in the administrator system 2100 of the information providing system according to the third embodiment. It is a form. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 56, the signboard BB110 as the advertising medium of the seventh embodiment is provided with a plurality of advertising frames 410a and advertising frames 410b, and in the vicinity of the advertising frames 410a and 410b, respectively. ID media 411a and 411b (NFC tags or the like) are attached.
  • the person who looked at the signboard BB110 reads ID medium 411a, 411b with the information viewer terminal 500, and a corresponding advertisement is displayed. That is, by assigning different advertising space IDs to the ID media 411a and 411b, different advertising information can be provided for the advertising spaces 410a and 410b.
  • the ID media 411a and 411b store an advertisement space ID in addition to the node ID of the main node. In this case, it is possible to change the size of the advertisement frame 410a and the advertisement frame 410b, change the posting time of the advertisement information, or change the advertiser's location.
  • the advertising space 410a is an advertising space related to advertisements at a specific place (for example, a store in front of Shinjuku Station) at a specific time (for example, the Christmas season from December 20 to December 25),
  • the advertising space 410b may be an advertising space related to advertising at a different location (for example, a store in front of Nagoya Station) in the same period (for example, the Christmas season from December 20 to December 25).
  • a plurality of advertising spaces can be purchased as a package. For example, when a cake shop operates stores nationwide, a plurality of advertisement frames (advertisement frames related to locations in each region) of one advertisement medium can be purchased together as a package.
  • Embodiment 7 An information providing system using a physical medium according to Embodiment 7 of the present invention is a display screen of a specific store as an example of a physical medium (advertisement medium) in the administrator system 2100 of the information providing system of Embodiment 3. It is an embodiment using.
  • the display board BB120 as the advertising medium of the eighth embodiment includes a plurality of advertising frames 410a, advertising frames 410b, and advertising frames 410c, and the advertising frames 410a and 410b.
  • ID media 411a, 411b, and 411c are attached in the vicinity of the advertisement frame 410c.
  • the person who looked at the display board BB120 reads ID medium 411a, 411b, 411c by the information browsing terminal 500, and a corresponding advertisement is displayed. That is, by assigning different advertising space IDs to the ID media 411a, 411b, and 411c, different advertising information can be provided for the advertising spaces 410a, 410b, and 410c.
  • the ID media 411a, 411b, and 411c store the advertising space ID in addition to the node ID of the main node.
  • the size of the frames can be changed in the advertisement frames 410a, 410b, and 410c, the posting time of the advertisement information can be changed, and the location of the advertiser can be changed.
  • the situation described in the third embodiment can also be used.
  • the display board BB120 serving as a specific advertisement medium can be configured to display an advertisement corresponding to the advertisement frames 410a, 410b, 410c.
  • different advertisers can purchase for each of the advertising spaces 410a, 410b, and 410c.
  • the advertising medium sales screen BB130 divides the advertising frame 712 into a central large frame advertising frame and left and right small frames 710a, 710b, 710c, 711a, 711b, 711c (or in the middle) A large frame and a large amount of advertising expenses are provided, and the small frames 710a, 710b, 710c, 711a, 711b, and 711c can be sold as a small amount of advertising expenses.
  • the small frames 710a, 710b, 710c, 711a, 711b, and 711c may be banner advertisements.
  • each frame can be configured so that automatic bidding by a computer device can be performed, or can be configured to be successful in an auction.
  • the advertisement medium sales screen BB130 is first displayed by reading the ID medium, and the corresponding advertisement page is displayed by clicking a specific banner on the advertisement medium sales screen BB130. Can be configured. Further, in the case of a configuration without a banner, a corresponding advertisement page can be displayed immediately upon reading the ID medium.
  • the information providing system of the present invention is a specific article, information printed matter, building, etc. in a specific place of a visited place where an information viewer such as a general consumer or a trader actually visited in the real world.
  • the information viewer can select and execute a main information link related to the bookmarked specific item with a mouse click or the like, or the past main information browsing history or past local ID
  • the main information of the specific article can be selected by performing a mouse click etc. on the link of the main information related to the specific article that has been browsed in the past or read the local ID in the past. Can be called instantly, and the main information web page can be accessed.
  • a bookmark is called a “physical bookmark” in the sense that it becomes a bookmark attached to a physical medium such as an article.
  • the main information of a physical medium such as a specific article can be called based on the browsing history in addition to the bookmark. It is called “Physical Bookmark”.
  • the information providing system of the present invention links the sub information to the main information related to the article etc., and makes a pair of the main information and the sub information.
  • Information provision system managed as information (sometimes referred to as “master / subordinate information use type information provision system”)
  • the information providing system can be embodied as an information providing system using only main information (hereinafter, also referred to as “main information using type information providing system”).
  • Embodiment 8 an information providing system according to Embodiment 8 will be described as a specific example of the main information utilization type information providing system.
  • the information providing system of the eighth embodiment is a first specific example of the information providing system using the physical bookmark. In the real world, you can bookmark products as physical media that you have actually seen and touched, and then you can purchase them quickly and smoothly. System ”)).
  • the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment is a second specific example of the information providing system using the physical bookmark.
  • An information guide linkage type information provision system (sometimes referred to as an “information guide linkage type information provision system”) that allows bookmarks of cooking recipes) to be browsed quickly and smoothly thereafter. Can be embodied.
  • the information providing system using the physical medium according to the eighth embodiment of the present invention is, as a first specific example, in the administrator system 100, 1100 of the information providing system according to the first or second embodiment, an information viewer (for example, , A traveler) is a physical ID that is an example of a local ID attached to a specific product in a store (for example, a souvenir shop) in a specific place (for example, a tourist spot visited by a traveler) by the information viewer terminal 500.
  • an information viewer for example, , A traveler
  • a physical ID that is an example of a local ID attached to a specific product in a store (for example, a souvenir shop) in a specific place (for example, a tourist spot visited by a traveler) by the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the administrator system 3100 of the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment has the same configuration as the administrator systems 100 and 1100 according to the first or second embodiment, and further purchase means. 3200. For example, if a traveler visits a souvenir shop in a specific tourist area and wants to purchase a specific product from that souvenir shop, he / she wants to purchase it at a later date in order to become a baggage.
  • the administrator system 3100 stores the browsing history in the browsing history tables 124 and 1124 (such as in the first embodiment). Then, the administrator system 3100 requests the purchase screen BM110 from the administrator system 3100 using the information viewer terminal 500 at a later date (for example, after returning home), and the administrator The system 100 provides a purchase screen (purchase page) BM 110 to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the purchase screen BM110 can be configured in a browsing history screen format or a bookmark menu format so that the past browsing products of the traveler are listed and displayed as the product list BM111.
  • the traveler selects a desired product from the called product list BM111, confirms the content by the image IM or the like, and then selects and executes the purchase button PB. Apply for purchase.
  • the administrator system 100 can create and provide a net shop website for this series of processing.
  • the net shop in this case can be a net shop for a single product prepared for each product to be purchased by the traveler.
  • the net shop is configured to handle only one product, and the same number of net shops are provided for all the products.
  • the administrator system 3100 has the configuration shown in FIG. can do. Specifically, this administrator system 3100 includes information management means and a management information database (DB) 3120, as with the administrator systems 100, 1100, and 2100 of the first to third embodiments, and further includes the purchase means. 3200.
  • the information management means and the management information database 3120 are respectively provided with means and tables relating to the main information in the administrator systems 100, 1100 and 2100 of the first to third embodiments, and means relating only to the sub information. And tables are omitted.
  • the information management unit includes an ID management unit 3111, a main information management unit 3112, and a browsing management unit 3113, and further includes a bookmark page creation unit 3115 and a browsing page creation unit 3116.
  • the administrator system 3100 further includes the purchase means 3200 (not shown in FIG. 60).
  • the information management database 3120 includes a physical node table 3121, a basic information table 3122, and a browsing history table 3123.
  • the administrator system 3100 includes the purchasing means 3200, so that the information providing system (net shop cooperation type information providing system) of the first specific example that handles product information for purchasing products at the net shop can be used.
  • the information providing system network shop cooperation type information providing system
  • an administrator system can be configured, as will be described later, an administrator system of an information providing system that handles information other than product information can also be configured.
  • the administrator system 3100 In addition to the configuration shown in FIG. 60, a configuration (function realization means) for separately processing information other than the product information is provided.
  • the administrator system 3100 may create a web page having the guide information of the tour guide or the cooking recipe as the content. Since the creation process can be realized by the browsing page creation unit 3116 as described later, the administrator system 3100 has a separate configuration (function) for processing the guide information in addition to the configuration shown in FIG. There is no need to provide any realization means).
  • the physical node table 3121 of the information management DB 3120 is a table for storing and managing the physical ID and its related information.
  • field names column names or column names
  • physical IDs physical IDs
  • user IDs location locations
  • URL1, URL2, issue date valid flag
  • other attributes attribute 1, etc
  • the physical ID of the physical ID table 3121 is an ID corresponding to the article ID of the first embodiment, and is a unique identifier (ID) assigned to each type of product.
  • the user ID stored in the physical node table 3121 is a merchandise seller (and an operator of the net shop) as the main user of the present embodiment among the user IDs of the first embodiment. It is a unique identifier (ID) given for each.
  • the location is the geographical information or the location information of the store where the product is present, and is composed of the location of the store or the location information specifying the geographical location of the store by latitude and longitude.
  • the location information is the geographical information or the location information such as his / her store address. It can be registered.
  • URL1 is a unique URL issued for each type of product in association with the physical ID, and is used as a first URL for a bookmark confirmation page described later.
  • URL2 is a unique URL issued for each type of product in association with the physical ID, and is used as a second URL for a product browsing page to be described later.
  • the issue date is the date on which the physical ID was issued.
  • the validity flag is a flag for determining whether the physical ID assigned to a specific product is valid or invalid, as with the validity flag of the first embodiment.
  • the basic information table 3122 is a table for storing and managing main information as basic information related to a specific product to which a physical ID is assigned, and includes a physical ID and a user ID as field names (column names or column names). , Physical medium name (product name), image (product image), and other attributes (attribute 1, attribute 2, attribute 3,...), Each value corresponding to each record (each tuple) Store in the field.
  • the physical ID of the basic information table 3122 has the same configuration as the physical ID of the physical node table 3121, and the storage data of the physical node table 3121 and the storage data of the basic information table 3122 are transmitted via the physical ID.
  • the predetermined relational calculation can be executed between the two to obtain desired data.
  • the user ID in the basic information table 3122 is an ID having the same configuration as the user ID in the physical node table 3121. Since the basic information table 3122 is a table for managing main information related to a specific physical ID belonging to the main user, the user ID stored in the basic information table 3122 is basically a physical node.
  • the user ID of the main user is the same as the user ID of the table 3121.
  • the product name is a product name of a specific product to which a physical ID is assigned.
  • the image is a product image of a specific product to which a physical ID is assigned.
  • Other attributes such as attribute 1 and attribute 2 are information such as product price and product manufacturer, for example.
  • the browsing history table 3123 is a table for storing and managing browsing history information acquired by reading the physical ID by the information viewer terminal 500 (information similar to a log in a normal information system). It has physical ID, user ID, and browsing time as (column name or column name), and each value is stored in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the physical ID of the browsing history table 3123 is an ID having the same configuration as the physical ID of the physical node table 3121 and the basic information table 3122, and the physical node table 3121 and the basic information table 3122 are stored via the physical ID.
  • a predetermined relational calculation is executed between the data and the stored data of the browsing history table 3123 so that desired data can be acquired.
  • the user ID in the browsing history table 3123 is a user ID assigned to an information viewer who uses the information viewer terminal 500, and is usually registered by user registration in the administrator system 3100 of the information providing system.
  • the browsing time is typically an ID reading time, which is the time when the information viewer reads the physical ID of a specific product using the information viewer terminal 500, but the physical time of the specific product is displayed by the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the browsing history table 3123 stores data other than the above three types of data (that is, data that constitutes ID browsing data described later, and is a set of data including a physical ID, a user ID, and a browsing time).
  • the data stored in the browsing history table 3123 is transmission data from the information viewer terminal 500 as described later, and the ID media 411 and 411a of a specific product are stored by the information viewer terminal 500. Since the data is automatically transmitted at the read timing, it is preferable to store only the above three types of data in order to simplify the configuration of the data structure and the like.
  • the ID management means 3111 of the information management means is a function realizing means for issuing and managing physical IDs and URLs (URL1, URL2), and includes a physical ID issuing means 3111a, a URL issuing means 3111b, and an ID / URL management means 3111c. It has. Further, the physical ID issuing unit 3111a has the same configuration as the article ID issuing unit 111a of the second embodiment, and the main user system 200 corresponds to a product sold at its own store to the administrator system 3100. A function to issue a physical ID to the specific product and store the physical ID in the article ID media 411, 411a to 411n when giving a request to issue a physical ID to be issued. Realize.
  • the URL issuing unit 3111b realizes a function of issuing the URL1 and URL2.
  • the URL issuing means 3111b like the URL issuing means 111b of the first embodiment, when a physical ID is issued for a specific product, uniquely corresponds to the physical ID, URL1 and URL2 Is newly issued or an existing URL is assigned.
  • the web page to which URL1 is assigned is the bookmark confirmation page, and the web page to which URL2 is assigned is the product confirmation page.
  • the ID / URL management unit 3111c is similar to the ID / URL management unit 111c of the first embodiment, for example, the physical ID issued by the physical ID issuing unit 3111a, and the URL1 and URL2 issued by the URL issuing unit 3111b.
  • the ID management unit 3111 also realizes a function of storing and registering the physical ID and URL1 and URL2 issued as described above in the physical node table 3121 in the same manner as the article management unit 111 of the first embodiment. .
  • the ID management unit 3111 also has a function of automatically issuing a physical ID when issuing a physical ID and storing and registering the physical ID in the physical node table 3121 in the same manner as the article management unit 111 of the first embodiment. Realize. Further, the ID management unit 3111 also realizes a function of storing and registering in the physical node table 3121 the validity or invalidity of the issued validity flag of the physical ID in the same manner as the article management unit 111 of the first embodiment.
  • the main information management unit 3112 of the information management unit has the same configuration as the main information management unit 112 of the first embodiment, and is a function implementation unit for managing main information.
  • the main information GUI unit 3112a, Main information registration management means 3112b is provided.
  • the main information GUI unit 3112a uses the main user system 200 to register the main information in the administrator system 3100 using the user interface ( A function that provides a GUI) is realized.
  • the main information registration management unit 3112b manages the main information input by the main user from the main user system 200 using the GUI for main information registration, like the main information registration management unit 112b of the first embodiment.
  • a function for storing and registering in the basic information table 3122 of the user system 3100 is realized. That is, the main information management unit 3112 stores and registers the physical medium name (product name), product image, etc. as main information in the basic information table 3122 in the same manner as the main information management unit 112 of the first embodiment. The function to do is realized. Also, the main information management unit 3112 stores and registers the location of the main user's store where the product is located in the physical node table 3121 in the same manner as the main information management unit 112 of the first embodiment. Realize the function.
  • the browsing management unit 3113 of the information management unit is a function realizing unit for managing browsing history information acquired by reading the physical ID by the information browsing terminal 500, and includes a page transmission unit 3113a, a browsing counting unit 3113b, And bookmark management means 3113c.
  • the page transmission means 3113a provides a bookmark page for confirming the bookmark of the product to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 When the information viewer wishes to confirm a specific product using the information viewer terminal 500 using the function to transmit (sometimes referred to as “BM page transmission function”), the information viewer terminal 500 on the other hand, a function of transmitting a browsing page for confirming the product (sometimes referred to as “browsing page transmission function”) is realized.
  • the bookmark confirmation page may have the configuration of the bookmark page UI 70 shown in FIG. 62
  • the product browsing page may have the configuration of the browsing page UI 80 shown in FIG.
  • the browsing counting means 3113b counts the total number of physical IDs read by various information viewers using the information viewer terminal 500 for one specific product as the total number of browsing related to the product. A function of storing in a predetermined storage means is realized. In the administrator system 3100 of the eighth embodiment, the browsing counting unit 3113b may be omitted for simplification of the configuration. However, if the browsing counting unit 3113b is provided, the user's own product can be provided to the main user. Can be used to determine the consumer's popularity and interest in (based on the total number of viewers).
  • the bookmark management unit 3113c is similar to the bookmark management unit 114 of the first embodiment, and after the information viewer completes the bookmark processing on the bookmark confirmation page UI 70 related to a specific product by the information viewer terminal 500, A bookmark management function for managing bookmark information of the product related to the product is provided to the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the bookmark management unit 3113c may be omitted to simplify the configuration.
  • the bookmark page creation unit 3115 creates the bookmark page UI 70 to be transmitted to the information viewer terminal 500 when the information viewer reads the physical ID of a specific product using the information viewer terminal 500.
  • a function (sometimes referred to as “BM page creation function”) is realized.
  • the bookmark page UI 70 can be a web page having a single configuration (same configuration) as shown in FIG. 62 regardless of the type of product. That is, as shown in FIG. 62, the bookmark page UI 70 having this configuration is simply a “bookmark” as a confirmation dialog having the same display contents for the information viewer who has read the physical ID by the information viewer terminal 500. It is possible to select whether or not to perform the selection by one of two options (such as “Yes” or “No”).
  • the bookmark page UI 70 is a web page specified by the first URL (URL 1), and is a web page that the administrator system 3200 creates and stores in advance by the bookmark page creation unit 3115. be able to.
  • the browsing page creation means 3116 transmits the information etc. to the information viewer terminal 500 when the information viewer wishes to confirm the products bookmarked in the past using the information viewer terminal 500.
  • a function of creating a browsing page UI 80 for confirmation of the user (sometimes referred to as a “browsing page creation function”) is realized.
  • the browsing page UI 80 can be a web page including a first pane P1 and a second pane P2.
  • a calendar-type browsing screen CA1 similar to the article browsing page CA shown in FIG. 23 is displayed.
  • the second pane P2 of the browsing page UI80 has a bookmark title of a physical ID bookmarked within the period of the calendar displayed in the first pane P1 (for example, in the case of a monthly calendar, the displayed month). Are displayed in the bookmark list BML. Details of the browsing page UI 80 created by the browsing page creation unit 3116 will be described in detail later.
  • a unique physical ID issued corresponding to each type of product 410A is stored.
  • the ID medium 411a is attached to the information printed matter 410B as another type of physical medium by printing or pasting it, and the information printed matter 410B is fixedly arranged at a position corresponding to each type of product 410A (for example, , Affixed to the packaging of the sample product 410A arranged at the top or foremost position of the group of products 410A arranged one above the other in the vertical or front-rear direction, or the closest to the group of products 410A Or arranged as a product popped just in front of the location in) can be attached.
  • the printed information 410B displays, for example, main information (for example, a product name, a product name, a price, etc.) of the product 410A and displays the information in the vicinity position (side, etc.) of the main information.
  • the ID mediums 411 and 411a having unique physical IDs assigned to the product 410A are attached, and for example, the ID medium 411a having physical IDs composed of two-dimensional barcodes is attached by printing.
  • the physical ID of the ID medium 411, 411a is set by the information viewer terminal 500 at a position near the ID medium 411, 411a (for example, above).
  • the product 410A can be purchased later (that is, the product 410A can be bookmarked using the information providing system of the present invention) (for example, “You can buy later”), etc. It can also be attached. Furthermore, in the information providing system of the first specific example of the eighth embodiment, when the ID medium 411a composed of a two-dimensional barcode is used, the ID medium 411a is configured depending on the specifications of the two-dimensional barcode system. Since an image such as an icon (not constituting barcode code information) can be printed at the center of the two-dimensional barcode, for example, image printing such as the product name and product image of the product 410A with the ID medium 411a attached. The part CH can also be provided by printing in the center of the ID medium 411a.
  • the guide information printed material 410A (as an article) which is a kind of physical medium of the present invention (for example, on its cover) is composed of an NFC tag and a two-dimensional barcode.
  • the ID medium 411 may be directly attached.
  • a summary of one or more guide information (tourist guide content or cooking recipe content) is described in the information printed matter (poster or the like) 410B, and each guide in the information printed matter 410B is recorded.
  • An ID medium 411a to 411n storing a unique physical ID issued corresponding to each guide information is attached to the side of the information summary by printing or pasting, and the printed information 410B is placed at a specific position (display).
  • the information printing system is the same as the image printing unit CH of the first specific example.
  • an image printing unit composed of iconic information (for example, a sightseeing mark) of the printed guide information 410A to which the ID media 411 and 411a are attached can be provided by printing at the center of the ID media 411 and 411a.
  • bookmark processing The bookmark processing by the information providing system of the eighth embodiment (including the first and second specific examples) will be described with reference to FIG. First, when an information viewer such as a traveler is interested in a specific product 410A at a store visited such as a travel destination and wants to purchase the product 410A at a later date, or an information viewer such as a traveler. However, he / she is interested in a guide information printed material 410A (or information printed material 410B on which one or more guide information is printed) such as a specific tourist guide or cooking recipe at a tourist information center such as a travel destination.
  • a guide information printed material 410A or information printed material 410B on which one or more guide information is printed
  • the information viewer uses the information viewer terminal 500 to display the physical information of the ID media 411 and 411a of the product 410A and the printed guide information 410A (or the printed information 401B) as shown in FIG.
  • the ID is read (STEP 91: ID reading process).
  • the bookmark page UI 70 shown in FIG. 62 is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 500 (STEP 92: confirmation screen display processing).
  • the confirmation screen display process of the bookmark page UI 70 in the information viewer terminal 500 is performed, for example, when the information viewer reads the physical ID of the product 410A or the like by the information viewer terminal 500 according to HTTP.
  • a request for the bookmark page UI 70 of the first URL (URL 1) is transmitted from the browser terminal 500 to the administrator system 3100, and the administrator system 3100 sends the bookmark page UI 70 to the information viewer terminal 500 as a response thereto. Achieved by sending.
  • the information viewer terminal 500 Data consisting of a physical ID of the product 410A, the user ID of the information viewer, and the browsing time of the product (that is, the reading time of the ID media 411, 411a of the product 410A) (“ID browsing data”) Is transmitted to the administrator system 3100 using a predetermined transmission method such as a Post method of HTTP (Hypertext Transfer Protocol) (STEP 93: browsing data transmission processing).
  • the HTTP Get method can be used as the transmission method, but it is preferable to use the Post method from the viewpoint of security.
  • the browsing management means 3113 of the administrator system 3100 refers to the user ID of the ID browsing data as the received data, specifies the information viewer who is the transmission source of the ID browsing data, and the user ID
  • the physical ID and browsing time of the ID browsing data are stored in the browsing history table 3123 (STEP 94: ID browsing data storage process).
  • the ID data transmission process and the ID data storage process are configured to be executed immediately when the ID is read without displaying the bookmark page UI 70 on the information viewer terminal 500 and confirming the information viewer.
  • the administrator system 3100 transmits a user registration screen for prompting user registration to the information viewer terminal 500 and displays the user registration screen on the browsing screen 530.
  • the determination as to whether or not the information viewer is a user registration can be made based on, for example, whether or not the administrator system 3100 has logged in from the information viewer terminal 500, and from the information viewer terminal 500 by the ID reading process.
  • the administrator system 3100 determines that the information viewer terminal 500 is not logged in at the time of transmitting a request to the administrator system 3100, the administrator system 3100 uses the user administrator means 140, for example. Then, a screen prompting login (login screen) and a screen prompting user registration (user registration screen) are transmitted to the information viewer terminal 500 and displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information viewer terminal 500.
  • the information viewer logs in using the login screen when the user has been registered.
  • his / her email address is entered as the user ID on the user registration screen. It transmits to the administrator system 3100.
  • the administrator system 3100 automatically issues a unique password (PW) for the user ID of the information viewer using, for example, the user management unit 140, and associates the user ID with the user ID.
  • PW unique password
  • FIG. 64 The browsing process after the bookmark process by the information providing system of the eighth embodiment (including the first and second specific examples) will be described with reference to FIGS. 64 and 65.
  • FIG. 64 the browsing page UI 80 used in the browsing process will be described in detail.
  • the administrator system 3100 creates and updates an individual browsing page UI 80 for each user ID of the information viewer.
  • the individual browsing page UI 80 is updated.
  • the browsing page UI 80 is transmitted to the information viewer terminal 500 of the information viewer. More specifically, the browsing page UI 80 uses the information viewer for each information viewer having a specific user ID (that is, user registration completed in the administrator system 3100) by the browsing page creation unit 3116.
  • the bookmark title unique to the information viewer based on the bookmark information created by referring to the user ID and registered by the information viewer is the product purchase page or guide information information page related to the physical ID that has been bookmarked.
  • a link to that is, with the URL of the information page as the link destination
  • it is displayed in time series on the browsing screen CA1.
  • the browsing screen CA1 is created as a calendar at the time (for example, January 2016) when the information viewer is browsing, and the browsing screen of the information viewer terminal 500 is displayed. It is transmitted to 530 and displayed.
  • the viewing screen CA1 can be created as a calendar with a year / month other than the current year / month, or the current year / month can be displayed as an initial display, and past years / years can be sequentially called. Also good.
  • the browsing page can have any configuration such as a simple time-series list display, but from the viewpoint of convenience during browsing, A calendar format is desirable.
  • the calendar is an easy-to-understand expression common to all people, and the places you stop by during a trip are often stored on two axes: location and time, so you can organize your bookmarks while traveling. It seems that it will be the best one.
  • a bookmark title for example, a product name as a bookmark title, a tourist guide information name
  • a physical ID that has been bookmarked unique to the information viewer related to the browsing screen CA1
  • Cooking recipe names, etc. are displayed.
  • the bookmark title is displayed with a link to the purchase page (net shop) of the product by the purchase means 3200 (that is, the URL of the purchase page as a link destination), and a guide
  • a link to the browsing page of the guide information (tourist guide information or cooking recipe information) is attached (that is, the URL of the guide information browsing page is used as the link destination). Is displayed.
  • FIG. 64 in the date fields of January 5th, 13th, and 29, product names and cooking recipe names as bookmark titles are displayed with links, respectively.
  • a filter list FL for displaying information on the browse page UI80 by filtering information and displaying the bookmarked product and guide information by the information viewer related to the browse page UI80 is displayed in the margin portion (upper margin portion) of the browse screen CA1.
  • a bookmark list BML displaying a list of products and guide information bookmarked by the information viewer related to the browsing page UI80 is displayed.
  • browsing processing using the browsing page UI 80 by the information providing system of the eighth embodiment will be described in detail.
  • the information viewer wants to browse his / her bookmarked information, for example, he accesses the home page UI 75 of the administrator system 3100 and selects a menu for browsing processing (for example, “bookmark browsing”) from the menu screen MN.
  • a menu item having a title is selected and executed (STEP 101: browsing start process).
  • a browsing page UI 80 as shown in FIG. 64 is transmitted and displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the information browsing terminal 500 (STEP 102: browsing page display process).
  • the information viewer transmits his / her user ID to the administrator system 3100 by login processing (for example, using the home page UI 75). Therefore, the administrator system 3100 refers to the user ID by the browsing page creation unit 3116 and uses the physical ID associated with the user ID from the browsing history table 3123 as bookmark information unique to the information viewer. And the date information of the browsing time associated with the physical ID is extracted, and the browsing page UI 80 is created (STEP 102A: browsing page creation process).
  • the browsing page creation unit 3116 displays a calendar-type browsing screen CA1 (STEP 102A1: browsing screen display processing) and displays the filter list FL in the first pane PN1 of the browsing page UI 80 (STEP 102A2: filter).
  • bookmark list display process and the bookmark list BML is displayed in the second pane PN2 (STEP 102A3: bookmark list display process).
  • the bookmark title related to the monthly bookmark on the browsing screen CA1 is the date of the bookmark.
  • the corresponding date field is displayed with the link.
  • the bookmark list BML among the bookmark titles of products and guide information bookmarked by the information viewer, the bookmark titles related to the monthly bookmarks on the browsing screen CA1 are displayed in a list format with the link.
  • a physical medium name product name or guide information name
  • a physical ID in the basic information table 3122 as main information
  • a period range different from the monthly level of the browsing screen CA1 for example, a predetermined period range including the monthly level of the browsing screen CA1 (for example, Bookmark titles related to bookmarks in the past three months or the like) may be displayed in a list format with the link.
  • the filter list FL displays the names (physical medium names) of the physical media to which the physical IDs scheduled by the information providing system of the eighth embodiment are classified according to type (or category).
  • type or category
  • the filter list FL displays the names (physical medium names) of the physical media to which the physical IDs scheduled by the information providing system of the eighth embodiment are classified according to type (or category).
  • This purchase page can be, for example, a web page in which the purchase page BM110 shown in FIG.
  • the administrator system 3100 transmits a guide information page having the detailed information of the guide information as content as shown in FIG. 62 by the information management means.
  • this guide information page can be a tourist guide information page UI 80A as shown in FIG. 62A.
  • the administrator system 3100 displays main information (product information and guide information) of the physical medium related to the bookmark.
  • main information product information and guide information
  • the time series display of the bookmark title on the browsing screen CA1 is updated (STEP 106: time series display update process).
  • the bookmark title is displayed on the browsing screen CA1 in chronological order with reference to the date when the information viewer actually bookmarked (that is, reading the physical ID). Is displayed in the date field of the actual bookmark date.
  • the bookmark of the physical medium bookmarked by the information viewer in the past year and month is displayed on the browsing screen CA1 of the past year and month.
  • the bookmark title of the browsing screen CA1 is selected and executed, and the information page related to the bookmark is browsed, the past bookmark title is In the browsing screen CA1 for the current year and month, it is additionally displayed in the date column corresponding to the current date.
  • the bookmark title of the product “Akafuku” is the current time on the August 2016 viewing screen CA1.
  • the information providing system assigns a physical ID to each type of product, thereby allowing various types of products to be obtained via the purchase unit 3200 of the administrator system 3100.
  • the administrator system 3100 allows a single shopping cart (purchase candidate) provided for each type of product bookmarked by one information viewer. It is possible to adopt a configuration in which products are stored together and stored on a web page for keeping the product ready for purchase. That is, in this case, the administrator system 3100 provides such a shopping cart for each user ID, and each time an information viewer of the user ID bookmarks a specific product, the physical ID of the product is set. It can be set as the structure which can purchase arbitrary goods from the goods preserve
  • an ID medium such as a QR code or an NFC tag is physically arranged at a place where a product such as a souvenir shop / product exhibition is exhibited at a travel destination, and a smartphone or the like.
  • a mechanism to bookmark URLs associated with them on smartphones etc. is constructed.
  • a traveler can easily register a page (in this case, a net shop) associated with the product as a favorite simply by reading a QR code or NFC tag with a smartphone or the like. Even if you have a product that you stop by during your trip, you can record it as a favorite so that you can compare and purchase it on the last day of your trip.
  • this information providing system is placed at a tourist information center, etc., and information on a point a little ahead of the current location where you plan to travel is bookmarked. This makes it a guidebook that travelers can easily take out at any time.
  • the facility In addition to being able to provide the latest information, the facility also has the advantage of saving printing and bookbinding costs and attracting tourists who want to use this function. Furthermore, information can be continuously transmitted to a person who uses a bookmark by e-mail distribution or the like when new information is uploaded.
  • the information providing system of the eighth embodiment for example, compared to a paper medium that can bookmark information that the user actually likes and can easily carry information such as sightseeing spots, There are advantages such as providing the latest information.
  • the information providing system reads a URL (link destination) embedded in a “tag” with a smartphone or the like and simultaneously bookmarks (strictly speaking, the URL for the bookmark embedded in the tag is different from the link destination). ) So you can view it whenever you are connected to the Internet. Therefore, it is superior to those using the conventional AR technology in that it can be used even if it is away from the read place and is not restricted by the place. If your smartphone is a “portable Internet medium” but you use the current AR technology, you can only browse information within a limited range, and you can get information specific to that location.
  • the information providing system of the eighth embodiment it is possible not only to easily access information with a smartphone or the like, but also to easily reuse what has been acquired once.
  • users are not restricted by location or time when using it, and can acquire user behavior trends such as travel destinations without requiring many facilities.
  • the installation location is fixed. Therefore, if the location information of the place where it is installed is recorded as data in advance, an advantage that even GPS is not necessary can be expected.
  • the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment can be applied to, for example, use in retail stores, and can be applied to the development of products sold at stores.
  • users can purchase their favorite products later by bookmarking them and registering them as favorites without purchasing them on the spot.
  • Build a mechanism. Net shop with only one item tied to a tag, etc.
  • the Internet is used for gifts as the survey results indicate that more than half of the places where “gifts” such as Mother's Day and birthday gifts for parents are purchased are on the Internet.
  • a problem with purchasing on the Internet is that it may be different from your imagination because you cannot actually see the product.
  • the system of this information provision system once registered as a user, can be purchased just by entering a password without having to enter information such as an address every time a product is purchased.
  • the information providing system of the eighth embodiment can be expected to be used at road SA / PA and road stations, and can also be expected to develop as a tourist information transmission function in the vicinity. That is, it can be used to add value to the information depending on the land, such as recording a tourist information pamphlet as described above.
  • a local recipe or the like unique to the land is arranged at a tourist information center or the like, and the recipe is recorded as a bookmark when the user accesses the tag while traveling.
  • Some special products sold at roadside stations have local cooking methods. If agricultural products used in recipes obtained at tourist information centers are sold at roadside stations, etc., there is a possibility that this will encourage purchase intentions. In the recipe, you can also introduce the roadside station where the ingredients are sold.
  • the information providing system of Embodiment 3 can be expected to be used as a new advertising model, and can be expected to be developed as big data including “location”.
  • placing a tag on the place will have a great meaning.
  • the tag at the coffee shop acts like a tourist information board, the advertiser who wants to display the advertisement to the person who accesses the place puts out an advertisement, and the shop owner of the coffee shop puts the tag there Just leave it, you can get advertising revenue.
  • the secondary user can use the URL (URL of advertisement medium suitable for his service or web page ( If the URL of the web page is also selectable, and the advertisement request is permitted to the advertising media owner (Pull Request), the advertising media owner sees the pull request and permits or rejects it. You can also.
  • the URL of the permitted advertisement information is posted on the list of URLs of the advertisement medium, a contract is established, and an incentive according to the number of clicks, conversion, or the like can be paid. It can also be configured to pay the administrator a specific percentage of incentives.
  • the advertisement medium owner declares “this tag is prepared in this place”, requests the administrator system 2100 on the service providing side, and the administrator system 2100 on the service providing side receives the ID and URL. And a web page that displays the status (number of accesses, location, etc.) of the advertising medium is prepared and displayed to the advertiser.
  • the advertiser selects a medium suitable for his / her service from among them, and associates the tag with the URL. Then, the advertisement medium owner and the administrator of the administrator system 2100 on the service provider side receive the incentive from the advertiser.
  • the information providing system according to Embodiment 3 of the present invention can be applied to a business model as an advertising medium to the last, but can also be used as a place for information disclosure for a corresponding item (device or place). .
  • a large business operator registers the same product ID for the same product of the company, and an ID medium to which the product ID is attached is attached to a product delivered to a store in each place handling the product. You can also. For example, when a major liquor manufacturer registers an item ID for a specific liquor product of the company, attaches an ID medium storing the item ID to the liquor product, and places the liquor product at stores in various locations, A customer at each store reads the ID medium of the liquor product, so that the major liquor manufacturer can acquire information about the liquor product at each location. For example, it is possible to acquire where and how many people in the country have browsed information on the product.
  • the large business operator is the advertiser.
  • stores in various locations can be paid royalties and commissions from major businesses by attaching an ID medium (according to the superiority of the location) to their stores.
  • Embodiment 9 As a specific example of the main information utilization type information providing system, an information providing system according to the ninth embodiment will be described as an embodiment obtained by further improving and developing the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment.
  • the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment is obtained by further extending and developing the technical idea of the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment.
  • the information providing system according to Embodiment 9 can be an embodiment in which various functions of the information providing system according to each of the above embodiments are implemented alone or in appropriate combination.
  • this point is the same in the information providing system according to the eighth embodiment.
  • the outline of the features of the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment will be described through comparison with the prior art.
  • SNS systems Conventional social network service systems (hereinafter referred to as “SNS systems”) are actually touched, viewed, and viewed via hearing information (eg, rumors about a product) between people. It is a system that can be used to attract customers for products that are not available. That is, the SNS system is a system in which the quality of a product or the like can be recognized for the first time by obtaining the actual product.
  • the information providing system according to the invention of Embodiment 9 connects (links) a repeater for what is actually held in hand, touched, viewed or seen (that is, actually experienced). ) System.
  • a conventional e-mail with a photo using the camera function of a smartphone or mobile phone it is not possible to record the product etc. by photographing what you actually experienced (for example, the product you liked at the travel destination)
  • the experienced person often forgets the recording destination of the product or forgets that the product has been recorded over time (such as after returning home from the travel destination). In this case, it becomes impossible to access information such as merchandise recorded at the corner.
  • the existing dissemination technology including a two-dimensional barcode such as a QR code (“QR code” is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED) and NFC is used.
  • QR code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED
  • NFC is used.
  • Using the content related to the object (for example, souvenirs, etc.) about the experiences (such as souvenirs, tourist attractions, events, etc., hereinafter referred to as “objects”) Merchandise information, etc.) can be easily recorded, and the contents of the recorded object can be reliably accessed at a later date.
  • a two-dimensional barcode is used to easily access a web page having a specific content, for example, when acquiring product information of a specific product or using a coupon code.
  • it is a system that reads the two-dimensional barcode on the spot and accesses the content, and cannot be used for acquiring the product information at a later date.
  • a system that gives a unique two-dimensional barcode to a packaging container or the like of a specific product in a store and accesses the website having the product information as content by reading the two-dimensional barcode In this case, in order to access the content website, it is necessary to read the two-dimensional barcode of the product at the store. In other words, if you remember a specific product (such as a souvenir from a travel destination) that you have seen at a specific store and want to purchase the product at a later date, It is usually difficult to remember even the product name.
  • the product can be obtained by a mobile terminal device having a communication function such as a smartphone at any timing after leaving the store.
  • the product information can be easily called, and the possibility of purchasing the product can be examined at a later date.
  • the information providing system according to the invention of Embodiment 9 when a person likes a specific product at a specific store, the person wants to purchase the product at a later date (or later timing) If you think that you want to give a gift to someone else in the middle of the year or at the end of the year, for example, you only need to record a mark (bookmark or memory) about the product at that store, and use your smartphone later.
  • Information on the bookmarked product can be acquired easily and reliably.
  • smartphones are becoming popular as information acquisition means in place of personal computers (PCs) in recent years.
  • the information about can be recorded and the information can be acquired at a later date.
  • two-dimensional barcodes and NFC are one means of information technology with high convenience, but they are only used to acquire information at that time (where two-dimensional barcodes and NFC are located). Can not do it.
  • the information providing system according to the invention of Embodiment 9 is an information providing system that expands the use scene of the conventional two-dimensional barcode or NFC.
  • C2C Consumer To Consumer: general consumers and general consumers Can also be used for cross-border EC (Electric Commerce). That is, the conventional SNS system has been difficult to apply to these uses, but the information providing system according to the invention of Embodiment 9 can be used, for example, for people who come to local tourist information centers and souvenir shops.
  • the information providing system according to the invention of Embodiment 9 replaces the “Like” of the conventional SNS system, secures a repeater, and actually touches the information on the product, etc. It is a system to fill the time lag between when you want to call.
  • the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment includes an administrator system 4100 (corresponding to the administrator system 100) (corresponding to the information providing system according to the first embodiment shown in FIG. 1), And a user terminal device 4200 (corresponding to the primary user system 200 or the secondary user system 300 or the information viewer terminal 500).
  • the user terminal device 4200 is a user computer device (hereinafter referred to as “user PC”) 4200A, a user PC 4200B, or a user portable terminal device (typically a user smartphone, hereinafter referred to as “user SP”). ) 4200C.
  • the user terminal device 4200 is a computer device or computer system owned and managed by the user (user) of the information providing system of the ninth embodiment, and the user is the same as in the first embodiment.
  • it may become a store related person, and in addition to this, it may become a store or product related person (corresponding to the secondary user in the first embodiment) related to a certain store or a certain product.
  • the general consumer of Form 1 (such as a person who actually contacts an actual product in an actual store, or a person who actually contacts an article of information printed matter at an information installation location).
  • the user terminal device 4200 has various functions provided by the information means 4210 (various functions provided by the information providing system by the function providing means 4115, such as a my-memory processing function and a memory service processing function described later). ).
  • function providing means 4115 provided on the server side by the administrator system 4100 (for example, function provision realized by a server side program)
  • the user terminal device 4200 as the client device can be configured as information means 4210A for acquiring the function via “WEB” in the user terminal device 4200A of FIG. 66, for example.
  • the 66 can be configured as an information unit 4210B that realizes its function by “app (application)” in the user terminal device 4200B of FIG.
  • the information means 4210, 4210A, and 4210B of the user terminal devices 4200, 4200a, and 4200b correspond to the processing functions of the administrator system described later (for memory management functions such as my memory processing and memory service processing).
  • Memory management unit 4211 (which realizes a corresponding function), page management unit 4212 (which realizes a function corresponding to a page management function such as page creation processing), and a function which corresponds to an article management function (such as article creation processing) )
  • Article management means 4213 event management means 4214 (which realizes functions corresponding to event management functions such as event creation processing), work management means 4215 (which realizes functions corresponding to work management functions and product management functions), and products Management means 4216, (functions corresponding to collaboration management functions such as collaboration application processing Current to) collaboration management unit 4217, and a (realizing the functions corresponding to the shelf management function of the item shelf processing) provided with the rack management unit 4218, the management unit further realize other management functions 4219.
  • the user terminal device 4200 is illustrated as managing data by the database DB. Normally, however, processing related to data storage is realized by a normal PC file system without using the DB. can do.
  • the system configuration relating to the information exchange of the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment can be the same hardware configuration and software configuration as the information providing system according to the first embodiment (except for the features of the invention).
  • the system configuration related to information browsing of the information providing system of the ninth embodiment can be the same hardware configuration and software configuration as those of the information providing system of the first embodiment (except for the features of the invention).
  • the network configuration of the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment can be the same as the network configuration of the information providing system according to the first embodiment (except for the characterizing portion of the invention).
  • the physical medium providing place of the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment can have the same configuration as that of the information providing system according to the first embodiment (except for the characteristic part of the invention).
  • products things and stores (locations), people (creators, etc.), and things (events, etc.) can also be used as business cards (such as creators) .
  • a node ID is used as an identifier corresponding to the local ID.
  • an ID storage medium for storing the node ID a two-dimensional barcode or NFC tag is used as in the first embodiment. Etc. can be used.
  • this node ID is stored in an ID storage medium (hereinafter also referred to as “bookmark” or “memory”) made up of a two-dimensional barcode or the like.
  • an information providing system includes an administrator system 4100, a user system 4200, a physical medium providing place 4400 (corresponding to the physical medium providing place 400), and a Web server 600. It has.
  • the user (user) of the user terminal device 4200 is not only a user such as a trader as the main user of the first embodiment, but also individuals, creators, event promoters, There are store managers, advertising media providers, etc., and in particular, individuals such as general consumers are also able to use for themselves.
  • my memory (which may be abbreviated as “MM” in the present application document) that is an ID storage medium corresponding to the bookmark according to the first embodiment is used.
  • the method is characterized by executing various processes to be described later.
  • the administrator system 4100 includes information management means 4110.
  • the information management unit 4110 realizes a function of managing various types of information such as information provided to the user terminal device 4200.
  • the administrator system 4100 also includes a management information database (hereinafter referred to as “management information DB”) 4120.
  • the management information DB 4120 realizes a function of storing various types of information such as main information provided to the user terminal device 4200 in cooperation with the information management unit 4110.
  • a user interface (GUI) for managing the various types of information is displayed on the management screen 130 of the administrator system 4100, and a person in charge can manage the management information via the management screen 130.
  • GUI user interface
  • the information management unit 4110 of the administrator system 4100 includes a node management unit 4111, an edge management unit 4112, a service management unit 4113, a data management unit 4114, and a function providing unit 115, and is not shown.
  • a configuration (function realization means) for realizing various processing functions in cooperation with the management information DB 4120 is provided.
  • the node management unit 4111 refers to data such as a node table described later (and a user table described later in the case of processing for a registered user) and the like, and performs a memory reading operation (and ID information corresponding to the read memory). Based on this, it is possible to create a new node (that is, a new node table), update the node table, and perform functions such as setting a node type for each node ID of the node table. It is a function realization means for realizing various processing functions.
  • the edge management unit 4112 refers to data such as a node table and an edge table to be described later, based on a memory reading operation (and ID information corresponding to the read memory), and a certain node (first node) A new edge for forming a link with another node (second node) is generated to generate a data structure of a subject / predicate / object relationship, as described later, or an edge table And a function implementing means for realizing various functions related to the edge, such as realizing a function such as setting an edge type for each edge of the edge table.
  • the service management unit 4113 is a function implementation unit that implements processing related to various services with reference to data such as a node table and an edge table.
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementation unit that implements processing such as addition / creation / editing / deletion of various data with reference to data such as a node table and an edge table. Specifically, the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes. Note that part of the following functions (particularly functions related to service processing) may be configured to be realized by the service management unit 4113.
  • P10 Processing related to memory recorded for each user (hereinafter also referred to as “my memory”) (hereinafter also referred to as “my memory processing”).
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the above-described (P10) my memory process.
  • P11 My memory category selection list display processing
  • P12 My memory favorite registration processing
  • P13 My memory selection list display processing only favorite registration memory selection processing
  • P141 When information of specific my memory is displayed by selecting specific my memory in the selection list display processing of my memory, Mail transmission processing to the node of other memory (node of others)
  • P142 When selecting a specific my memory and displaying the information of the specific my memory in the selection list display processing of the my memory Notification from the node (the other's node) Whether the selection process receives a)
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the memory service process (P20).
  • P21 New memory creation processing in memory service processing
  • P22 Memory management processing after new memory creation in memory service processing
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the new memory creation process (P21).
  • P211 Selective memory creation processing that enables execution of memory creation processing for each memory category in new memory creation processing of memory service processing (P2111) Selection for each memory category in new memory creation processing of memory service processing Page creation process unique to the memory (node) when the dynamic memory creation process is executed (P2112)
  • P2111 Selective memory creation processing that enables execution of memory creation processing for each memory category in new memory creation processing of memory service processing
  • Selection for each memory category in new memory creation processing of memory service processing of memory service processing Page creation process unique to the memory (node) when the dynamic memory creation process is executed
  • P2112 In the new memory creation process of the memory service process, when the selective memory creation process for each memory category is executed , Create memory for printing memory (node)
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementation unit that implements a selective memory management process that enables a memory management process to be executed for each memory category as various processes subordinate to the memory management process of (P22).
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the memory management process of (P22).
  • the work management process of (P224) is a process realized in the memory management process when the category “Koto” is selected
  • the product management process of (P225) is a process when the category “thing” is selected. This process is realized in the memory management process.
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the article management process (P221).
  • P2211 Letter transmittable number confirmation process for displaying letter transmittable number on article management screen
  • P2212 Letter purchase process for enabling letter purchase when letter transmittable number is insufficient on article management screen
  • Article creation processing for creating a new article on the article management screen (P22131)
  • storage / publication processing for temporarily saving or publishing a new article
  • Article list display processing for displaying a list of existing articles on the article management screen (P22141)
  • the properties of the selected article article name, publication target, Article attribute screen showing the number of collectable letters that can be sent, number of people sent, number of read, etc.
  • Article attribute display processing to be displayed (P221411)
  • Article content display processing for displaying the article content display screen for displaying the content of the article (actual display content
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the event management process (P222).
  • P2221 Ticket number confirmation process for displaying the number of tickets (for events) on the event management screen
  • P2222 Ticket that allows ticket purchase when the number of tickets (for events) is insufficient on the event management screen Purchase processing
  • P2223 Article creation processing for creating a new article on the event management screen (P22231)
  • article creation processing is performed on the article management screen, a new article is temporarily saved or saved / published for publication Processing
  • P22241 Article List Display Processing for Displaying List of Existing Articles on Event Management Screen
  • the content of the selected article is displayed.
  • Article content display processing for displaying the article content display screen P22242
  • Print memory creation processing for creating print memory for the article node on the article content display screen (P2225)
  • Collaboration request processing for requesting collaboration of other nodes on the article management screen (P22251)
  • Collaboration request confirmation process for displaying the URL for collaboration request, selecting the person requesting the collaboration, searching for the person requesting the collaboration, etc. on the event collaboration request screen displayed in the collaboration request process
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the page management process (P223).
  • P2231 Page editing processing for editing a created page on the page management processing screen
  • P2232 Printing for creating a printing memory for the node corresponding to the created page on the page management processing screen Memory creation process
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the work management process (P224).
  • P2241 Work addition processing for adding a new work on the work management processing screen
  • P22421 Remaining display shelf number display processing for displaying the number of remaining display shelves on the work management processing screen (P22421) Displaying the number of remaining display shelves
  • P2243 The work list display process that displays a list of the created works on the work management process screen (P22431) Listed in the work list display process Display shelf processing that enables entry / exit of the work to / from the display shelf by selecting one of the works (P22432) By selecting any of the works listed in the work list display process, Work information display process to display information
  • the data management unit 4114 is a function implementing unit that implements the following processes as various processes subordinate to the product management process (P225).
  • P2251 Product addition processing for adding a new product on the product management processing screen
  • P22521 Remaining product shelf number display processing for displaying the number of remaining product shelves on the product management processing screen (P22521) Displaying the number of remaining product shelves
  • the product shelf purchase process that enables the purchase of additional product shelves
  • P2253 In the product management process screen, the product list display process that displays a list of added products (P22531)
  • the product list display process displays a list.
  • the management information DB 4120 can be configured by a relational database (RDB) as in the first embodiment.
  • RDB relational database
  • the management information DB 4120 has a data structure (data schema) as shown in FIGS. can do.
  • RDB relational database
  • FIGS. data schema
  • an example in which the management information DB 4120 is configured by an RDB will be described.
  • the management information DB 4120 is configured by a DB other than the RDB, the same description can be obtained by replacing “table” with “file”. Specifically, in the example shown in FIGS.
  • the management information DB 4120 stores, as a master table, a node type (node_type) that is data defining a node type in association with a node type name (node_type_name).
  • An order ID (order_id), a node ID (node_id), and a user ID used in the node type table (node_types), edge type table (edge_types), shelf type table (shelf_types), (not shown) billing processing table group A sequence table (sequences) for storing (user_id) in association with each other.
  • the management information DB 4120 includes a node table (nodes), a node state table (node_status), an edge table (edges), a user table (user), a lead list table (read_list), an article table (articles), a letter as a transaction table.
  • Node table nodes
  • node_status node state table
  • edge table edges
  • user table user
  • lead list table read_list
  • article table article table
  • article_attached_images FIG.
  • the management information DB 4120 includes a table for storing data for a paid service in association with a charging-related table.
  • the management information DB 4120 can also include other tables (such as a browsing history table) similar to the management information DB 120 of the first embodiment.
  • the node table (nodes) is a table for storing and managing a node ID and related information for each memory, and corresponds to the node table of the second embodiment.
  • the node table includes, as field names (column names or column names), a node ID (node_id), a node key (node_key), an owner node ID (owner_node_id), a root node ID (root_node_id), a node name (name), and a node image (node_image).
  • the node ID in the node table is a unique identifier (ID) assigned to each specific object as the local ID.
  • the node ID can have an arbitrary configuration like the article ID of the first embodiment.
  • a guest user (who has not yet accessed this information providing system) can access the guest issued by the administrator system 4100 by using the camera function and ID reading function of his / her smartphone.
  • Log in as a guest user to this information provision system by reading the guest memory (eg, the two-dimensional barcode displayed on the introduction leaflet of the information provision system or the introduction web page) consisting of be able to.
  • the guest memory is the web page accessed by the guest user (the web page displayed on the guest user's smartphone) at this time, and the login web page (so-called landing page) prepared in advance by the information providing system.
  • This landing page is also processed as a node in the information providing system, and has a unique node ID for the landing page.
  • the information providing system assigns a node unique to the guest user (node management in FIG. 1). (Using means 4111 etc.) and assigning a unique node ID to the node.
  • This node ID is an ID composed of serial numbers (easily guessed by others). Therefore, the node key is a key (a key obtained by complicating the node ID with a hash or the like) uniquely assigned to the node ID in consideration of a case where information is provided to the outside.
  • a user table is created that stores the user information of that user in association with the guest user's node table.
  • the information providing system accesses the information providing system from the next time onward.
  • the node table data of the user is acquired through the node ID of the user table, and the login process of the user is executed. That is, at this time, the information providing system collates the user ID (or email address) and password entered by the registered user with the user ID (or email address) and password of the user table (via the user table). ) Refers indirectly to the node table.
  • the guest user does not execute the user registration process of this information provision system, no user table is created for that guest user. Even in this case, the guest user has his own node at this point (that is, a node table unique to the guest user has been created), but accesses the information providing system from the next time onward.
  • the information providing system cannot use the node ID to execute the same login process as that of the registered user. Therefore, for this time, the present information providing system uses the existing cookie when the guest user accesses for the first time (that is, for the request at the time of the first access) (using the node management means 4111 or the like).
  • the guest key (unique to the guest user) is stored in the response cookie, and the guest key is stored in the node table of the guest user.
  • the information providing system uses the guest key in the node table to execute the same login process as that of the registered user. . That is, at this time, the guest user's request (at the time of access) includes the guest in the cookie (as long as the guest user permits cookies and if the cookie has not disappeared due to the retention period elapses).
  • a guest key unique to the user is stored, and this information providing system checks the guest key against the guest key in the node table of the guest user and stores the guest key (that is, the guest user).
  • the login process similar to that of the registered user is executed through the node ID with reference to the node table.
  • the login process to the information providing system includes a login process as a guest user and a login process as a registered user.
  • the node table of the registered user is indirectly accessed via the node ID of the user table. That is, according to whether the user table exists for the accessing user, this information providing system is either a guest user (without a user table) or an owner (owner user) as a registered user (with a user table). Is identified.
  • the owner node ID when the user accesses and logs in to the information providing system after the next time, the value of the node ID (created at the first access) becomes the node ID of the user who owns the node. Stored in the owner node ID (that is, the node ID becomes the owner node ID). In this way, an owner (guest user or registered user) having an owner node can change his / her alternation (owner node), which is a substantial existence (physical existence) in the physical world (realized by this information providing system). It can be created in a virtual world on the net, and only one owner node can be owned as a special node.
  • the value of the owner node (flag) in the node table is changed from “0” (indicating that it is not yet an owner node) to “1” (indicating that it is an owner node).
  • a guest user can also own only one node, like a registered user.
  • the user who owns the owner node records the memory of another node somewhere (for example, the node corresponding to the memory attached to a specific product at a specific store), and then the owner of that user A node (hereinafter sometimes referred to as “main node”) becomes the subject, and another node (hereinafter also referred to as “subordinate node”) becomes the object, and these main node and subordinate node become ( Linked (associated) by edges (defined in an edge table described later).
  • the edge is a predicate that connects the subject and each purpose.
  • this information provision system uses a node table and an edge table to link one node and another node with one edge, and expresses it as a subject, predicate, and object.
  • the node table is a self-referencing table
  • the nodes are linked with each other by using only the node table and the edge table, and
  • the relationship can be expressed by the relationship between the subject, predicate, and object.
  • the root node ID is an ID indicating the highest hierarchy (root hierarchy) when there is a memory having a hierarchical structure. For example, there is a net shop memory (for example, the user of the net shop If you have memory for a product that you sell in that net shop (for example, if the user owns the memory for the net shop), the node ID of that net shop is It becomes the root node ID (in the sense of becoming the root node of the product node). For example, when a customer of a certain net shop sends a “letter” (which is a notification of an “article” described later) to a node of the net shop for a net shop owned by a certain user.
  • a “letter” which is a notification of an “article” described later
  • the letter is not the node of the product, but the root node ID of the node of the net shop to which the product belongs (ie, based on the node ID of the product and referring to the root node ID of the node table)
  • the letter is sent directly to the node of the net shop.
  • the owner node exists at a higher level of the net shop as a hierarchical structure.
  • the letter is based on the owner node ID of the node table (not the node of the net shop). Sent directly to the node.
  • the node name is an arbitrary character string assigned to the node.
  • the node image is an image (image) assigned to the node (displayed on the display screen for the node as a thumbnail or the like).
  • the user ID is a unique ID of the registered user stored in the user table.
  • the service ID is an ID that is uniquely assigned to various services provided by the present law provision system. That is, the present law providing system is a service providing system that provides various services in an integrated / integrated manner.
  • the node type is an ID for specifying the node type
  • the node category is an ID for specifying the node category.
  • the node category includes categories (classification) such as self (owner, etc.), “people” (creators, etc.), “things” (events, etc.), “things” (products, etc.), “places” (net shops, etc.)
  • the node type is specified by subdividing the node type further than the node category.
  • a product for example, node A1 of a net shop (for example, node A) and a work (for example, node B1) of a creator (for example, node B) are in the same category as “things” of the node category.
  • There is a node type such as "(Shop) product", "(Creator's) work", etc., specifically what the "thing” is (for example, creator's work) This is a subcategory of categories.
  • the external URI stores “0” or “1” as a flag, and is set to “1” when the information page of the node is specified by the external URI (not the internal URI of the information providing system).
  • the external URI is set to “0” when the information page of the node is an internal URI of the information providing system.
  • the external URI is “1” (only when “1”), the node URI is used. At this time, the external URI is stored in the node URI.
  • the prefecture ID (prefecture_id) is an ID that identifies the prefecture where the memory exists. Geohash specifies geographic information (latitude, longitude).
  • the node description expresses the detailed contents of the node (typically by JASON), and stores information such as the name of the person, the store name and address of the shop, and the representative.
  • the node start date specifies the start date when the start date is set for the node.
  • the node end date specifies the end when the end is set for the node. For example, when a deadline is set for the node (for example, a specific product is displayed on a shelf defined in a shelf-related table described later, and the display period is limited (for example, 60 days) The display period (for example, 60 days) is counted down from the start of the use of the shelf by the product (the display start time using the display function of the product).
  • a deadline for the node
  • 60 days is counted down from the start of the use of the shelf by the product (the display start time using the display function of the product).
  • the number of memories is the number of people who recorded the node (by memory) (number of people), and the number of favorites is the number of people who registered the node as favorites (by the favorite function) (number of people).
  • the theme allows the theme of the information page of the node to be freely changed by CSS or the like.
  • the default memory is a name of a memory (such as a two-dimensional barcode) generated by default. In other words, in this information provision system, when a node is created for the first time, a unique memory (such as a two-dimensional barcode) is always created by default, but the default memory is the memory of the memory such as the two-dimensional barcode at this time.
  • the name is uploaded to the network via the cloud and stored as an image tag.
  • the status is a value representing the status of the node, and stores values such as “0”, “1”, “2”, and is set to “0” when the node is unavailable, for example. For a guest user, it is set to “1”, and for deleting the node, it is set to “ ⁇ 1”.
  • the owner node is “0” when the node is not yet the owner node, and is set to “1” when the node becomes the owner node.
  • the service node is a flag for specifying whether or not the node belongs to the service. When the node is a service such as a net shop or a place, the service node is set to “1”, If it is not a service, it is set to “0”.
  • the service key is a key that is separate from the node key, and is a key that is disclosed to the outside by a two-dimensional barcode or the like. This service key is a memory key for identifying a menu provided by the information providing system.
  • the owner can own various services in relation to the owner node, and the service can be disclosed to the outside together with the memory, but the menu key is known to the outside.
  • a service key is provided as an external key.
  • “Publish” is a flag for specifying whether the node is public or private, and is set to “1” when the node is public, and is set to “0” when the node is private.
  • the charging node is used when charging occurs, and the price stores the price when charging occurs.
  • the creation date stores the creation date (creation date) of the node
  • the update date stores the update date (update date) of the node.
  • the refusal number is the number of people (nodes) who have not received a letter from that node, and is the total number of people (nodes) who have refused the letter from that node. By referring to the number of rejections, it is possible to determine which person (which node) is rejecting (based on the node ID of the node that is the destination of the rejected letter).
  • the state (status) will be described in relation to the edge table. When the state (status) of a specific destination node is “0”, a letter is transmitted from the node to the specific node. I can't do it.
  • the node type table is a table that defines the node type of the node table, and has a node type (node_type) and a node type name (node_type_name) as field names (column names or column names). Store in the corresponding field of the record (each tuple). As described above, the node type is “person” or the like, and the node type name is a name given to the node type.
  • the node state table is a table that defines the state of a node in the node table, and has a state ID (status_id) and a state name (status_name) as field names (column names or column names), and each value is recorded in each record. Store in the corresponding field of (each tuple).
  • the state ID is an ID that uniquely represents the state of the node, and the state name is a name assigned to each state ID.
  • the user table is a table that stores user registration information.
  • a user ID user_id
  • an e-mail email
  • a password password
  • Each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the user table has event ticket (event_ticket), node ID (node_id), and storage token (remember_token) as unique data, and stores each value in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the event ticket is data related to an event purchase ticket
  • the node ID is the node ID of the node table
  • the storage token is data for logging in the guest user.
  • the edge table is a table corresponding to the link table of the second embodiment, but a link is formed between one node (first node) and another node (second node) as in the link table.
  • the table further stores description information for expressing the relationship between the subject, predicate, and object described above by the first node, the second node, and the edge by the link.
  • the edge table includes, as field names (column names or column names), a node ID 1 (node_id 1), a node ID 2 (node_id 2), a root node ID (root_node_id), a weight (weight), an edge type (edge_type), and a start date (date_from).
  • End date (date_to), geohash (geo_hash), state (status), creation date (created_at), and update date (updated_at), each value being stored in the corresponding field of each record (each tuple) To do.
  • the node ID 1 is a node ID of one node (first node) when a link is formed by an edge (for example, as described above, between the first node and the second node), and the node ID 2 is , The node ID of the other node (second node).
  • the root node ID is as described in the node table.
  • the weight corresponds to the link strength in the second embodiment, and indicates the link strength between the nodes. In the ninth embodiment, for example, when a user of a certain owner node records a memory of another node (for example, a memory of a product), the weight is set between the owner node and the product node at the time of recording.
  • the weight of the edge to be linked is “1”, but if the owner subsequently registers the product memory as a favorite, the weight of the edge between the owner node and the product node is incremented to “2”.
  • the weight of the edge that links between the owner node and the creator node is “1” at the time of recording.
  • the edge weight that links between the owner node and the creator node is set to “2”. Incremented.
  • the edge type identifies and expresses the attribute of the edge that functions as a predicate as described above. For example, it is recorded (memory becomes an attribute when various memories are recorded), (network shop node, etc.) Owned (have), held (have an attribute when holding an event, etc.) held (hold), a role (becomes an attribute when playing a specific role in an event, etc.) (Role), (participate in an event or the like) (participate). As long as the edge functions as a predicate, any edge type can be used, and various attributes can be stored as the edge type.
  • the start date stores the date (date and time) when the edge is generated
  • the end date stores the date (date and time) when the link by the edge is completed, but is provided for each edge. Note that the relationship between the nodes (edge type) by the edge is not only recorded (memory), but when the edge has an expiration date, that is, the edge is valid only during a period from a certain time point to the next certain time point.
  • the date and time are stored on the start date and the end date.
  • first node when a certain node (first node) records another node (second node), and when there is a contract relationship between the first node and the second node (that is, the first node) Between the first node and the second node, the first node indicating that the first node has recorded the second node (edge type is “record”) as an edge linking the first node and the second node.
  • first node when a certain node (first node) records another node (second node), and when there is a contract relationship between the first node and the second node (that is, the first node) Between the first node and the second node, the first node indicating that the first node has recorded the second node (edge type is “record”) as an edge linking the first node and the second node.
  • this contract period is the start of the second edge
  • the date and the end date (or only the end date) are stored, and after the contract period, the link by the first edge between the first node and the second node does not disappear, but the first node and the second node
  • Link according to the second edge between cuts i.e., defining the end of the contract
  • the start date and the end date are for providing a valid period on the link side for the predicate (edge) that connects the subject (first node) and the object (second node).
  • the geo-hash is similar to the geo-hash of the node table.
  • the geo-hash in the node table indicates the position of the node itself, and is “null” when the geo-hash is not registered.
  • geohash for example, when memory is transmitted to the shop, the location information of the shop where the memory is transmitted (destination) is stored, and the location information separate from the transmission source is stored. The Since the creation date and the update date are the same as the creation date and the update date of the node table, the description is omitted.
  • the edge type table is a table that defines the edge type of the edge table, and has an edge ID (edge_id) and a name (name) as field names (column names or column names), and each value is stored in each record ( Store in the corresponding field of each tuple.
  • the edge ID is an edge ID of the edge table, and the name (edge name) is a name uniquely given to the edge ID.
  • the article table creates an article (equivalent to a blog) for the purpose of advertising other people's own memory created by the owner node user (using the memory service described later).
  • the table stores article information related to the article.
  • the article table includes, as field names (column names or column names), article ID (article_id), root node ID (root_node_id), node ID (node_id), service ID (service_id), article type (article_type), and status (status). , Title (body), body (body), creation date (created_at), and update date (updated_at), and each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the article ID is an ID that uniquely identifies the created article.
  • the root node ID is as described in the first embodiment.
  • the node ID is the node ID of the node that created the article.
  • the service ID is a unique ID assigned to each service in the memory service.
  • the article type indicates the type of article.
  • the state is the same as the state of the node table or edge table.
  • the letter table for example, creates an article (equivalent to a blog) for the purpose of advertising other people's own memory created by the owner node user (using the memory service described later). In this case, when it is desired to notify the other node of the article, this is a table for storing notification information regarding the notification.
  • the letter table includes an article ID (article_id), a destination node ID (to_node_id), a destination owner node ID (to_owner_node_id), a root node ID (root_node_id), and a node ID (node_id) as field names (column names or column names). , Read state (read_status), creation date (created_at), and update date (updated_at), each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the article ID is the article ID of the article table.
  • the transmission destination node ID is a node ID of a node that is a transmission destination of a letter (article notification).
  • the transmission destination owner node ID is the node ID of the owner node when the node to which the letter (article notification) is transmitted is the owner node.
  • the root node ID is as described in the node table, for example, the node ID of the net shop node when there is a net shop node and a product node, and the node ID is the node ID of the product in this case is there.
  • the already-read state is a flag indicating whether or not the article of the letter has been read in the destination node.
  • the above-mentioned article and letter created at a certain node are sent to the person (node) who records the node, for example, set to send only to the person (node) who has registered the node as a favorite.
  • the letter transmits link information (article ID etc.) to the corresponding article to each of the destination nodes, and the article body (of the article via the article ID)
  • the communication load can be greatly reduced.
  • the information providing system enables a creator-related work or a product of a shop to be displayed on a shelf and made public by using a shelf-related table (and removed from the display of the shelf and made private)
  • the structure is also characterized.
  • the item shelf table is a table for storing and managing shelf information in the case of displaying items such as creator's works and net shop products.
  • the item shelf table includes a node ID (node_id), a user ID (user_id), a maximum number (max_num), a usage number (use_num), a creation date (created_at), and an update date (field name (column name or column name)). updated_at) and each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the node ID is a node ID of a user node (owner node) that creates the item shelf.
  • the user ID is the user ID of the user who is the owner of the item shelf.
  • the maximum number is the maximum number of works or products that can enter the item shelf.
  • the number of uses is the total number of items placed in the item shelf.
  • the cart shelf table is a table for storing and managing cart information (corresponding to an Internet shopping cart) as a shelf.
  • the cart shelf table includes a node ID (node_id), a user ID (user_id), a maximum number (max_num), a used number (use_num), a creation date (created_at), and an update date (field name (column name or column name)). updated_at) and each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the node ID is a node ID of a user node (owner node) that creates the cart shelf.
  • the user ID is the user ID of the user who is the owner of the cart shelf.
  • the maximum number is the maximum number of works or products that can enter the cart shelf.
  • the number of uses is the total number of items placed in the cart shelf.
  • the cart shelf line table includes, as field names (column names or column names), ID (id), node ID (node_id), order ID (order_id), used node ID (use_node_Id), shelf type (shelf_type), number of days (days) ), Expiration date (expire_date), state (status), creation date (created_at), and update date (updated_at), each value is stored in a corresponding field of each record (each tuple).
  • the exhibition deadline is not set for the creator's work (item), but the shop product has a deadline, so the shelf type of the cart shelf line table is used,
  • the type is differentiated.
  • a shelf type in which a time limit is set such as a time limit “60 days” or a time limit “30 days” is prepared.
  • the used node ID is a node ID of a shelf product (a product that uses the shelf).
  • the number of days is set to “60 days” for a shelf with a time limit, and is set to “0 days” for a shelf with no time limit (permanent display).
  • the status is a flag indicating the status of the shelf, and stores “0” or “1”.
  • the information viewer uses the user terminal device 4200 to physically view the ID media 411 and 411a of the product 410A and the printed guide information 410A (or printed information 401B) as shown in FIG. ID (that is, memory) is read (ID reading process). Then, the memory recording page UI 170 shown in FIG. 72 is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the user terminal device 4200 (confirmation screen display processing).
  • the confirmation screen display processing of the memory recording page UI 170 in the user terminal device 4200 is the same as the bookmark processing in the eighth embodiment.
  • the information viewer executes a selection execution process (such as clicking the “Yes” button) for confirming that the memory is recorded on the memory recording page UI 170, the user terminal device 4200.
  • the data including the node ID unique to the memory of the product 410A, the user ID of the information viewer (for registered users) or the guest key (for guest users), the viewing time of the product, etc.
  • the data is transmitted to the administrator system 4100 using a predetermined transmission method such as a Post method (browsing data transmission process). This browsing data transmission process can be the same as the browsing data transmission process of the eighth embodiment.
  • the node ID of the node relating to the newly recorded memory is stored in the node table of the user, and the node (first node) of the user and the node of the memory recorded in the edge table of the user ( Edge information linking the second node) is stored.
  • a data structure represented by the above-described subject / predicate / object relationship is generated between the first node and the second node via the edge.
  • the memory (my memory) recorded by the user in the past is the newest in the order of recording date and time as described in the first embodiment.
  • the list is displayed in order from the first.
  • the recorded memory can be selectively displayed in order to facilitate the search of the memory recorded in the past.
  • a plurality of selection icons for display memory selection are displayed in parallel on the left and right at the top of the processing screen BM120.
  • the selection icons are “all” (icons displaying the letter “A” in the figure), “people” (icons displaying the letter “H” in the figure), “things” (“T” in the figure). ”(Icon that displays the letter“) ”,“ thing ”(icon that displays the letter“ G ”in the figure),“ location ”(icon that displays the letter“ P ”in the figure),“ other ”( Figure The icon displaying the letter “O”. By selecting any of the selection icons, only the memories belonging to the category of the selection icon are displayed in a list on the processing screen BM120. (In the case of “All”, all memories are displayed.)
  • a favorite icon for selecting whether or not to make the memory to be displayed a favorite registration is displayed at a position adjacent to the selection icon (next to the right) at the top of the processing screen BM120.
  • the favorite icon By selecting the favorite icon, only the memories registered as favorites are displayed in a list on the processing screen BM120. (If you do not select the favorite icon, all memories are displayed.)
  • icons for executing my memory processing, calendar processing, and memory service processing are arranged in parallel at the bottom of the processing screen BM120.
  • my memory processing icon When the my memory processing icon is selected, each operation of the above-mentioned my memory processing can be executed.
  • calendar process icon When the calendar process icon is selected, each calendar process operation described below can be executed.
  • memory service processing icon When the memory service processing icon is selected, each operation of the memory service processing described above can be executed.
  • a login icon indicating the login state an icon displaying a letter “S” in the figure
  • a letter icon (“L” in the figure) for confirming the received letter are displayed.
  • An icon to be displayed) and a menu icon an icon displaying a letter “M” in the drawing are arranged in parallel on the left and right.
  • the memory service processing screen BM220 displays a list of memories created in the past by the user for each memory category.
  • the above memory service processing can be selectively executed for the created memory. Specifically, by selecting any of the created memories displayed on the processing screen BM220, the above-described processing such as article management can be executed on the selected memory.
  • a memory creation icon for creating a new memory is displayed at the top.
  • the new memory creation process can be executed by selecting a memory creation icon. More specifically, when a memory creation icon is selected, a category selection screen that enables memory creation for each category is displayed as shown in FIG. Here, by selecting an icon of one of the categories displayed on the category selection screen, it is possible to create a memory of a node specific to the category.
  • Calendar processing by the information providing system of the ninth embodiment will be described with reference to FIG.
  • FIG. 76 in the calendar processing screen BM320, memories created in the past by the user are listed in a calendar that displays 12 months in units of one year (recorded in the calendar for convenience of explanation). (The memory is not displayed.) More specifically, in the same manner as the bookmark display processing by the calendar described in the eighth embodiment, the recorded memory is displayed in a list in the corresponding month frame of the calendar based on the recording date and time.
  • STEP 103 when the guest user selects whether or not to perform user registration and performs user registration processing, in STEP 104, a user table for the user is created, and the user table is associated with the node table of the user. In STEP 105, related data (such as a user ID) of the user table is additionally stored in the node table. As a result, the user (registered user) can access the node table via the user table and log in to the information providing system as described above in STEP 106 from the next time.
  • related data such as a user ID
  • FIG. 80 when a user-specific My Memory screen is displayed in STEP 211, the user determines in STEP 212 whether or not to display only the favorite registered memory among the user's My Memory. Can be selected (as described above). If the user selects to display only the memory registered as a favorite, in STEP 213, only the memory registered as a favorite is displayed on the my memory screen. On the other hand, if the user selects to display all the memories, in STEP 214, all the memories are displayed on the my memory screen.
  • the user can execute selection display processing for each category of the memory in STEP 215, and in STEP 216, “all”, “person”, “thing”, “thing”, “location”, “other” You can select one of the categories and display only the memory for that category. Further, when the user selects whether or not to perform the calendar process in STEP 217 and performs the calendar process, the user can display the my memory of the selected month in STEP 218 as described above.
  • management processing (memory management processing) for the created memory will be described using the flowchart of FIG. First, as shown in FIG. 82, when a memory service screen unique to the user is displayed in STEP 221, the user selects in STEP 231 whether or not to perform memory management processing for the created memory, and in STEP 232. The memory for performing the memory management process can be selected. The user can execute the management process for each category of memory in STEP 233A-F. For each memory, the above-described work addition process, product management process, etc.
  • Step 234 the above article management process (STEP 235), and the above Event management processing (STEP 236) and the above-mentioned page management processing (STEP 237) can be executed. Further, as subordinate processing, work / product addition processing, display processing, editing processing, and memory are performed as described above.
  • First dependent processing 234A such as creation processing
  • second dependent processing 235A such as article creation, article display processing, article editing processing, memory registration processing, event creation, collaboration application processing, event display processing, event editing processing, and printing
  • Third subordinate processing 236A such as memory creation processing, page editing processing and printing memory
  • a fourth subordinate process 237A such as a creation process can be executed.
  • a fifth subordinate process 234B such as a print memory creation process or an article creation process can be executed, and an article notification process (letter) is a process subordinate to the second subordinate process 235A or the fifth subordinate process 234B.
  • Transmission processing) S238 can be executed.
  • the link between node 1 and node 3 is linked by an edge (“role” meaning “role”) Is done. That is, a data structure having a meaning or context such as “I play a role as a creator” is generated.
  • the node 2 and the node 4 are linked by an edge (“hold” meaning “held”). Is done. That is, a data structure having a meaning or context such as “another creator holds an event” is generated.
  • node 1 when the user of node 1 records the memory of the event for participating in the event of node 4 as the creator of node 3, the node between node 3 and node 4 is an edge (" participate "). That is, a data structure having a meaning or context such as “a creator who is himself participates in an event of another creator” is generated.
  • the node 3 and the node 2 are linked by an edge (“memory”). That is, a data structure having a meaning or context such as “a creator who is himself records other creators” is generated.
  • node 1 and node 5 have an edge ("owned”). "Owner”). That is, a data structure having a meaning or context such as “I own the net shop” is generated. In this way, one node having a specific attribute (node type) and another node having a specific attribute are linked by an edge having a specific attribute (edge type). In response, data structures of subjects / predicates / objects having different meanings and contexts are generated.
  • the management information DB 4120 processes information related to shelves using the item shelf table, cart shelf table, and cart shelf line table, but the shelf itself may be configured to be used as a node. it can. That is, when a node key is provided on a shelf, the shelf becomes a node. In this way, the recommended shelves are recorded in memory each time the displayed product changes every season, the shelves recorded in the memory are provided as recommended shelves at a predetermined timing, or the memory is used. Thus, it becomes possible to perform processing related to various shelves.
  • a message board memory for example, a message board memory is provided in a specific place (a specific convenience store, etc.), and by reading and recording the message board memory, events near the place are guided. Can be configured.
  • a message board memory is set up in a specific area such as a tourist spot or a tourist attraction, and information relating to the place is provided to a person who wants to provide nearby event information. If the event information is allowed to be posted (by passers of the location, convenience store customers, etc.) by reading and recording the message board memory of the location, the event information held in the vicinity of the location is recorded. In particular, when various events are held in the vicinity, information can be effectively provided by displaying them in a list. Similarly, for “people”, “things”, and “things” in the vicinity of the place, introduction articles and introduction information can be provided via the message board memory.
  • a posting period (start date and end date) can be provided in the information posted in the memory of the message board.
  • the information posted in the memory of the message board is configured so that it is posted in order from the latest information.
  • the information providing system uses one node (first node) and another object (first node) using a node uniquely specified in the node table and an edge uniquely specified in the edge table.
  • 2 node can be constructed as a representation of a data structure with a subject / predicate / object relationship.
  • linked open data proposed in recent years has strict specifications and is not sufficient in terms of practicality. However, according to the information providing system of the ninth embodiment, it is lighter than this linked open data.
  • Data can be linked with the relationship
  • the kind of edge (edge type) as a predicate can be set arbitrarily, and by greatly increasing the kind, it can be performed between nodes in various ways.
  • the relationship can be expressed as a “subject / predicate / object” relationship.
  • Such data representation based on the “subject / predicate / object” relationship corresponds to a data representation called triple in RDF (Resource Description Framework), but RDF requires very strict specifications.
  • the operation speed is not sufficient, and the practicality is still insufficient.
  • the relationship between data (between nodes) can be expressed by a system that is simpler and lighter than this triple, and greatly improves the practicality. Can do.
  • a specific memory similar to the bookmark described in the first embodiment etc. is used, but the term “memory” is used specifically for the information providing system in the ninth embodiment
  • a link is formed between the node 1 and the node 2 (which are already linked to the memory) via the memory.
  • the memory 1 of the node 1 and the memory 2 of the node 2 are connected in a memory relationship via the new memory (memory 3).
  • the weight of node 1 and node 2 (corresponding to the link strength described in the second embodiment, etc.) is changed from the default value (initial value) “1” to “2”. (That is, the link strength increases).
  • the weight of the node 1 is “1”, but the memory 1 of the node 1 passes through the memory 3. Since it is linked to the memory 2 of the node 2, the weight of the node 1 is increased to “2”.
  • Each type of memory is a different node.
  • event memory it becomes a node for organizers, promoters, organizers, participants, etc. of events (exhibitions, exhibitions, concerts, seminars, etc.) Are linked to each other by edges to represent the subject / predicate / object relationship.
  • the nodes are linked (linked) by the edge, but since different types of edge types are associated as attributes with respect to each edge of the edge table storing the edge information, the edge type The relationship between nodes changes by changing.
  • the number of people who recorded a memory (memory A) (number of recorders) is, for example, 10 people, and another memory (memory B) that is typically the type of memory associated with memory A
  • memory A number of recorders
  • memory B another memory
  • the user A of the node A in the memory A applies for a collaboration (application for participation) to the user B of the node B in the memory B.
  • the user A of the node A of the memory A sends an event notification message (on the Internet) to the recorder B (100 people) of the memory B in addition to the recorder A (10 people) of the memory A.
  • This information is equivalent to a blog or a message transmitted / received in the document, and may be simply referred to as a “letter” in the present application document.
  • the user A of the node A of the memory A creates the memory of the “creator” belonging to the “person” memory as the memory type and releases it as his own memory A, and an event related to his / her business (For example, exhibition of your own work) or user A of node A of memory A creates “net shop” memory belonging to “thing” memory as his memory A as memory type
  • an event related to your business for example, an exhibition / sale event for your product
  • the event will be used to introduce your profile page (self (own store) created when creating Memory A).
  • you create an article about the event (equivalent to a general blog) The article while being published in the own profile page, the article (via the Internet) with respect to each of the above recording's sent to notification.
  • the memory A can be further set to notify only the recording person registered in “favorite” using the “favorite” function.
  • the event memory can be attached to this article. That is, for the event itself, a memory (for an event which is a different type of memory from the memory A) is created, and the event memory (event memory) is used together with the letter, for example, the letter text.
  • a link is attached to the event memory, and by selecting and executing the link, the same processing as the event memory is read (processing similar to the processing related to memory) is executed. Can do.
  • the user A gives an introduction article about his / her new product to the person (recorder) who records (bookmarks) the memory A for the product. It can also be sent along with the created memory (product memory).
  • Articles (letters) sent to each of the recorders are simply configured to put a link to the web page of the letter on the transmission page.
  • the server and communication environment Can be greatly reduced. That is, the article (letter) of the present embodiment can be regarded as a blog with a notification function. Also, the article can be a blog displaying images and memory.
  • a node of the memory is created and stored in the database node table in association with the node ID or the like. For example, when a user logs in to the user registration web page of the administrator system and executes the registration process, a node for the user is created as an owner node.
  • node_desc represents the location of the store and the attributes (type, sales product, etc.) of the store.
  • JSON Java Script Object Notation
  • XML extensible Markup Language
  • the store memory is a root node ID
  • the product memory node is the root node (top node or parent node) of the store memory. It becomes a child node (lower node) subordinate to the node.
  • Memory types include people, things, things, places, message boards, and others.
  • the information providing system of the ninth embodiment can also be applied to the advertising business model as in the third embodiment.
  • the message board memory of the ninth embodiment can be provided.
  • a message board for notifying the content of the event is installed in a specific place near the event holding place, for example.
  • the memory (message board memory) for the event is installed (printing etc.) on the message board.
  • a passer-by passes through the place and sees the message board, he / she is interested in the event and reads the message board memory to record the message board memory related to the event as the memory of the passer-by. I can have you.
  • the passerby remembers the event and wants to confirm its contents at any later time, the event information can be acquired via the message board memory. .
  • the administrator system may be configured to require the permission of the person who recorded the message board memory, for example, in order to send a letter about such message board memory.
  • the letter it is necessary to request permission (via the administrator system) from the person, obtain the permission of the person, and then transmit the letter.
  • the article of the event can be configured not to be transmitted (and posted) to the information terminal device or the like of the person.
  • the information can be used by an advertising company or the like to select a place for placing an advertisement (for example, for an advertising service using artificial intelligence).
  • the inappropriate message board memory and the article (letter) node (or the owner node of the owner) are deleted. It can also be configured.
  • the information providing system of the ninth embodiment can also be applied to a tourism area development platform (DMO).
  • DMO tourism area development platform
  • RDF Resource Description Framework
  • S subject
  • P predicate
  • O object
  • T object
  • the subject is a resource to be described
  • the predicate indicates the characteristics of the subject and the relationship between the subject and the object
  • the object is the value of an object or predicate that has a relationship with the subject.
  • the information providing system can define the relationship between the subject, predicate, and object of the RDF triple using the relationship between the node and the edge, and is suitable for computer processing on the web.
  • the same function (utilization of large-scale data called big data) can be realized as linked open data (Linked Open Data: “LOD”), which is a generic name of technologies for publishing and sharing the data. That is, the relationship between the nodes can be described by the relationship between the subject, the predicate, and the object by the edge, and the big data can be created at a lower cost than the conventional system.
  • AI artificial intelligence
  • Node types include owner nodes, root nodes, service nodes, and the like.
  • the service node (service_node) is “1” when the store is looking (recording a memory). That is, it is set to “1” at the start of the service. Even if the product is registered, the service node remains “0” by itself.
  • the owner node (owner_node) is “0” before logging in, and when logging in for the first time and connecting to the information providing system (to be precise, reading the memory for the first time and connecting to the administrator system succeeded, The initial value is set to “1” (when the initial screen is displayed).
  • the service key (service_key) is a key for the user to log in to the menu of the information management system.
  • Edge types include records (memory), owners, creators, promoters, organizers, and participants.
  • Node table The node table is a self-reference type, and all the relationships are aggregated in the node table.
  • the administrator DB 4230 can have an add-on table.
  • This table associates an add-on ID (addon_id) for providing a merchandise cart function with a certain node. By purchasing the merchandise cart function, a relation is formed between the node table and the add-on table.
  • the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment uses various memories corresponding to the physical bookmark described in the first embodiment or the like for bookmarks in the real world (real world). .
  • DM direct mail
  • media advertisements that are cost effective and troublesome, and that even if DM is sent, the reaction is weak.
  • the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment solves the conventional problems and continuously approaches passing consumers (prospective customers and customers including potential customers and existing customers). This makes it possible to increase purchase opportunities, eliminates the need for costly DM, makes it easy to send messages and event information, and so on.
  • the first embodiment is an invention of a main information / subordinate information link type (see FIGS. 1 to 24). That is, in this invention, a main user (for example, a pub) attaches an article ID (QR code or the like) to a product (for example, a specific brand of alcohol) and stores main information (the product information) in a database. Then, when an information viewer (for example, a customer) reads the product ID with a smartphone or the like, the product information is output to the smartphone or the like. In addition, a secondary user (for example, the liquor dealer) who is the person who handles the product applied for a link to the secondary information (your store information, etc.) and the application was approved.
  • a main user for example, a pub
  • a product for example, a specific brand of alcohol
  • link information according to main information When an information viewer (for example, a customer) reads the article ID with a smartphone or the like, in addition to the main information (product information), the number of sub-information linked to the main information (number of links), and the main information The number of accesses to is output in accordance with the smartphone or the like (see FIGS. 16 and 17). Further, at this time, the sub information (store information or the like) may be output.
  • the sub information stored information or the like
  • FIG. 2 an article ID table and a URL table as shown in FIG. 2 are used for the above processing.
  • a normal approval routine as shown in FIG. 14 or a deletion approval routine as shown in FIG. 15 is used.
  • a bookmark process for storing the article ID in association with the merchandise (a process as shown in FIG. 24, which is the original form of the memory processing of the hook), and the merchandise information can be confirmed at a later date. (See FIGS. 19 and 20).
  • confirmation processing by a calendar is also enabled (FIG. 23).
  • time-series display processing display from the latest to the top, processing to rank the most recently browsed to the top, etc. is performed.
  • the invention according to the second embodiment is similar to the invention according to the first embodiment, but for the above processing, a node table and a link table as shown in FIG. 25 are used.
  • the data structure has a tree structure as shown in FIG. 29
  • the data structure has a network structure as shown in FIG.
  • the link strength can be stored according to the number of links between nodes, and a network structure as shown in FIGS. 32 to 36 can be generated.
  • the link can be deleted as shown in FIG. 37 using the link approval function.
  • a table structure as shown in FIG. 38 can be used for link strength calculation, and processing as shown in FIG. 39 can be performed as link strength calculation processing. Thereby, the link strength between the nodes is calculated as shown in FIGS.
  • the invention according to Embodiment 3 is an advertisement-use invention (see FIGS. 44 to 53). That is, this invention uses the invention of Embodiment 1 and the invention of Embodiment 2 for advertisement. That is, the present invention has a table structure as shown in FIG. 45 and uses an article node table, an advertisement frame table, and an advertisement node table. Further, as shown in FIG. 49, it is possible to categorize (filter processing) by action or context, or to categorize (filter processing) by situation as shown in FIGS. Furthermore, as shown in FIG. 52, it is also possible to statistically process the number of accesses to advertisements in time series and sell data at a high browsing frequency (to advertising agencies, etc.).
  • the inventions according to Embodiments 4 to 7 are also advertisement-use inventions (see FIGS. 54 to 58). That is, the inventions of the fourth to seventh embodiments are further developments of the advertisement-type invention of the third embodiment. That is, these inventions are applied to an outdoor signboard as shown in FIG. 55, a signboard as shown in FIG. 56, a display board as shown in FIG. 57, and an advertising medium sales screen as shown in FIG. It is an invention that can.
  • the invention according to Embodiment 8 is a network shop cooperation type invention (see FIGS. 58 to 65). That is, in this invention, a main user (for example, a souvenir shop in a sightseeing spot) attaches an item ID (QR code or the like) to a product (for example, a confectionery of a specific brand), and stores main information (the product information) in a database. To store. Then, when an information viewer (for example, a tourist) reads the product ID with a smartphone or the like, bookmark processing of the product is executed, and the tourist can purchase the product at an online shop at a later date. Further, using a physical node table or the like as shown in FIG. 59, processing as shown in FIG. 60 is executed. In addition, as shown in FIG. 62, the present invention can be applied to the case where the tourist information of the area is guided at a tourist information center or the like.
  • the invention according to the ninth embodiment is a network shop cooperation type invention similar to the invention of the eighth embodiment, and is an invention obtained by extending and developing the invention of the eighth embodiment (FIGS. 66 to 83). reference).
  • Embodiment 10 As a specific example of the main information utilization type information providing system, the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment will be described as an embodiment obtained by further improving and developing the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment is obtained by further extending and developing the technical idea of the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment may be an embodiment in which various functions of the information providing system according to each of the above embodiments are implemented alone or in appropriate combination.
  • this point is the same in the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment.
  • First, an outline of the features of the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment will be described.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment is an extension and / or application of the first to ninth embodiments including the ninth embodiment, the first embodiment will be described in the following description. However, in this case, “X” or “x” is added to the end of the reference numerals (member numbers and the like) used in the first embodiment. Therefore, in the following description, the specific configuration, operation, and effect of the information providing system of the tenth embodiment will become clearer with reference to the corresponding description of the first embodiment and the like.
  • the physical medium providing place 4400X corresponds to the physical medium providing place 4400 of the ninth embodiment shown in FIG. , Consisting of tourist attractions.
  • the display screen 410X of the information terminal device or the like is a kind of the physical medium 410, like the article 410A and the paper medium 410B.
  • content such as articles is displayed on the screen 410X.
  • the information providing system includes an administrator system 4100X (corresponding to the administrator system 100) (corresponding to the information providing system according to the first embodiment shown in FIG. 1), And a user terminal device 4200X (corresponding to the main user system 200 or the sub user system 300 or the information viewer terminal 500).
  • the user terminal device 4200X is a user computer device (hereinafter referred to as “user PC”) 4200AX, a user PC 4200BX, or a user portable terminal device (typically a user's smartphone, Hereinafter, “user SP”) 4200CX can be used.
  • the user terminal device 4200X is a computer device or computer system owned and managed by the user (user) of the information providing system of the tenth embodiment, and the user is related to facilities such as a tourist information center. (Actually, the person in charge or the person in charge as the operator), but in addition to this, with the related parties of the stores and products related to the facility (corresponding to the secondary user in the first embodiment) In addition, it may become a general consumer of the first embodiment (such as a person who actually contacts the facility information).
  • the user terminal device 4200X includes various functions provided by the information means 4210X (various functions provided by the information providing system using the function providing means 4115X, such as the above-described my memory processing function, memory service processing function, etc. And a function realized by the present embodiment).
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment has a function providing unit 4115X (for example, server side) provided by the administrator system 4100X on the server side for these various functions on the user terminal device 4200X side.
  • the function providing means 4115X realized by the program the user terminal device 4200X as the client device is configured as an information means 4210AX that acquires the function via, for example, “WEB” in the user terminal device 4200AX of FIG.
  • the user terminal device 4200X as the client device, for example, it can be configured as information means 4210BX that realizes its function by “app (application)” in the user terminal device 4200BX in FIG.
  • the information means 4210X, 4210AX, and 4210BX of the user terminal devices 4200X, 4200AX, 4200BX, and 4200CX correspond to the processing functions of the administrator system described later, and correspond to the memory management means 4211 of the ninth embodiment.
  • FIG. 1 First management means 4211X, second management means 4212X corresponding to page management means 4212, third management means 4213X corresponding to article management means 4213, fourth management means 4214X corresponding to event management means 4214, works Corresponding to the fifth management means 4215X corresponding to the management means 4215, the sixth management means 4216X corresponding to the product management means 4216, the seventh management means 4217X corresponding to the collaboration management means 4217, and the shelf management means 42
  • the information unit 4210AX of the user terminal device 4200AX is illustrated as including the first management unit 4211X to the fourth management unit 4214X, but although not illustrated, the user terminal device 4200AX is not illustrated.
  • Fifth management means 4215X to other management means 4219X are also provided.
  • the information means 4210BX of the user terminal device 4200BX is shown to include fifth management means 4215X to other management means 4219X, but although not shown, the user terminal device 4200BX is First management means 4211X to fourth management means 4214X are also provided.
  • the information means 4210CX of the user terminal device 4200CX includes first management means 4211X to other management means 4219X.
  • the user terminal device 4200X manages data by the database DB. Although illustrated, it is possible to realize processing related to data storage by a normal PC file system without using a DB.
  • the system configuration relating to the information exchange of the information providing system of the tenth embodiment can be the same hardware configuration and software configuration as the information providing system of the first embodiment (except for the features of the invention).
  • the system configuration relating to the information browsing of the information providing system of the tenth embodiment can be the same hardware configuration and software configuration as the information providing system of the first embodiment (except for the features of the invention).
  • the network configuration of the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment can be the same as the network configuration of the information providing system according to the first embodiment (except for the characterizing portion of the invention).
  • the physical medium providing place 4400X of the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment can have the same configuration as the physical medium providing place 4400 of the information providing system according to the first embodiment (except for the characteristic part of the invention).
  • goods (things) and stores (locations) as entities including the objects of the ninth embodiment in addition to tangible objects such as articles (including products) and objects and physical media in the first embodiment, etc.)
  • a tourist information center or the like can also be the physical medium providing place 4400X.
  • a node ID (node_id) is used as an identifier corresponding to the local ID.
  • an ID storage medium for storing this node ID a two-dimensional barcode is used as in the first embodiment. Or NFC tags can be used.
  • this node ID is stored in an ID storage medium (“bookmark” or “memory”) made up of a two-dimensional barcode or the like.
  • the information providing system of the tenth embodiment includes an administrator system 4100X, user terminal devices 4200AX, 4200BX, and 4200CX as user systems (corresponding to the physical medium providing place 400).
  • a physical medium providing place 4400X and a Web server 600 are provided.
  • the information providing system of the tenth embodiment is the same as that of the ninth embodiment except that the user (user) of the user terminal device 4200 is a user other than a user as a main user of the first embodiment. In addition to people involved in facilities such as tourist information, there are individuals. Further, in the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment, as in the ninth embodiment, various memories to be described later are used by using my memory (“MM”) that is an ID storage medium corresponding to the bookmark according to the first embodiment. It is characterized by executing processing.
  • MM my memory
  • the administrator system 4100X includes information management means 4110X.
  • the information management unit 4110X realizes a function of managing various types of information such as information provided to the user terminal device 4200X (4200AX, 4200BX, 4200CX).
  • the administrator system 4100X includes a management information database (“management information DB”) 4120X.
  • the management information DB 4120X realizes a function of storing various types of information (corresponding to the main information) provided to the user terminal device 4200X in cooperation with the information management unit 4110X.
  • GUI user interface
  • the information management unit 4110X of the administrator system 4100X includes a node management unit 4111X, an edge management unit 4112X, a service management unit 4113X, a data management unit 4114X, and a function providing unit 4115X, which are not shown.
  • a configuration (function realization means) for realizing various processing functions in cooperation with the management information DB 4120 is provided.
  • the node management unit 4111X refers to data such as a node table (corresponding to the node table of the ninth embodiment) (and a user table described later in the case of processing for a registered user), etc. Based on the ID information corresponding to the stored memory), a function of generating a new node (that is, a new node table) or updating the node table is realized, and a node type is set for each node ID of the node table.
  • This is a function realization means for realizing various processing functions related to the node, such as realizing the functions such as.
  • the edge management unit 4112X refers to data such as a node table and an edge table (corresponding to the edge table of the ninth embodiment), and based on a memory reading operation (and ID information corresponding to the read memory). Create a new edge to form a link between one node (first node) and another node (second node), and execute story linkage processing as described later
  • the function realizing means for realizing the functions of various processes related to the edge, such as the function of setting the edge type for each edge of the edge table.
  • the service management unit 4113X is a function implementation unit that implements processing related to various services with reference to data such as a node table and an edge table.
  • the service management unit 4113X is provided in connection with story linkage processing. Implement various service processing.
  • the data management unit 4114X is a function implementation unit that implements processing such as addition / creation / editing / deletion of various data with reference to data such as a node table and an edge table. As in the ninth embodiment, part of the functions of the data management unit 4114X (particularly functions related to service processing) may be realized by the service management unit 4113X.
  • the management information DB 4120X can be configured by a relational database (RDB) as in the first embodiment. For example, various tables (node table, edge table, node type table, edge type table, etc.) as shown in FIG. ). In this case, the management information DB 4120X can be configured to have a data structure (data schema) as shown in FIGS. 70 and 71 as an example.
  • RDB relational database
  • the node table (nodes) is a table for storing and managing the node ID and the related information for each memory, and corresponds to the node table of the second embodiment. It corresponds to a table.
  • the node ID (node_id) in the node table is a unique identifier (ID) assigned to each specific object as the local ID as described above.
  • the node ID can have an arbitrary configuration like the article ID of the first embodiment.
  • the edge table is a table corresponding to the link table of the second embodiment, and corresponds to the edge table of the ninth embodiment, but is different from one node (first node) as in the link table.
  • the first node and the second node are further linked (linked) with the edge, so that the above-described story linkage processing It is the table which stores the information for realizing.
  • the node ID 01 (node_id_01) and the node ID 02 (node_id_02) are stored in the edge table.
  • the node ID of one node (first node) and the node ID 02 are the node IDs of the other node (second node).
  • the weight (link strength: weight) is stored in the edge table as in the ninth embodiment, but the weight corresponds to the link strength in the second embodiment, and is between the nodes. This shows the link strength.
  • the weight is, for example, that the user cooperates with another node (second node) linked to a certain node (for example, the first node linked to the basic content (first topic) serving as the starting point of the story). (For example, memory related to the next topic (second topic) of the story) (for example, by an action other than memory reading), the first node and the second
  • the weight of the edge linking to the other node is “0”, but if the user reads and records the memory of the second node after that, it is between the first node and the second node.
  • the edge weight of the first node is incremented by “1”, and if the user registers the first node or the second node as a favorite, Wait edge between the second node is incremented further by "1”. (That is, when the favorite registration is performed in addition to the reading record, the total is incremented by “2”).
  • the edge type (field data defined in the edge type table (edge_types) of the ninth embodiment and corresponding to the edge name (name) of the edge type table) is a predicate as described in the ninth embodiment.
  • the attribute of the edge functioning as an element is identified and expressed, for example (recorded as an attribute when recording various memories) (memory), (attributed when possessing a net shop node, etc.) Own (have), hold (become an attribute when holding an event, etc.), hold (hold), play an role (become an attribute when playing a specific role in an event, etc.), (role), (in an event, etc.)
  • it is a story linkage process. To represent the definitive type of story, etc.
  • edge type can be used as long as the edge functions as a predicate (link information between a subject and an object or a complement) or link information for story linkage. Can be stored as an edge type.
  • the edge type table (edge type table) is a table that defines the edge type of the edge table, and corresponds to the edge type table of the ninth embodiment.
  • the tenth embodiment is a table corresponding to the article table of the ninth embodiment, and stores story content (for example, partial content as partial information of a story assigned to each digital stub described later). It is a table.
  • the content table is not shown in the management information DB 4120X due to the limitation of the drawing space of the drawing, but it is clear from the above description that the illustration is omitted.
  • the administrator system 4100X uses the information management means 4110X to store link information between nodes based on edges, while the number of edges between a pair of nodes, as described with reference to FIG. Is determined by calculation processing, etc., and the link strength is determined by calculation based on the total number of edges (total number of links) (that is, the total number of links is the link strength value). Yes.
  • the administrator system 4100X can also be configured to execute various predetermined processes based on the stored link strength value.
  • the administrator system 4100X has a function implementation unit (“link strength management unit”) necessary to execute the link strength storage processing and other processing. And link strength calculation means. Note that FIG.
  • the administrator system 4100X includes a necessary configuration among the configurations described in the above embodiments. That is, in FIG. 85, the link strength calculation unit and the link strength management unit are combined with the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx, which is one function realization unit, in the information management unit 4110X of the administrator system 4100X due to the limitation of the drawing space of the drawing.
  • the link strength calculation unit and the link strength management unit are combined with the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx, which is one function realization unit, in the information management unit 4110X of the administrator system 4100X due to the limitation of the drawing space of the drawing.
  • these can be embodied as another function realizing means.
  • information management means 4110X includes information management means 4112bx and information GUI 4112cx (corresponding to main information registration management means 112 and main information GUI of main information management means 112 in FIG. 26, etc.). Although shown, it is apparent from the above description that the information management means 4110X various function realizing means described with reference to FIG. 84 are provided.
  • the administrator system 4100X corresponds to the node table 1121 of the second embodiment (corresponding to the node table of the ninth embodiment).
  • the administrator system 4100X is similar to the ninth embodiment in that a node type table (node_types) 4125X for storing data related to the node type and the edge An edge type table (edge_types) 4126X that stores data regarding types is provided (this is the same as the table configuration of the administrator system 4100 of the ninth embodiment).
  • the administrator system 4100X includes information management means 4110X (corresponding to the main information management means 112 shown in FIG. 25).
  • the information management unit 4110X further includes a link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx as described above. Yes.
  • These configurations can be the same as the configurations of the corresponding elements described in the above embodiment, but the configuration can be changed as appropriate in accordance with the story cooperation function realized in the tenth embodiment.
  • FIG. 86 is an explanatory diagram schematically showing the memory registration process of the information providing system using the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment of the present invention by using functional blocks and the like.
  • the physical medium according to the tenth embodiment is used.
  • the memory registration process memory recording process
  • a series of processes are executed according to the flow shown in FIG.
  • the memory recording page UI 170 shown in FIG. 86A is displayed on the browsing screen 530 of the user terminal device 4200X (confirmation screen display processing).
  • the confirmation screen display processing of the memory recording page UI 170 in the user terminal device 4200X is the same as the bookmark processing in the eighth embodiment.
  • the user terminal device 4200X when the information viewer executes a selection execution process (such as clicking the “Yes” button) for confirming that the memory is recorded on the memory recording page UI 170, the user terminal device 4200X.
  • the data including the node ID unique to the memory of the story information, the user ID of the information viewer (for registered users) or guest key (for guest users), the viewing time of the product, etc. is the HTTP Post.
  • the data is transmitted to the administrator system 4100X using a predetermined transmission method such as a method (browsing data transmission process). This browsing data transmission process can be the same as the browsing data transmission process of the eighth embodiment.
  • the node ID of the node relating to the newly recorded memory is stored in the node table of the user, and the node (first node) of the user and the node of the memory recorded in the edge table of the user ( Edge information linking the second node) is stored.
  • the data structure for describing the above-described story information between the first node and the second node via the edge is generated by coordinating the topics in order.
  • bookmark information about a facility such as a tourist information center (one topic of story information) as a physical medium that you actually saw and touched, and then connect to that information (one topic)
  • a story-linked information providing system (sometimes referred to as a “story-linked information providing system”) that enables quick and smooth access to information (next topic).
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment is a second specific example of the information providing system using the physical bookmark, in which a user such as a tourist or a general consumer actually Bookmark the tourist guide (tourist guide printed in physical form as a physical medium) and partial information (one piece of tourist information divided into a series of tourist guide information) After that, it is embodied in an information guide linkage type information provision system (sometimes referred to as an “information guide linkage type information provision system”) that allows the series of guide information to be browsed quickly and smoothly. You can also.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment includes a historical site guide information providing system as shown in FIG. 87 (a) and a folktale information as shown in FIG. 87 (b). It can be embodied as a provision system.
  • the information providing system is such that an information viewer (for example, a traveler) browses information in the administrator system 4100X of the information providing system.
  • the user terminal 500 reads a local ID attached to a specific physical medium of a facility (for example, a tourist information center) of a specific place (for example, a tourist spot visited by a traveler), and based on the browsing history (the day (Or at a later date) it is configured as an information providing system that allows the information to be browsed.
  • a specific physical medium of a facility for example, a tourist information center
  • a specific place for example, a tourist spot visited by a traveler
  • Attaching method of physical ID In this case, for example, a place where a printed guide information such as a specific tourist guide as a specific physical medium is displayed or distributed (tourist guide, service area, parking area, roadside station, etc. )), A unique physical ID is assigned to the ID medium (physical ID medium) for each type of various types of printed guide information arranged in the display / distribution corner of the printed guide information, and each type of guide information is provided.
  • the ID medium can be arranged and attached at a position corresponding to the printed matter.
  • the confirmation screen display process of the bookmark page UI 70 in the information viewer terminal 500 is performed, for example, when the information viewer reads the physical ID by the information viewer terminal 500 according to HTTP.
  • a request for the bookmark page UI70 of the first URL (URL1) is transmitted to the administrator system 4100X, and the administrator system 4100X transmits the bookmark page UI70 to the information viewer terminal 500 as a response thereto. Achieved.
  • the information viewer clicks on the bookmark title of either the browsing screen (for example, corresponding to the calendar-type browsing screen CA1 in FIG. 63) or the bookmark list (for example, corresponding to the bookmark list BML in FIG. 63).
  • the URL of the information page linked to the bookmark title is requested using, for example, the HTTP get method, and the administrator system 4100X receives the URL as a response to the request.
  • the information page is transmitted to the information viewer terminal 500 and displayed on the browsing screen 530 (link destination information display process).
  • the administrator system 4100X transmits one content (topic information) belonging to a specific story by the information management means.
  • the story can be, for example, historic site information of a specific sightseeing spot (for example, XYZ town).
  • the administrator system 4110X divides content constituting one historical site information (content as one completed historical site information including text information, image information, etc.) along the historical time axis of the historical site. Or from a series of topics, divided according to the context about historical information, or divided into places related to historical sites, or divided according to other criteria for dividing historical information. It is stored in a predetermined storage means (database or the like) as a plurality of (usually many) partial content information.
  • the content itself is usually prepared by the department or person in charge of the sightseeing area by himself or outsourced, and registered in the administrator system 4100X using the user system 4200X or the like. You can also.
  • the department in charge of the sightseeing spot that corresponds to the user uses the physical medium for each partial content of the content (for each topic) via the administrator system 4100X.
  • An ID is attached. That is, one unique local ID is attached via a predetermined physical medium for each of the divided partial contents constituting the historical information (each topic of historical information).
  • a stub hereinafter sometimes referred to as “digital stub” as digital data displayed on a display screen of a portable terminal device such as a smartphone is used. Details of the digital stub will be described later.
  • the department in charge of the sightseeing spot makes the fact known as much as possible by means of advertisements or public relations, for example, a tourist who visits the sightseeing spot (use Make it available to the Then, when a user visits a facility such as a tourist information center in a tourist area and reads the local ID of a physical medium in the facility with a portable terminal device or the like, a predetermined partial content (historical information) associated with the local ID 1 topic) is displayed on a display screen of a mobile terminal device or the like.
  • the digital stub is issued corresponding to each partial content. (Alternatively, the display of each partial content itself may be the digital stub.)
  • historic site information (completed content) of an XYZ town historic site is divided into locations such as location A, location B, location C, etc. ),
  • a unique local ID is attached (to a predetermined physical medium) for the partial content for each location.
  • ID_A is attached to the location A as the local ID
  • ID_B is assigned to the location B as the local ID
  • ID_C is assigned to the location C as the local ID.
  • a predetermined corresponding partial content is associated and stored in a predetermined storage unit.
  • a partial content A (Description 1) is provided at location A via ID_A as a local ID
  • a partial content B (Description 2) is provided at location B via ID_B as a local ID
  • a local ID is provided at location C.
  • the partial contents (description 3) are stored in association with each other via ID_C.
  • the user first supplies the local ID (that is, ID_A of the place A) associated with the first partial content that is the starting point information of the completed content (completed historic site information) (typically, the portable terminal device (typically).
  • the corresponding partial content that is, description 1 of the location A
  • a digital stub A corresponding to the local ID (ID_A of location A) is issued from the administrator system 4100X to the user's mobile terminal device, and the digital stub A is stored in the storage area of the mobile terminal device.
  • a link enabling access to a corresponding stub stored in a storage area such as a database of the administrator system 4100X is stored in the user's mobile terminal device, and by clicking the link, etc., You can call the stub.
  • the first partial content is stored in a predetermined storage area of the administrator system 4100X in association with the second partial content that is continuous (that is, related in terms of content) according to the context or the like.
  • the second partial content is stored in a predetermined storage area of the administrator system 4100X in association with the third partial content that is continuous (that is, contentally related) along the context or the like (
  • all partial contents constituting the completed content such as the fourth partial content and the fifth partial content are stored in association with each other as a series of contents.
  • the user when the user reads the local ID of the first partial content, only the first partial content (description 1) is displayed, and the user can view the contents below the second partial content. (For example, for the explanation after the second partial content, only a hatena mark or the like is displayed). Then, in order for the user to browse the partial content after the second partial content and browse the entire historic site information (completed content) in cooperation with the first partial content, the user must It is necessary to actually visit a location (location B) associated with the second partial content and read the local ID (ID_B) at the location B by the mobile terminal device.
  • location B location associated with the second partial content and read the local ID (ID_B) at the location B by the mobile terminal device.
  • the user who owns the digital stub A corresponding to the local ID (ID_A) of the place A actually visits the place (place B) associated with the second partial content and is in the place B.
  • the second partial content (Description 2) of the location B is displayed on the display screen of the user's mobile terminal device for the first time.
  • a digital stub B corresponding to the second partial content at the location B is issued.
  • the digital stub B can be configured by displaying the second partial content and displayed on the display screen.
  • the user can make the third part in the same manner.
  • the user In order to browse the partial content after the content and browse the entire historic site information (completed content), the user must have the third partial content (with the digital stub of the previous partial content owned). It is necessary to actually visit a location (location C) or the like associated with, and read a local ID (ID_C or the like) at the location C or the like by the portable terminal device.
  • location C location or the like associated with, and read a local ID (ID_C or the like) at the location C or the like by the portable terminal device.
  • a local folk tale XYZ (completed content) is divided into locations such as location A, location B, location C,... A story for each chapter or section), a unique local ID is attached (to a predetermined physical medium) for the partial content for each location.
  • ID_A is attached to the location A as the local ID
  • ID_B is assigned to the location B as the local ID
  • ID_C is assigned to the location C as the local ID.
  • a predetermined corresponding partial content is associated and stored in a predetermined storage unit.
  • the partial content A (Chapter 1 Section 1) is received at the location A via ID_A as the local ID
  • the partial content B (Chapter 1 Section 2) is received at the location B via ID_B as the local ID
  • the partial contents (Chapter 1 Section 3) are stored in association with each other via the ID_C as the local ID in the place C.
  • the user when the user reads the local ID of the first partial content, only the first partial content (Chapter 1 Section 1) is displayed. The user cannot browse the contents below the second partial content. Then, in order for the user to browse the partial content after the second partial content and view the entire folk tale (completed content) in cooperation with the first partial content, the user must The user actually visits the location (location B) associated with the second partial content (with the digital stub of the partial content of 1) and reads the local ID (ID_B) at the location B by the mobile terminal device There is a need.
  • the user when the user actually visits the location (location B) associated with the second partial content and reads the local ID (ID_B) at the location B by the mobile terminal device, the user's mobile The second partial content (Chapter 1 Section 2) at location B is displayed on the display screen of the terminal device. Thereafter, in the same manner, in order for the user to browse the partial content after the third partial content (Chapter 1, Section 3, etc.) and browse the entire folk tale (completed content), the user must A place where a third partial content is associated (location C) etc. (with a digital stub for a partial content before that), and a local ID (ID_C, etc.) at that location C etc. Needs to be read by the portable terminal device.
  • stub A, B, C, D is issued to the user who visited each place, and a pair of stubs (stub A and stub B, stub B and stub C, By using the stub C and the stub D,..., A pair of continuous partial contents (information A and information B, information B and information C, information C and information D,%) Is browsed. As a result, the entire completed content can be viewed.
  • the stub B is associated with the stub B
  • the predetermined information A is associated with the stub A
  • the predetermined information B is associated with the stub B
  • the predetermined information C is associated with the stub C.
  • the user can browse the next partial content (information B). Actually goes to the location where the partial content (information B) is, has the stub B of that location issued, reads the node ID of the stub B by the mobile terminal device, and the corresponding partial content (information B) ). Similarly, after the user reads the node ID of stub B by the mobile terminal device and browses the corresponding partial content (information B), the user can view the next partial content (information C). The partial content (information C) is actually visited at a place where the partial content (information C) is actually issued, and the stub C of the location is issued. The node ID of the stub C is read by the portable terminal device and the corresponding partial content (information C) Need to browse.
  • FIG. 92 conceptually illustrates the processing of FIG. 91 and schematically illustrates the cooperation processing from stub A to stub D.
  • FIG. 91 and FIG. 92 uses a pair of stubs (a set of two stubs), whereas the processing of FIG. 93 is between nodes using a stub having a selected branch.
  • the sequential processing of the mutual links is shown.
  • a plurality of (two or more) digital stubs are provided at a lower position of one upper stub (for example, stub A), and a predetermined number of administrator system 4100X is designated. Stored in association with the storage area.
  • the stub A there are two stubs B1 and B2 as a pair of stubs (a lower stub or a partial content stub that will be placed in the subsequent stage as a partial content).
  • the stubs are associated with each other so that the user can select one of these two stubs B1 and B2 and view the next partial content that is continuous with the partial content of the stub A. It has become.
  • stub C1 and stub C2 are associated as a pair of stubs, and the user selects one of these two stubs C1 and C2 and selects stub B1. It is possible to browse the next partial content continuous to the partial content.
  • the other stub B2 can be selected in association with a plurality of stubs (C3, C4, etc.). Thereafter, similarly, stubs for a plurality of options are prepared for the next partial content.
  • stubs A and B can be provided for each partial content of historical site information.
  • [Specific examples of stubs for mobile terminal devices] 95 and 96 show an example of displaying partial content on the display screen of the mobile terminal device using the paired digital stub shown in FIG. 91 and FIG. 92 (in pairs).
  • FIG. 95 first, the user visits a location associated with the first partial content, and reads the local ID associated with the first partial content at that location by the mobile terminal device, thereby responding.
  • the digital stub A to be issued is issued, and the first partial content associated with the digital stub A is displayed on the display screen of the mobile terminal device and viewed.
  • FIG. 96 the user visits the next place with the digital stub A owned, reads the local ID of the place by the portable terminal device, and corresponds to the second part.
  • the display screen of the mobile terminal device has a digital stub A of partial contents (first and second partial contents) forming a pair with respect to the previous location and the current location. And B are displayed in pairs. In this way, the user can actually visit the next place sequentially and read the local ID of the place by the mobile terminal device, and as a result, can view the entire completed content.
  • FIG. 97 shows an example of displaying the partial content on the display screen of the mobile terminal device using the digital stub shown in FIG. 93 (with options).
  • the user visits a location associated with the first partial content, and has a choice by reading the local ID associated with the first partial content at the location by the mobile terminal device.
  • a digital stub is issued.
  • this digital stub is for displaying, for example, partial contents representing a scene of the video game development, and a plurality of partial contents associated with the stub are portable terminals. It is displayed on the display screen of the device.
  • FIG. 97 shows an example of displaying the partial content on the display screen of the mobile terminal device using the digital stub shown in FIG. 93 (with options).
  • the user visits a location associated with the first partial content, and has a choice by reading the local ID associated with the first partial content at the location by the mobile terminal device.
  • a digital stub is issued.
  • this digital stub is for displaying, for example, partial contents representing
  • the information providing system of the tenth embodiment can be embodied as the embodiment shown in FIG.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment provides existing content (historical information) to the user, whereas the information providing system according to this alternative example uses basic content (typical) as a starting point. Only the partial content that is a part of the completed content and the partial content that is the beginning of the story development) is prepared as an existing partial content (stored in the storage means of the administrator system 4110X), and its basic For subsequent partial content that follows the content, the user creates or creates new content in sequence, depending on the scene, context, or other elements for association.
  • the storage unit of the administrator system 4110X is configured to store in association with the immediately preceding partial content.
  • user 1 usually a parent user such as an administrator system
  • another user user 2 actually visits a specific place (place where the node ID of the stub A is attached) and reads the node ID of the stub A with the mobile terminal device
  • the user 2 can browse the basic story A associated with the stub A.
  • the information providing system of this different example is configured so that the user 2 can create and store the next story (additional story B) that is continuous with the basic story A. That is, in order to create the additional story B, the user 2 needs to obtain a stub B corresponding to the additional story B in addition to the stub A (corresponding to the basic story A).
  • the stub B can be obtained by actually visiting a place where the node ID of the additional story B associated with the stub B is attached and reading the node ID by the mobile terminal device. At this time, the user 2 needs to obtain the stub A that forms a pair with the stub B. In this case, the user 1 transfers the stub A to the mobile terminal device of the user 2 via a network or the like. You can also.
  • user 1 checks the attributes of user 2 (such as creditworthiness) and transfers stub A only if it is determined to be reliable.
  • attributes of user 2 such as creditworthiness
  • transfers stub A only if it is determined to be reliable.
  • next user creates the next additional story (additional story C etc.) and associates it with the storage means of the administrator system 4100X (to the previous story) and stores it. This makes it possible to create a story as completed content.
  • the creation and storage of additional content can be controlled by using the later-described approval function (the normal approval function in FIG. 103 and the deletion approval function in FIG. 104).
  • the information providing system of the tenth embodiment can also construct a hub type network as shown in FIG. That is, a location that serves as a hub (for example, a specific hot spring resort) is provided with a corresponding local ID (that is, the above node ID for the hub), while a specific location around the location (hub) is specified.
  • a location that serves as a hub for example, a specific hot spring resort
  • a corresponding local ID that is, the above node ID for the hub
  • a specific location around the location (hub) is specified.
  • Each of the facilities for example, nodes A, B, C, and D (stores A, B, C, and D) including stores such as souvenir stores
  • has a corresponding local ID that is, the above node for each node). ID
  • a predetermined corresponding partial content is associated and stored in a predetermined storage unit.
  • corresponding stubs A, B, C, and D are issued to each facility, and the user (tourist or the like) reads the local ID of the place serving as the hub with the portable terminal device, and then the surrounding facilities And the local ID of the facility is read by the portable terminal device, a mutual link is formed between the facility and the hub location, and the predetermined storage area (edge table or the like) of the administrator system 4100X is formed.
  • management is performed when another person (user) wants to link his / her second information to the first information of the owner (user) of the first information.
  • the person system 4100X performs a link application process as shown in FIG. Specifically, first, for example, when the person in charge of the location A wants to link the node ID (ID_A) of the location A (as a local ID) to the node ID (ID_B) of another location B, for example, The person in charge of A makes a link application to the person in charge of the place B (using the corresponding configuration of the administrator system 4100X).
  • the person in charge at the location B approves the link
  • the person in charge at the location B notifies the link approval (using the corresponding configuration of the administrator system 4100X).
  • the person in charge at the place A issues the stub A at the place A and transfers it to the person in charge at the place B by network communication or the like.
  • the place B owns the corresponding stub B.
  • a mutual link is formed between the stub A and the stub B.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment can be applied to a so-called stamp rally, or a function performed by a so-called narrative section (a transmission function of a specific folk tale, etc.) can be realized by a computer device. That is, the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment records specific content at a specific location in the memory. Therefore, this recorded information (specific content linked to each place) can be used in the stamp rally. In this case, the information providing system records normal rally stamp information (only a series of stamp information stamped on the stamp sheet) and contents behind it (for example, information specific to the place where the stamp is pressed). To do. Thereby, using this information providing system, it is possible to reliably record information of places (specific various places) that the user has gone through, and to create a unique world consisting of the places that have been passed.
  • information can be linked from the place where the user actually visited, and only information on the place where the user has actually visited is linked. At this time, if you do not own the stub, you will not be able to see the corresponding information, and as a result, you will not be able to see all the information. One can be brought to that place without fail.
  • this information providing system can have game elements. That is, as shown in FIG. 97, on the display screen of the mobile terminal device or the like, in addition to the game picture (picture), the basic explanation (for example, explanation of the warrior who is the character) is displayed. Location, development, etc. can be provided to users. In addition, the explanation of the next scene and place is only suggested (or only the title information is displayed), and the specific explanation is not given, so that the user is interested in the next scene. Can be encouraged. In this case, it is also possible to additionally display information such as where (where and where) the information can be obtained.
  • the information providing system can provide a user with a card such as a paper medium as a physical card. At this time, in order to obtain this physical card, a digital stub may be required.
  • this information providing system can be applied to novels and can be used for chapter preparation for each place.
  • supplementary information that complements certain information is located elsewhere, so users must always go to that location to obtain the supplemental information.
  • the directionality as a real world information provision system can be enhanced.
  • a digital stub corresponding to the above stub composed of digital information
  • a single content is created from the half content (corresponding to the partial content) and the half content, and used for viewing by the user. be able to.
  • this information providing system can be used for mutual regional cooperation by utilizing the point that the user always visits the place for information supplementation.
  • Any entity that is the target of this information provision system can be anything, and as mentioned above, events, people, facilities, things made by (someone), people making it, etc. Any entity that can be linked to each other can be targeted.
  • This information provision system is targeted at people who want to introduce (or refer to) their location and facilities to others, and by actually contacting one person to another, their location is actually changed. This can lead to an increase in the number of customers visiting.
  • this information providing system can obtain a corresponding stub (digital stub) by bookmarking (BM) a node using an edge.
  • BM bookmarking
  • FIGS. 91 and 92 it is preferable to use a pair of stub 1 and stub 2 as one set, which simplifies the system configuration.
  • the number of stubs may be 3 or 4 (or more) to form one set.
  • the link strength is “0” in a state where a pair of nodes are linked at the edge. That is, in this case, it indicates that the user has not been to the place and bookmarked. However, if the user actually goes to the place and bookmarks the node, the link strength becomes “1”, and if the favorite is registered, the link strength becomes “2”, “3”,.
  • the contents (contents) of the first part of the first chapter are as follows. You can see, but if you have not bookmarked stub 2, you can not see the contents (contents) of Part 2 of Chapter 1 (view only the contents (contents) of Part 1 of Chapter 1 Is configured so that it cannot.
  • a hot spring egg character may be used for the stub.
  • the hot spring egg (as an image display) can be configured to open when the user goes to the place.
  • the information registration management unit 4112bx shown in FIG. 85 realizes a function for registering information input by the user from the user system 4200X using the information registration GUI in the administrator system 4100X.
  • the information registration management unit 4112bx implements a function of registering information transmitted from the user system 4200 in the administrator system 4100X by the information registration process (user process) shown in FIG.
  • a user terminal device 4200X as a user system includes information registration means 4210X including the information means 4210AX, 4210BX, 4210X.
  • the information registration means 4210X realizes a function of registering main information of the main user system 4200X with respect to the administrator system 4100X and applying for issuance of a local ID such as an article ID.
  • non-user processing is performed in STEP 4X (that is, guest user processing using cookies is performed as described in the ninth embodiment).
  • the administrator system 4100X transmits the GUI information of the information registration screen (screen corresponding to the information registration page UI20) to the user system 4200X, and the user system 4200.
  • the information registration screen is displayed on the registration screen (a screen corresponding to the registration screen 240).
  • STEP 6X when the input information is transmitted from the user system 4200X to the administrator system 4100X by the confirmation means (corresponding to the content confirmation button UI25 of the main information registration page UI20), the administrator system 4100X The data of each input item is confirmed, and it is determined in STEP 7X whether necessary basic information (information corresponding to the main information and the information described in the tenth embodiment) is input. If it is determined that the necessary basic information is not input in STEP 7X, an error display is executed in STEP 8X, and STEP 5X is executed again until the necessary basic information is input on the information registration screen. (STEP5X to STEP7X) are repeated.
  • necessary basic information information corresponding to the main information and the information described in the tenth embodiment
  • the type of the local ID related to the application is determined in STEP 9X. If the local ID type determined in STEP 9X is NFC, an NFC-ID is issued in STEP 10X. If the type of local ID determined in STEP 9X is BC (one-dimensional barcode), a one-dimensional barcode ID is issued in STEP 11X. When the type of the local ID determined in STEP 9X is a 2D (two-dimensional) barcode, a 2D barcode ID is issued in STEP 12X.
  • the administrator system 4100X creates a registration information confirmation page (a page corresponding to the main information registration confirmation / ID issuance application page UI30) and transmits it to the user system 4200X.
  • the confirmation information is transmitted to the administrator system 4100X by the application means (corresponding to the ID application button UI33 of the main information registration confirmation / ID issue application page UI30)
  • the administrator system 4100X The registration information (basic information) is stored and registered in the basic information table 122, and the user process is completed.
  • STEP22X may be omitted.
  • STEP 23X based on the user information such as the user ID input from the user system 4200X, it is determined whether or not the accessed user is a regular user, and it is determined that the user is not a user.
  • step 24X non-user processing is performed.
  • the administrator system 4100X transmits the GUI information of the information registration screen to the user system 4200X and causes the registration screen 240 of the user system 4200X to display the information registration screen. .
  • STEP 26X when input information is transmitted from the user system 4200X to the administrator system 4100X by the content confirmation button on the information registration page, the administrator system 4100X checks the data of each input item, and in STEP 27X. The necessary conditions for processing such as whether or not the URL of the first information for linking to the second information is input are determined. If it is determined in STEP 27X that necessary information has not been input, an error display is executed in STEP 28X, STEP 25X is executed again, and this series of processing (STEP 25X to STEP 27X is performed until necessary information is input on the information registration screen. ) Is repeated.
  • the administrator system 4100X creates an information confirmation page (information confirmation page) and transmits it to the user system 4200X. Then, in STEP 30X, when the confirmed information is transmitted to the administrator system 4100X by a link application button or the like on the information confirmation page, the administrator system 4100X uses the approval method (approval mode) for approving the information linking in STEP 31X. ) For example, based on the approval mode selected on the information registration page. If it is determined in STEP 31X that the approval method is the normal approval mode, a normal approval routine shown in FIG. 103 (corresponding to the normal approval routine in FIG.
  • the user of the second information determines whether to approve the link application. That is, when the user of the second information does not approve (rejects) the link of the first information of the other person who has applied for a link to his / her second information, the user of the second information On the approval page, a delete button or the like is selected and executed (that is, a rejection link approval unit is executed). As a result, the link application is rejected in STEP 45X, and the first information is not linked to the second information.
  • STEP 47X the link registration process for the URL of the first information related to the link application is executed, and the first information is linked to the second information.
  • the link registration process is executed, the content corresponding to the predetermined page is updated in STEP 48X.
  • the deletion approval routine will be described with reference to the flowchart of FIG. First, in the normal approval routine, when there is an application for linking the first information to the specific second information from the user system 4200X, the administrator system 4100X approves the user of the second information. A user system that provides a user page and decides whether to approve the link of the first information of the other person to the second information of the user before the link of the first information. Via the 4200X, only the first information that the user of the second information has indicated the intention of approval is linked to the second information, and data such as a predetermined page is updated.
  • the administrator system 4100X when there is an application for linking the first information to the specific second information from the user system 4200X, the administrator system 4100X does not obtain the approval of the user of the second information. 3rd, where all the first information for which a link application has been applied is registered as a link to the second information and the data on the predetermined page etc.
  • the administrator system 4100X includes a “link deletion application means” that realizes such a function), and is specified to a third party.
  • the first information of the specific second And it is adapted to determine whether it is appropriate as a broadcast of a linking object.
  • the deletion approval routine as shown in FIG. 104, in STEP 51X, the user system 4200X makes an application with a link to the first information for specific second information to the administrator system 4100X.
  • the administrator system 4100X receives the first information of the user related to the application (by the user of the second information by the information registration management means) in STEP52X.
  • a link application is made for the relevant information portion of a predetermined web page or the like (for example, a guide page) for the second information immediately before the target second information is registered. (That is, the same routine process as the link registration / page update process of STEP 50X is executed).
  • the administrator system 4100X monitors the output from the link deletion application means for the web page etc. whose first information has been updated, and deletes the link of the first information to the second information. Determine whether or not an application has been made.
  • the link deletion application means can be realized by, for example, a “link deletion application button” provided in the vicinity (for example, the right side) of each first information link on a predetermined web page such as a guide page.
  • the link deletion application button is selected and executed.
  • the information browsing terminal 500 may transmit the deletion application information to the information registration management unit of the administrator system 4100X, and the information registration management unit may execute the deletion application process.
  • the administrator system 4100X deletes the link of the first information to the second information related to the application, and in STEP 56X, the second information The guide page or the like is updated (that is, the information of the first information is deleted).
  • STEP57X the administrator system 4100X transmits a link-attached confirmation mail of the URL return page (for restoring the deleted link) to the user system 4200X.
  • the URL restoration page (web page) is displayed on the registration screen (corresponding to the registration screen 240) of the user system 4200X. Is displayed.
  • the URL return page displays the detailed page of the first information whose link has been deleted for confirmation by the user.
  • a link deletion approval / return button such as a delete approval button or a return button (link deletion) (Approval / return means)
  • the user determines whether to approve deletion of the link of the target first information or to restore the link of the deleted first information. That is, when the user approves the deletion of the link of the first information whose link is deleted with respect to the second information of the user, the user selects and executes the delete approval button on the URL return page. (Or, the URL return page is terminated without pressing the return button). Thereby, in STEP 60X, the link deletion state by the administrator system 4100X is maintained, and the deleted first information is not linked again to the second information.
  • STEP 59X when the user wishes to return the link of the first information whose link has been deleted with respect to his second information (that is, when it is determined that the link deletion is not valid) The user selects and executes a return button on the URL return page.
  • the administrator system 4100X restores the link of the deleted first information, and links the deleted first information to the second information again.
  • the link return process is executed in STEP 61X, the corresponding content such as the guide page is updated in STEP 62X (that is, the first information related to the restored link registration is posted).
  • the administrator system 4100X has the same person who deleted the specific first information that has restored the link to the specific second information (hereinafter also referred to as “link deleter”).
  • link deleter In order not to delete the link of the same first information related to the second information after that (after link recovery) again, the same information as the person who deleted the link is related to the same second information.
  • a process of depriving the authority to delete the link of the same first information (same deletion main authority depriving process) is executed. Thereby, when there is a link deletion application for the same first information related to the same second information, the administrator system 4100X determines that the link deletion applicant is the first in the deletion request determination step of STEP53X. It is determined whether or not the authority to delete the link of the first information related to the information of 2 has been deprived (for example, based on the user ID of the person) and rejects the link deletion request from the same deletion owner .
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx connects link strengths between nodes (ie, one specific node to another specific node) by its link node strength calculation function (ie, function as link strength calculation unit). The total number of edges to be calculated) is realized.
  • link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx is configured as a function realization unit for calculating the link strength between two pairs of nodes, a series of procedures (link strength calculation processing) as shown in FIG. Is executed by a computer device.
  • the link strength calculation process in FIG. 105 is an example, and the link strength calculation / management means 4112cx can also calculate the link strength by another link strength calculation process.
  • the link strength calculation process obtains the node IDs of all nodes in the edge table in STEP 81X, and then in STEP 82X, the node strength of each node ID in the edge table.
  • the link strength value is set to “0” (ie, initialized).
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines at a predetermined timing whether or not another node (second node) is linked to one node (first node).
  • the monitor process (the same process as the “link monitor process” described in the above embodiment) may be executed, in the tenth embodiment, the first node and the second node are linked to each other.
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx refers to the node ID of the first node and the node ID of the second node at a predetermined timing in STEP83X. Then, it is determined whether or not the bookmark processing has been performed for the first node or the second node (that is, after the first node ID is read and the first node is registered, the second node It is determined whether or not the ID is read and the registration process of the second node is completed), and whether or not the favorite registration process is performed for the first node or the second node is determined (that is, the above-mentioned After the bookmark process, it is determined whether the favorite registration process for registering the first node and / or the second node as a “favorite” is completed).
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines in STEP 83X that neither the bookmark process nor the favorite registration process is executed for the first node or the second node, the link strength calculation process ends. On the other hand, when the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines in STEP 83X that the bookmark processing has been executed for the first node or the second node, the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines that the first node And the weight of the edge connecting the second node (ie, link strength) is increased by “1”.
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines that the favorite registration process has been executed for the first node or the second node
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx The weight of the edge connecting the second node and the second node (that is, link strength) is further increased by “1”. That is, when the favorite registration process is performed, the weight of the edge connecting the first node and the second node (that is, the link strength) is incremented by “1” by the bookmark process and “1” by the favorite registration process. "Increment" is added to become “2".
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines whether there is another node (other than the second node) to which the first node is linked in the edge table. If the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines in STEP 85X that there is no other node (other than the second node) linked to the first node, the link strength calculation processing ends. On the other hand, when the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx determines in STEP 85X that there is another node (third node) (other than the second node) linked to the first node, the link strength calculation / management The means 4112cx obtains the node ID of the third node in addition to the node ID of the first node in STEP86X.
  • the link strength calculation / management means 4112cx (when it is determined that there is a reason for the increase in link strength as described above) in the edge table, the weight of the edge between the first node and the third node ( Link strength) is increased by “1”.
  • the link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx executes the processing of STEP83X to STEP87X each time another node is newly linked to one node. As a result, the two nodes forming the pair are linked to each other via the edge, and the link strength (by the edge) between the two nodes forming the pair is calculated.
  • the link strength is an index representing the strength of a link between two nodes that form a mutual link by the node ID, and is stored in the edge table in association with each of the two nodes that form a pair. For example, as shown in FIG. 106, when the first node N31X and the second node N32X are registered in the administrator system 4100X, both the nodes N31X and N32X are linked via the edge. In such a state, the link strength between the nodes N31X and N32X is “0”.
  • a user for example, the store of the first node is visited
  • the consumer reads the local ID of the product of the second node stored in the store of the first node with his / her mobile terminal device and performs bookmark processing, between the first node and the second node
  • the link strength is changed from “0” to “1”.
  • the link strength between the first node and the second node is changed from “1” to “2”.
  • a consultant that provides (sells) a seminar (service) for a fee is a first node and a specific seminar of seminars held by the consultant is a second node
  • a user for example, A consumer who knows the consultant of the first node through an introductory medium such as a magazine, and the local ID of the seminar of the second node held by the consultant of the first node (for example, a seminar on a web page or flyer)
  • the local ID attached to the notification medium is read by the mobile terminal device and bookmark processing is performed, the link strength between the first node and the second node is changed from “0” to “1”.
  • the link strength between the first node and the second node is changed from “1” to “2”. Furthermore, when the user actually attends the service (seminars) of the second node and is registered as a customer in the student list of the consultant of the first node (and the administrator system 4100X has its When the customer registration process is set as the reason for increasing the link strength), the link strength between the first node and the second node is changed from “2” to “3”.
  • the second node service of the consultant of the first node may be used by another person (for example, another consultant who has an alliance relationship with the consultant) to introduce the second node service through his / her own introduction medium.
  • another person for example, another consultant who has an alliance relationship with the consultant
  • the user further reads the local ID of the service of the second node in the other person's introduction medium by his / her mobile terminal device and performs bookmark processing, The link strength between the first node and the second node is further increased by “1”.
  • the edge table indicates a state where two different nodes n1 and n2 are linked to each other via two different edges e1 and e2, and this relationship is stored in the edge table.
  • confirmation and determination can be made.
  • the link strength between the nodes n1 and n2 can be confirmed and determined by referring to the weight of the edge table for the edge connecting both the notes n1 and n2. In the example of FIG. 107, the weight is “2”.
  • link strength In the description of the link strength, “bookmark processing” and “favorite registration processing” are cited as reasons for increasing the link strength (events when increasing), the link strength increases from “0” to “1”, Furthermore, the case of increasing from “1” to “2” has been described, but the link strength in the information processing system of the present invention may also occur between one node and another node. For all events, it can be the reason for the increase in link strength. Each time such an event occurs, the link strength between the one node and the other node may be increased by “1”. it can. That is, the link strength in the information processing system of the present invention may naturally exceed “2” in accordance with the number or type of events set as the reason for increasing the link strength.
  • Embodiment 11 As shown in FIG. 108, in addition to the configuration of the information providing system of the first embodiment or the like, the information providing system according to the eleventh embodiment displays information such as a product subject to physical ID (for example, a business card size). ) Printing on a physical card and using this physical card together increases the level of interest of the user. Specifically, as shown in FIG. 108, the physical card is printed with a photograph of the product A to which the physical ID is assigned, and a local ID (article ID) corresponding to the product A is attached by printing. Yes.
  • a product subject to physical ID for example, a business card size.
  • a pair of stubs (in this case, the first and second stubs) is issued to the user corresponding to the paired nodes (for example, the first and second nodes).
  • the pair of stubs can be used to acquire a pair of partial contents (in this case, first and second partial contents) having continuous contents.
  • the first content can be viewed by bookmarking the corresponding local ID (first node ID) at the first node and acquiring the first stub, By bookmarking the corresponding local ID (second node ID) at node 2 and obtaining a second stub (ie, by obtaining a paired first and second stub)
  • a mutual link is established between the first and second nodes so that the second partial content can be viewed. That is, in the tenth embodiment, the relationship between the paired nodes is a one-to-one relationship.
  • each partial content is stored in association with each node in advance, and by acquiring a stub of one node, one partial content can be acquired and two stubs that make a pair are acquired. Only when a predetermined condition is satisfied, a pair of partial contents (consecutive contents) corresponding to the paired nodes can be acquired.
  • partial contents are stored in a predetermined column (for example, node_desc of nodes in FIGS. 70 and 71) in a predetermined data format (for example, JSON) in the node table of the corresponding node.
  • a predetermined data format for example, JSON
  • the data related to the stub assigned to the node is stored in, for example, a predetermined column of the node table of the node (for example, not shown, ticket_01).
  • the data of the partial content corresponding to the node is transmitted to the mobile terminal device and displayed.
  • the node ID of the link destination node that is linked to the node that is, the link source node
  • the stub assigned to the link destination node Is transmitted to the mobile terminal device (and displayed as necessary)
  • the partial content data corresponding to the link destination node is transmitted to the mobile terminal device, so that the partial content of the link source node is transmitted.
  • the partial content of the link source node (which is set to be a link source of the link destination node) is also stored together with the partial content of the link destination node (for example, , Stored in the node_desc), and the series (two) partial contents may be read from the node table of the link destination node and transmitted.
  • the node ID of the link source node and the node ID of the link destination node are respectively stored in predetermined columns of the edge table (for example, node_id_01 and node_id_02 of edges in FIGS. 70 and 71). A mutual link is formed with the link destination node.
  • edge data between the link source node and the link destination node is necessary. Can be stored in advance in the edge table. For example, before the link is established between the link source node and the link destination node (that is, until the node ID of the link destination node is read after the node ID of the link source node is read), the edge data A predetermined column (for example, status of edges in FIGS. 70 and 71) is set to a value indicating a non-link state (for example, “0”), and a link is established between the link source node and the link destination node.
  • a non-link state for example, “0”
  • a predetermined column indicating the state of the edge data is set to a value indicating the mutual link state ( For example, it may be set to “1”), and at that time, two consecutive partial contents may be transmitted as described above.
  • the node that forms the pair is the first time A pair of partial contents (consecutive contents) corresponding to can be acquired.
  • FIG. 109 in another example of the tenth embodiment, the same field (column) as that of the tenth embodiment is defined in the node table. That is, in the node table, the same node ID (node_id) and root node ID (root_node_id) as the node table (nodes) shown in FIGS.
  • the root node ID (root_node_id) is an ID indicating that when there is data having a hierarchical structure, the data is the highest hierarchy (root hierarchy). is there.
  • the information providing system according to the tenth embodiment and other examples can be applied to a stamp rally execution system, an attendance management system such as a school, a groupware system, and the like. Then, for example, the information providing system specifies the data of the highest hierarchy by the root node ID, specifies the “subject” and “object (or complement)” by the node ID, and uses the “ID” by the edge ID. It can be configured to identify "predicates".
  • the information providing system when the information providing system is applied to a stamp rally execution system, the information providing system assigns a unique root node ID to a specific one of a large number of stamp rallies held (for example, a specific date). To a specific stamp rally by a specific organizer held at a specific location), so that the specific stamp rally can be specified by a loop node ID. In this case, the information providing system assigns a unique node ID (that is, a node ID as the participant ID) to each participant of the specific stamp rally, and the participant of the specific stamp rally is assigned by the node ID. Be identified.
  • the information providing system assigns a unique node ID (that is, a node ID as a stamp ID) to each stamp point of the specific stamp rally, and each stamp point of the specific stamp rally is assigned by the node ID. Be identified.
  • a specific participant of the specific stamp rally reads the node ID of the stamp point attached to a physical medium (for example, a stamp stand) provided for each stamp point with his / her portable terminal device.
  • the node ID of the stamp point is linked to the node ID of the participant (that is, edge data that links the node ID of the participant and the node ID of the stamp point is created, and the node ID, edge ID, etc. are stored), and it can be recorded that the participant has pressed the stamp at the stamp point.
  • the information providing system uses “where (location)”, “who (subject)”, “what” according to the root node ID, participant node ID, stamp point node ID, and edge ID, respectively.
  • (Object) ”and“ what (predicate) ” can be specified. That is, the information providing system can specify the location of the stamp rally, the identification of the participant, the identification of the stamp point, and whether or not the participant has pressed the stamp of the specific stamp point. That is, the information providing system uses the node table or the edge table based on the root node ID, the node ID of the participant, the node ID of the stamp point, and the edge ID. ), “Which participant” (identified by the node ID of the participant), “At which stamp point” (identified by the node ID of the stamp point), and “Pressed stamp” (identified by the edge ID) It can be performed.
  • the root node ID is an ID for uniquely determining a specific “school”.
  • a node ID as a “student ID” for uniquely determining a specific student of the school
  • a class of the school a specific lesson subject held in a specific classroom at a specific date and time
  • the information providing system will display the student's node.
  • a link is established between the ID and the node ID of the class, and the edge data of the link is stored in the edge table.
  • the information providing system can determine which student has received which class by using the node table or the edge table.
  • the node table defines a from node ID (from_node_id) as a field (column), and stores corresponding data.
  • This from node ID is stored in the node table in association with the node ID of a specific node, and is an ID that uniquely identifies the node from which the node originates.
  • information indicating where the participant came from (origin) with respect to the participant's node ID (node ID that becomes the participant ID in the stamp rally)
  • a unique from node ID is assigned to a location, an address location, a belonging organization, and the like.
  • the information providing system uses the node table or the edge table by the above-mentioned from node ID, root node ID, participant node ID, stamp point node ID, and edge ID, and "in which stamp rally” (Identified by the root node ID), “from where” (identified by the root node ID), “which participant” (identified by the node ID of the participant), “at which stamp point” (by the node ID of the stamp point) Determination), “depressed stamp” (specified by edge ID) can be made.
  • information indicating where the student came from (birthplace, address) with respect to the student's node ID (node ID that becomes the student ID at the school) , High school, etc.) are assigned a unique From Node ID.
  • the information providing system uses the node table and the edge table based on the from node ID, the root node ID, the participant node ID, the stamp point node ID, and the edge ID, and at which school ( Identified by root node ID), “Where came from” (identified by root node ID), “Which student” (identified by node ID of participant), “Which class” (identified by node ID of stamp point), It can be determined that “I attended” (identified by the edge ID).
  • the user of the link source node may refer to the information “from where (or where has seen) the link destination node” (hereinafter referred to as “origin information”). .) May be an important factor. For example, when a user of a link source node participates in the stamp rally by looking at notice information of a specific stamp rally published in an information medium such as a magazine or a website, the node ID of the stamp rally (the above route) It is unclear what route the user participated in the stamp rally simply by bookmarking the node ID).
  • the node ID is the from node ID. Is stored in the node table or the like. Therefore, when the user bookmarks the node ID (the root node ID) of the stamp rally, the information providing system refers to the node table and extracts the from-node ID, so that the user can It is possible to recognize the participation of the stamp rally through such a route (that is, to see which information medium's announcement information), and to use it as an index to measure the advertising effect of the information medium. Can be used.
  • edge table In another example of the tenth embodiment, fields (columns) similar to those in the tenth embodiment are defined in the edge table as shown in FIG. That is, in the edge table, the same node ID 01 (node_id_01), node ID 02 (node_id_02), root node ID (root_node_id), edge ID (edge_id), and the like are defined as in the edge table (edges) shown in FIGS. The corresponding data is stored.
  • the root node ID (root_node_id) is the same as the root node ID in the node table, and when a link is formed between the nodes, the corresponding root node ID is also stored in the edge table.
  • the from node ID (from_node_id) is defined in the edge table as in the node table, and the corresponding data is stored. This from node ID is the same as the from node ID of the node table. When a link is formed between the nodes, the from node ID corresponding to the edge table is also stored.
  • the edge table includes a node ID01 direction (node_id_01_dir) and a node ID02 as a field (column) for determining the link direction (that is, as “node ID direction (node_id_direction)”).
  • a direction (node_id_02_dir) is defined and corresponding data is stored.
  • the values of “1” and “2” are stored as continuous values, and the link between the nodes expresses from which node to which node. It is supposed to be.
  • the information providing system can determine that the link between the node 1 and the node 2 is a link extending from the node 1 toward the node 2.
  • the node ID direction expresses whether each node becomes the start point (base end side of the line segment) or the end point (arrowhead side) of the directed link (directed edge) for the link between the nodes. .
  • the information providing system can determine that the link between the node 1 and the node 2 is a link extending from the node 2 toward the node 1.
  • the direction in which information flows can be expressed. For example, in a subject (predicate) or object (or complement) sentence (sentence), node 1 is the subject, node 2 can be expressed as an object (or complement).
  • the edge table includes content in a predetermined format (for example, JSON format data) including predetermined text data, as in the node description (node_description, ie, node_desc) of the node table.
  • Edge description (edge_description, ie, edge_desc) is defined as a field (column) for storing the corresponding data.
  • a field (column) for storing predetermined text data a text 01 (text_01), a text 02 (text_02), a text 03 (text_03) (hereinafter referred to as a text 04, etc.) Only), and the corresponding text data is stored respectively.
  • text data can also be stored as hierarchical data.
  • text 01 is configured as text data of the highest hierarchy
  • text 2 is text data of the next lower hierarchy (intermediate hierarchy) of text 1
  • text 3 is configured as text data of the next lower hierarchy (lowermost hierarchy) of text 2.
  • the text 1 and the like can be configured as text data in the same hierarchy.
  • Embodiment 12 As a specific example of the main information use type information providing system, the information providing system according to the ninth embodiment is further improved and developed as in the tenth embodiment, and the embodiment 12 is related.
  • the information providing system will be described.
  • the information providing system in the twelfth embodiment is an extension and development of the technical idea of the information providing system in the ninth embodiment.
  • the information providing system according to the twelfth embodiment may be an embodiment in which various functions of the information providing system according to each of the above embodiments are implemented alone or in appropriate combination.
  • an outline of the features of the information providing system of the invention according to Embodiment 12 will be described.
  • the information providing system according to the twelfth embodiment is an extension and / or application of the first to ninth embodiments including the ninth embodiment, as in the tenth embodiment. May be described with the aid of the description of the first embodiment, in which case (in the tenth embodiment, “X” at the end of the symbols (member numbers, etc.) used in the first embodiment and the like. Or, as described with “x” attached thereto, in Embodiment 12, “Y” or “y” is added to the end of the code (member number, etc.) used in Embodiment 1 or the like (or In the following description, “X” and “x” at the end of the codes used in Embodiment 10 are replaced with “Y” and “y”.
  • the twelfth embodiment is an invention obtained by changing or developing the tenth embodiment, naturally, the various configurations and functions described in the tenth embodiment can also be applied to the twelfth embodiment. . Therefore, the configuration and functions of the tenth embodiment applicable to the twelfth embodiment may be omitted in the following description. Of course, such functions and configurations are also constituent elements of the invention of the twelfth embodiment. Thus, an invention including such a component is also within the scope of the present invention.
  • the relationship between the node and the content is 1: 1.
  • the information providing system is configured such that the relationship between nodes and content (or the relationship between conditions and content) is many to one. That is, for example, the setting is made on the condition that physical bookmarks are registered for all of three or more nodes (node 1, node 2, node 3, etc.). In other words, in the above case, one content corresponding to the one condition that the second node is bookmarked after the bookmark of the first node is displayed.
  • the condition in terms of linking two nodes with one edge, if the number of edges is regarded as the number of conditions, the condition is one condition (hereinafter, sometimes referred to as “single condition”). Can do.
  • it is not a single condition that only requires formation of one link (edge), but a condition that requires the formation of a plurality of links (edges) (in the sense that a plurality of edges are required)
  • a process of displaying a predetermined content (one content or two or more contents) set in accordance with the composite condition is executed only after “composite condition” is satisfied.
  • each content in this case can be configured as, for example, one content that is continuous in terms of content (a content that displays partial content continuously). Details of the information providing system according to the twelfth embodiment will be described below.
  • the information providing system of the twelfth embodiment includes an administrator system 4100Y, a user system 4100X, and a physical medium providing place 4400X, as in the tenth embodiment.
  • the configurations of the user system 4100X and the physical medium providing place 4400X are the same as those in the tenth embodiment.
  • the administrator system 4100Y includes information management means 4110Y and a management information database (DB) 4120Y. Similar to the information management unit 4110X of the tenth embodiment, the information management unit 4110Y includes components (function implementation units) such as a link strength calculation / management unit 4112cx and a node management unit 4111X.
  • the management information DB 4120Y includes the same tables (node table, edge table, node type table, edge type table, etc.) as the management information DB 4120X of the tenth embodiment, and performs the above-described many-to-many data processing.
  • a control table and a content table are provided as a control table and a content table (sometimes referred to as “secret table”).
  • the display management unit 4115Y includes a link condition management / determination unit 4112by and a content extraction / display unit 4112ay.
  • the link condition management / determination means 4112 by sets (stores) and manages the conditions necessary for displaying the predetermined content in the control table, and refers to the control table to determine whether the condition has occurred. Realize the function to determine whether or not.
  • the content extraction / display unit 4112ay has a function of extracting predetermined content from the content table based on the determination result of the link condition management / determination unit 4112by, and transmitting and displaying the predetermined content to the user system 4200X. Realize. Note that data related to the control node is held as internal data of the administrator system 4100Y, and cannot be viewed from the outside.
  • control node 1 and control node 2 are ( Set in the control table).
  • the control node 1 and the control node 2 store content 1 and content 2 in association with each other as corresponding predetermined content.
  • the information providing system stores the content ID of content 1 and the content ID of content 2 in association with the control ID of control node 1 and the control ID of control node 2, respectively, in the control table. Yes.
  • the information providing system sets a predetermined composite condition (composite condition 1) as a condition for displaying the content 1 in the control table, and stores it in association with the control node 1.
  • the information providing system sets a predetermined composite condition (composite condition 2) as a condition for displaying the content 2 in the control table, and stores it in association with the control node 2.
  • the composite condition 1 of the control node 1 is set on the condition that, for example, all of the nodes 1, 2 and 3 are bookmarked.
  • the compound condition 2 of the control node 2 is set on the condition that, for example, another plurality of nodes (for example, the node A and the node D) are all bookmark-registered.
  • the control node 1 (root node 1) is set as a node that uniquely represents a specific (first) stamp rally
  • the control node 2 (root node 2) is set as a node that uniquely represents another specific (second) stamp rally.
  • the compound condition 1 includes a node 1 that is a user node (a node type “node_man” may be set in this node) and a node 2 that is a stamp point 1 (a node type “node_point” in this node).
  • the node 3 that becomes the stamp point 2 are all registered as bookmarks (that is, the user registers both the stamp at the stamp point 1 and the stamp 2 at the bookmark). ).
  • compound condition 2 can also be made conditional on completion of bookmark registration for all nodes (comprising a combination of stamp points different from the above) in addition to user nodes.
  • compound condition 2 can be made conditional on completion of bookmark registration for both node A and node B (having another node type representing another attribute) from a different perspective than the stamp point.
  • the administrator system 4100Y uses a link condition management / determination means 4112by, for example, to a node different from the node A and the node B (for example, the control node 1 which is another control node via the edge).
  • the information providing system determines that the stamp of the node 3 in the stamp rally is pressed (that is, the node ID is bookmarked) in addition to the determination of the composite condition 2 based on the bookmark registration of the node A and the node B. It is also possible to set a new composite condition in which the composite condition 2 is corrected in the condition.
  • the information providing system refers to the control table by using the link condition management / determination means 4112by of the display management means 4115Y of the administrator system 4100Y, and whether or not the composite condition 1 is satisfied for the control node 1
  • the content condition management / determination unit 4112by of the display management unit 4115Y is used to refer to the content table and the content corresponding to the composite condition 1 (for example, the content 1 Text 1 (text_01) is extracted, and the content is transmitted and displayed on the user system 4200CX of the user, etc.
  • the information providing system uses the link condition management / determination means 4112by to control the control table. And connect to control node 2.
  • the content condition management / determination means 4112by is used to refer to the content table, and the content corresponding to the composite condition 2 ( For example, the text 2 (text_02) of the content 2 is extracted, and the content is transmitted to the user system 4200CX of the user and displayed, etc.
  • the information providing system is configured to use a composite condition (for example, a certain control node)
  • the composite condition 2) of the control node 2 is satisfied, instead of extracting the content of the control node (in this case, the content 2), the content of another control node (for example, the content 1 of the control node 1) is extracted.
  • the function can be realized by storing the content ID of the content 1 in association with the control node 2.
  • 112 may be configured to display the same content even when the information is satisfied, as an example, the information processing system refers to the data of the from-root node associated with the node 1 of the user. And the aspect which extracts and utilizes the data regarding the origin of the user is illustrated.
  • the stamp rally is a normal stamp rally that is a monotonous operation of simply pressing stamps at predetermined stamp points sequentially.
  • a predetermined number of stamp points a combination of a predetermined number of stamp points, a combination of a plurality of consecutive stamp points as described above, or an even or odd number or a randomly selected difference depending on preset conditions.
  • the bookmark registration is executed, the user can acquire predetermined content corresponding to the composite condition only when the bookmark registration is executed. As a result, the user can be given a certain palatability improvement effect due to the secrecy that the predetermined content related to the stamp rally cannot be viewed until a predetermined composite condition is satisfied.
  • stamp rally it will be possible to hold a new genre stamp rally that should be called "stamp rally” or "secret tour".
  • stamp rally when there are a total of nine stamp points, it is determined that the composite condition 1 is satisfied when a part of a plurality of (for example, three) stamp points is bookmarked. If the first content is displayed, a sub-rally that is a subset (subset) of the stamp rally can be provided, and another entertainment can be provided to a user who cannot complete the stamp rally.
  • the information providing system according to the first to tenth embodiments, another example of the tenth embodiment, the eleventh embodiment, and the twelfth embodiment is grasped as a concept invention as shown in FIG. Can do. That is, a plurality of nodes (node A, node B, and node C) are linked to the root node via an edge, and in this sense, the plurality of nodes are connected to one root node. It can be grasped as a component or a member.
  • the plurality of nodes are nodes (node_points) representing stamp points.
  • a certain user human node: node_man
  • bookmarks one of the nodes (node_point) in the case of a stamp rally, a stamp
  • the above-described processing is executed.
  • the data structure of each of the above embodiments including the narrative part and the stamp rally can be expressed only by the above nodes and edges, and the real world Log-like information for recognizing all the structures of can be provided as data in a form that approximates real-world data.
  • various complex conditions can be created simply by changing the number and type of conditions (corresponding to the single condition of the tenth embodiment) constituting the complex condition.
  • Various conditions can be configured according to requirements.
  • the approval system of the tenth embodiment can be combined with the information providing system of the twelfth embodiment.
  • description information (information corresponding to the above contents etc.) such as node_desc stored in the node table or the like can be described in a data format such as JSON as described above.
  • a language ID (jp, en, cn, etc.) that uniquely specifies the language used for information (Japanese, English, Chinese, etc.) is stored in a predetermined table (node table, etc.), and the node_desc etc.
  • description information information described in each language (Japanese, English, Chinese, etc.) can be stored, and when a specific language is selected, the above-described content display can be performed in that language. .
  • the default language is Japanese (jp), and other languages (English, Nakago, etc.) can be arbitrarily selected by the user.
  • the data format of the description information can be stored by providing a separate table in addition to storing the node table in a data format such as JSON, or storing only difference information of the description information. (For example, data storage using a NoSQL database such as a document-oriented database).
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes: ID providing means for realizing in a computer an ID assigning function for giving a local ID, which is a unique identifier for identifying a specific object belonging to a specific place, to the specific object in an readable manner from the outside; Causes a computer to realize a main information storage function that stores main information, which is information unique to a specific object belonging to the specific location, in a main information storage area of a database in association with the local ID assigned to the specific object Main information storage means; When the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal, which is a computer device for browsing information, the local ID is associated with the user ID of the user of the information viewer terminal.
  • a browsing management means for realizing a browsing history storage function to be stored in the browsing history storage area of the database in a computer; Browsing time that causes a computer to realize a browsing time storage function in which a browsing time that is a time when the information viewer terminal reads a local ID of the specific object is associated with the local ID and stored in a browsing history storage area of the database Storage means; Geography / address information storage means for causing a computer to implement a geography / address information storage function for storing the geographic information or address information of the specific object in the main information storage area of the database in association with the local ID of the specific object; , Based on the local ID and browsing time stored in the browsing history storage area and the main information stored in the main information storage area, the title of a specific object related to the local ID in a time series based on the browsing time Is displayed on the information viewer terminal, and the computer realizes a time-series display function for giving a link to a web page having the main information of the specific object as content for the title of the specific object
  • an information providing method using a physical medium includes: An ID assigning procedure for causing a computer to execute an ID assigning process in which a local ID, which is a unique identifier for identifying a specific object belonging to a specific location, is given to the specific object in an readable manner from the outside; Causes a computer to execute main information storage processing for storing main information, which is information specific to a specific object belonging to the specific location, in a main information storage area of a database in association with the local ID assigned to the specific object Main information storage procedure, When the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal, which is a computer device for browsing information, the local ID is associated with the user ID of the user of the information viewer terminal.
  • a browsing management procedure for causing the computer to execute browsing history storage processing stored in the browsing history storage area of the database; Browsing time that causes the computer to execute browsing time storage processing in which the browsing time that is the time when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of the specific object is stored in the browsing history storage area of the database in association with the local ID Storage procedure; Geographic / address information storage procedure for causing a computer to implement geography / address information storage processing in which the geographic information or address information of the specific object is stored in the main information storage area of the database in association with the local ID of the specific object; , Based on the local ID and browsing time stored in the browsing history storage area and the main information stored in the main information storage area, the title of a specific object related to the local ID in a time series based on the browsing time Is displayed on the information viewer terminal, and the computer realizes a time-series display process for giving a link to a web page having the main information of the specific object as content for the title of the specific object Time series display procedure, Main information display processing for displaying
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes: ID providing means for realizing in a computer an ID assigning function for giving a local ID, which is a unique identifier for identifying a specific object belonging to a specific place, to the specific object in an readable manner from the outside; Main information storage means for causing a computer to realize a main information storage function for storing main information, which is information unique to a specific object belonging to the specific location, in a database in association with the local ID assigned to the specific object; , Subordinate information storage means for causing a computer to realize a subordinate information storage function for linking subordinate information, which is information related to the specific object, to the main information related to the specific object and storing it in the database; When the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal that is a computer device for browsing information, the information viewer terminal accesses the main information of the specific object.
  • Main information output means for causing a computer to realize a main information output function for outputting the main information of the specific object to the information viewer terminal in a viewable / listening manner; Access time when the information viewer terminal reads the local ID of the specific object and accesses the main information of the specific object, and stores the access time in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object Access time storage means for causing a computer to perform a storage function; Geographic / address information storage means for causing a computer to implement a geographic / address information storage function for storing the geographic information or address information of the specific object in the database in association with the local ID of the specific object; The main information output means reads the main information of the specific object when the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reading means of the information viewer terminal which is a computer device for information browsing. The subordinate information associated with the main information and the access history information related to the access from the information viewer terminal to the main information are associated with the main information. The output is performed in a viewable / listening manner.
  • an information providing method using a physical medium includes: An ID assigning procedure for causing a computer to execute an ID assigning process in which a local ID, which is a unique identifier for identifying a specific object belonging to a specific location, is given to the specific object in an readable manner from the outside; A main information storage procedure for causing a computer to execute main information storage processing for storing main information, which is information unique to a specific object belonging to the specific location, in a database in association with the local ID assigned to the specific object; , Subordinate information storage procedure for causing a computer to execute subordinate information storage processing for linking subordinate information, which is information related to the specific object, to main information related to the specific object and storing the subordinate information in the database; When the local ID of the specific object is read by the ID reader of the information viewer terminal that is a computer device for browsing information, the information viewer terminal accesses the main information of the specific object.
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes: An ID storage medium for storing a unique ID for identifying the object; The user reads the ID storage medium at a place where the ID storage medium physically exists by a terminal device having a function of reading the ID of the ID storage medium, whereby the ID of one object is stored in a predetermined storage unit.
  • ID recording means for causing a computer to perform a recording function;
  • the user reads the other ID storage medium storing the ID of the other object to which the ID different from the ID of the one object is assigned by the terminal device, so that the ID of the one object and the other Edge storage means for causing a computer to realize a function of storing edge information forming a link with an object ID in the storage means.
  • an information providing method using a physical medium includes: Use an ID storage medium that stores a unique ID that identifies the object, The user reads the ID storage medium at a place where the ID storage medium physically exists by a terminal device having a function of reading the ID of the ID storage medium, whereby the ID of one object is stored in a predetermined storage unit.
  • An ID recording procedure for causing a computer to execute a recording process The user reads the other ID storage medium storing the ID of the other object to which the ID different from the ID of the one object is assigned by the terminal device, so that the ID of the one object and the other An edge storage procedure for causing a computer to execute processing for storing edge information forming a link with an object ID in the storage means.
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes: Node storage means for causing a computer to realize a function of storing node information including a unique node ID for identifying an object in a predetermined storage means; Edge storage means for causing a computer to realize a function of storing edge information forming a link between one node information stored in the storage means and another one node information in the storage means;
  • the node information has different types of attribute information,
  • the edge information has different types of attribute information,
  • One of the one node information and the other one node information is set as first information corresponding to a subject in an expression composed of a subject, a predicate, and an object, and the one node information and the other one are The other of the node information is the second information corresponding to the object in the data representation, and the edge information forming a link between the one node information and the other one node information ID,
  • the first information corresponding to the predicate in the data representation the first information
  • an information providing method using a physical medium includes: A node storage procedure for causing a computer to execute a process of storing node information including a unique node ID for identifying an object in a predetermined storage unit; An edge storage procedure for causing a computer to execute processing for storing edge information forming a link between one node information stored in the storage unit and another one node information in the storage unit;
  • the node information has different types of attribute information,
  • the edge information has different types of attribute information,
  • One of the one node information and the other one node information is set as first information corresponding to a subject in an expression composed of a subject, a predicate, and an object, and the one node information and the other one are The other of the node information is the second information corresponding to the object in the data representation, and the edge information forming a link between the one node information and the other one node information ID,
  • the first information corresponding to the predicate in the data representation the first information
  • various physical media having article properties and object properties such as merchandise are used.
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes an ID storage medium attached to a specific physical medium and storing a unique ID for identifying a specific tangible object, and a user
  • the ID storage medium By reading the ID storage medium at a specific location where the ID storage medium physically exists by a terminal device having a function of reading the ID of the ID storage medium, the ID of one tangible object is stored in a predetermined storage unit. It is characterized by comprising information recording means for causing a computer to realize a recording function, and information calling means for providing a function for calling information on a tangible object uniquely corresponding to the ID recorded in the storage means to the user.
  • the specific tangible object is a specific tangible object in the real world, and the goods, articles, objects, objects, etc. themselves are tangible objects, as well as old tales, folk tales, myths, lore stories, histories and novels. Also includes specific locations (geographic information) that can be associated with all or part of a story.
  • the ID corresponds to a local ID described later.
  • the information related to the tangible object may be predetermined content (historic site information, folktales, etc. of Embodiment 10) in addition to product information (such as Embodiment 1 described later).
  • the ID storage medium when the information recording unit reads the ID storage medium by the terminal device, the ID storage medium further exists. It is also characterized by recording geographical information about a specific place.
  • the information recording unit when the information recording unit reads the ID storage medium by the terminal device, the time information regarding the reading time is further recorded. It is characterized by doing.
  • the information calling unit further provides the user with information on a tangible object that uniquely corresponds to the ID recorded in the storage unit. It is provided in time series based on the time information.
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes an ID storage medium attached to a specific physical medium and storing a unique ID for identifying an entity, The user reads the ID storage medium at a specific location where the ID storage medium physically exists by a terminal device having a function of reading the ID of the ID storage medium, thereby obtaining the ID of one entity ID recording means for realizing the function of recording in the storage means in the computer, and other ID storage for storing the ID of another entity to which the user is assigned an ID different from the ID of the one entity by the terminal device
  • edge information forming a link between the ID of the one entity and the ID of the other entity, Characterized in that it comprises an edge storage means to realize the function of storing the serial storage means to the computer.
  • the entity may be, for example, a tale, folk tale, or myth (in the tenth embodiment described later) in addition to a product, article, object, object (such as in the first to eighth embodiments or ninth embodiment described later). Also includes all or part of stories and content such as tradition, history and novels.
  • an information providing system using a physical medium includes node information including a unique node ID attached to a specific physical medium and identifying an entity.
  • Node storage means for realizing a function to be stored in a predetermined storage means in a computer, and edge information forming a link between one node information stored in the storage means and another node information in the storage means
  • Edge storing means for causing a computer to perform the function of storing, and associating the node information with a partial content information obtained by dividing a specific completed content that is a continuous content according to a predetermined standard, into a predetermined storage area
  • a link based on edge information of the edge is provided between the content storage means for storing and the one node information and the other node information.
  • the partial content information of the one node information and the partial content information of the other one node information are connected to each other, and the completed content is generated as a series of contents in accordance with the predetermined standard.
  • content linking means for providing a function.
  • the node information (corresponds to the information in the node table described in the ninth embodiment or the tenth embodiment described later.
  • the node storage means is described in the ninth embodiment or the embodiment described later.
  • the link between the one node information and the other node information is described in the ninth embodiment or the tenth embodiment (to be described later).
  • the edge information corresponds to information in an edge table (described in a ninth embodiment or a tenth embodiment described later), and the edge storage means includes ( This corresponds to edge management means of an administrator system (described in Embodiment 9 or Embodiment 10 described later), and the predetermined criteria in the content storage means The degree of cooperation is determined by location, time axis, context, etc., and will be described in detail in Embodiment 10 described later. It can also be configured by storing it in the node table as different types of attribute information (described in Embodiment 9 or Embodiment 10), and the completed content is a traditional story as described in Embodiment 10.
  • the content storage means may be composed of data management means of an administrator system (described in the ninth or tenth embodiment to be described later). Forming a link based on edge information of the edge is equivalent to forming a mutual link (as described in the ninth or tenth embodiment).
  • the content linkage means may be constituted by (described in Embodiment 9 or embodiment 10 of the embodiment to be described later) data management unit of the management's system.
  • An information providing system and an information providing method using a physical medium include an actual store support type information providing system and information providing method, an advertisement support type information providing system and information providing method, and a net shop cooperation type information providing system.
  • the present invention can be applied to a stamp rally execution system, an attendance management system, and the like.
  • 100, 1100, 2100, 4100, 4100X administrator system 200, 2200: primary user system 300, 2300: secondary user system 400, 2400: physical medium providing place 500: information viewer terminal 4200, 4200A, 4200B: usage Terminal device

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
  • Databases & Information Systems (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Data Mining & Analysis (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Business, Economics & Management (AREA)
  • Development Economics (AREA)
  • Strategic Management (AREA)
  • Finance (AREA)
  • Accounting & Taxation (AREA)
  • Marketing (AREA)
  • Entrepreneurship & Innovation (AREA)
  • General Business, Economics & Management (AREA)
  • Game Theory and Decision Science (AREA)
  • Economics (AREA)
  • Management, Administration, Business Operations System, And Electronic Commerce (AREA)
  • Mobile Radio Communication Systems (AREA)
  • Information Transfer Between Computers (AREA)

Abstract

La présente invention est destinée à élaborer un système d'informations ou un réseau d'informations sur la base de supports physiques, et fournit des informations prescrites comprenant une série d'informations et analogues ayant une relation temporelle et/ou spatiale et/ou contextuelle. Le présent système d'informations comprend : un support de stockage d'ID qui est fixé à un support physique prescrit et stocke des ID uniques qui identifient des objets tangibles; un moyen d'enregistrement d'informations qui permet à un utilisateur d'utiliser un dispositif de terminal ayant une fonction de lecture pour lire les ID dans le support de stockage d'ID afin de lire un support de stockage d'ID dans un emplacement prescrit où le support de stockage d'ID existe physiquement, ce qui permet de fournir à un ordinateur une fonction d'enregistrement, dans un moyen de stockage prescrit, de l'ID d'un objet tangible; et un moyen d'accès à des informations qui fournit à un utilisateur la fonction d'accès à des informations se rapportant à un objet tangible correspondant de manière unique à un identifiant enregistré dans le moyen de stockage.
PCT/JP2019/005450 2018-02-14 2019-02-14 Système de fourniture d'informations utilisant des supports physiques et procédé de fourniture d'informations Ceased WO2019160063A2 (fr)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US16/992,651 US20210124791A1 (en) 2018-02-14 2020-08-13 Information provision system using physical media,and information provision method

Applications Claiming Priority (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2018024579A JP2021067961A (ja) 2018-02-14 2018-02-14 物理媒体を利用した情報提供システム及び情報提供方法
JP2018-024579 2018-02-14

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/992,651 Continuation US20210124791A1 (en) 2018-02-14 2020-08-13 Information provision system using physical media,and information provision method

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2019160063A2 true WO2019160063A2 (fr) 2019-08-22
WO2019160063A3 WO2019160063A3 (fr) 2019-10-10

Family

ID=67621033

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/JP2019/005450 Ceased WO2019160063A2 (fr) 2018-02-14 2019-02-14 Système de fourniture d'informations utilisant des supports physiques et procédé de fourniture d'informations

Country Status (3)

Country Link
US (1) US20210124791A1 (fr)
JP (1) JP2021067961A (fr)
WO (1) WO2019160063A2 (fr)

Families Citing this family (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2023159551A (ja) * 2022-04-20 2023-11-01 株式会社 みずほ銀行 アイテム管理システム、アイテム管理方法及びアイテム管理プログラム

Family Cites Families (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2004246522A (ja) * 2003-02-13 2004-09-02 Hitachi Ltd 分散コミュニティシステム及び分散コミュニティ端末
JP4631094B2 (ja) * 2004-10-20 2011-02-16 株式会社日立ソリューションズ コンテンツ表示システム
JP2009064250A (ja) * 2007-09-06 2009-03-26 Ricoh Co Ltd 画像形成装置、情報管理方法、及び情報管理システム

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
WO2019160063A3 (fr) 2019-10-10
JP2021067961A (ja) 2021-04-30
US20210124791A1 (en) 2021-04-29

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
JP6469189B2 (ja) 物理媒体を利用した情報提供システム及び情報提供方法
US11610211B2 (en) Giga app for transforming a traditional email application into a virtual mail application to significantly improve email marketing results
Berthon Marketing communication and the world wide web
US7523132B2 (en) Data tag creation from a physical item data record to be attached to a physical item
US6804660B2 (en) System method and article of manufacture for internet based affiliate pooling
Hanafizadeh et al. Online Advertising and Promotion: Modern Technologies for Marketing: Modern Technologies for Marketing
Kasavana eMarketing: Restaurant websites that click
CN101460970A (zh) 用于在线内容市场的系统及其操作方法
TW201222443A (en) Cooperative Personalized Promotion method according to consumer-store transaction history and system using the same
Brabazon et al. Digital wine: How QR codes facilitate new markets for small wine industries
CN103942702A (zh) 基于电子名片开展电子商务的系统和方法
KR102334612B1 (ko) 잔여 시간을 고려하여 생성되는 웨딩에 관한 정보를 제공하는 방법 및 서버
CN101882288A (zh) 主动式广告平台
Wills The ins and the outs of electronic publishing
KR101370656B1 (ko) 가상 동네 서비스 제공 시스템 및 방법
WO2019160063A2 (fr) Système de fourniture d'informations utilisant des supports physiques et procédé de fourniture d'informations
US8065385B2 (en) Transferring information and records via a data structure for a physical item in the control of a user
WO2014100436A1 (fr) Site de marketing social amélioré
CN113781185A (zh) 一种基于mvc框架的智能平台的校园二手交易系统
Suvanno Using Digital Communication in Trust Marketing Concept Managerial Implementing
Mustafiz et al. Development of a Novel Integrated Web-Based System for Advertisement Service
Johnson et al. Horizon Report: 2009 Economic Development Edition.
KR20080113168A (ko) 개체지향 키워드박스와 유동적 정형화된 분류연결구조를 이용하는 정보검색, 데이터 호환, 유비쿼터스, 광고에 대한 시스템, 방법, 소프트웨어(컴퓨터 프로그램 상품)에 관한 것이다.
Fuciu et al. Internet and E-commerce-tools for creating value in the E-marketplace
Barnett CODE: ELEC-4616 TITLE: ELECTRONIC COMMERCE

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 19754663

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A2

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: JP